changeset 18788:e1f4e9d78a6a v8.1.2383

patch 8.1.2383: using old C style comments Commit: https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/734a867ffe198886da7365b618be67ab8ed9d9f6 Author: Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org> Date: Mon Dec 2 22:49:38 2019 +0100 patch 8.1.2383: using old C style comments Problem: Using old C style comments. Solution: Use // comments where appropriate.
author Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
date Mon, 02 Dec 2019 23:00:04 +0100
parents 06ed2fe62dce
children bea2e4dfc6d7
files src/gui_mac.c src/gui_motif.c src/gui_photon.c src/gui_w32.c src/gui_x11.c src/gui_xmdlg.c src/gui_xmebw.c src/version.c
diffstat 8 files changed, 1976 insertions(+), 1990 deletions(-) [+]
line wrap: on
line diff
--- a/src/gui_mac.c
+++ b/src/gui_mac.c
@@ -28,25 +28,26 @@
  *
  */
 
-/* TODO (Jussi)
+/*
+ * TODO (Jussi)
  *   * Clipboard does not work (at least some cases)
  *   * ATSU font rendering has some problems
  *   * Investigate and remove dead code (there is still lots of that)
  */
 
-#include <Devices.h> /* included first to avoid CR problems */
+#include <Devices.h> // included first to avoid CR problems
 #include "vim.h"
 
 #define USE_CARBONIZED
-#define USE_AEVENT		/* Enable AEVENT */
-#undef USE_OFFSETED_WINDOW	/* Debugging feature: start Vim window OFFSETed */
-
-/* Compile as CodeWarrior External Editor */
+#define USE_AEVENT		// Enable AEVENT
+#undef USE_OFFSETED_WINDOW	// Debugging feature: start Vim window OFFSETed
+
+// Compile as CodeWarrior External Editor
 #if defined(FEAT_CW_EDITOR) && !defined(USE_AEVENT)
-# define USE_AEVENT /* Need Apple Event Support */
+# define USE_AEVENT // Need Apple Event Support
 #endif
 
-/* Vim's Scrap flavor. */
+// Vim's Scrap flavor.
 #define VIMSCRAPFLAVOR 'VIM!'
 #define SCRAPTEXTFLAVOR kScrapFlavorTypeUnicode
 
@@ -58,7 +59,7 @@ SInt32 gMacSystemVersion;
 
 static int im_is_active = FALSE;
 # if 0
-    /* TODO: Implement me! */
+    // TODO: Implement me!
 static int im_start_row = 0;
 static int im_start_col = 0;
 # endif
@@ -86,7 +87,7 @@ static pascal OSStatus gui_mac_unicode_k
 #endif
 
 
-/* Include some file. TODO: move into os_mac.h */
+// Include some file. TODO: move into os_mac.h
 #include <Menus.h>
 #include <Resources.h>
 #include <Processes.h>
@@ -97,13 +98,13 @@ static pascal OSStatus gui_mac_unicode_k
 # include <Gestalt.h>
 #if UNIVERSAL_INTERFACES_VERSION >= 0x0330
 # include <ControlDefinitions.h>
-# include <Navigation.h>  /* Navigation only part of ?? */
+# include <Navigation.h>  // Navigation only part of ??
 #endif
 
-/* Help Manager (balloon.h, HM prefixed functions) are not supported
- * under Carbon (Jussi) */
+// Help Manager (balloon.h, HM prefixed functions) are not supported
+// under Carbon (Jussi)
 #  if 0
-/* New Help Interface for Mac, not implemented yet.*/
+// New Help Interface for Mac, not implemented yet.
 #    include <MacHelp.h>
 #  endif
 
@@ -112,7 +113,7 @@ static pascal OSStatus gui_mac_unicode_k
  * headers? (Jussi)
  */
 #define kNothing 0
-#define kCreateEmpty 2 /*1*/
+#define kCreateEmpty 2 //1
 #define kCreateRect 2
 #define kDestroy 3
 
@@ -123,34 +124,33 @@ static pascal OSStatus gui_mac_unicode_k
 #define botRight(r)	(((Point*)&(r))[1])
 
 
-/* Time of last mouse click, to detect double-click */
+// Time of last mouse click, to detect double-click
 static long lastMouseTick = 0;
 
-/* ??? */
+// ???
 static RgnHandle cursorRgn;
 static RgnHandle dragRgn;
 static Rect dragRect;
 static short dragRectEnbl;
 static short dragRectControl;
 
-/* This variable is set when waiting for an event, which is the only moment
- * scrollbar dragging can be done directly.  It's not allowed while commands
- * are executed, because it may move the cursor and that may cause unexpected
- * problems (e.g., while ":s" is working).
- */
+// This variable is set when waiting for an event, which is the only moment
+// scrollbar dragging can be done directly.  It's not allowed while commands
+// are executed, because it may move the cursor and that may cause unexpected
+// problems (e.g., while ":s" is working).
 static int allow_scrollbar = FALSE;
 
-/* Last mouse click caused contextual menu, (to provide proper release) */
+// Last mouse click caused contextual menu, (to provide proper release)
 static short clickIsPopup;
 
-/* Feedback Action for Scrollbar */
+// Feedback Action for Scrollbar
 ControlActionUPP gScrollAction;
 ControlActionUPP gScrollDrag;
 
-/* Keeping track of which scrollbar is being dragged */
+// Keeping track of which scrollbar is being dragged
 static ControlHandle dragged_sb = NULL;
 
-/* Vector of char_u --> control index for hotkeys in dialogs */
+// Vector of char_u --> control index for hotkeys in dialogs
 static short *gDialogHotKeys;
 
 static struct
@@ -170,23 +170,23 @@ Boolean	    gIsFontFallbackSet;
 UInt32      useAntialias_cached = 0x0;
 #endif
 
-/* Colors Macros */
+// Colors Macros
 #define RGB(r,g,b)	((r) << 16) + ((g) << 8) + (b)
 #define Red(c)		((c & 0x00FF0000) >> 16)
 #define Green(c)	((c & 0x0000FF00) >>  8)
 #define Blue(c)		((c & 0x000000FF) >>  0)
 
-/* Key mapping */
-
-#define vk_Esc		0x35	/* -> 1B */
-
-#define vk_F1		0x7A	/* -> 10 */
-#define vk_F2		0x78  /*0x63*/
-#define vk_F3		0x63  /*0x76*/
-#define vk_F4		0x76  /*0x60*/
-#define vk_F5		0x60  /*0x61*/
-#define vk_F6		0x61  /*0x62*/
-#define vk_F7		0x62  /*0x63*/  /*?*/
+// Key mapping
+
+#define vk_Esc		0x35	// -> 1B
+
+#define vk_F1		0x7A	// -> 10
+#define vk_F2		0x78  //0x63
+#define vk_F3		0x63  //0x76
+#define vk_F4		0x76  //0x60
+#define vk_F5		0x60  //0x61
+#define vk_F6		0x61  //0x62
+#define vk_F7		0x62  //0x63 ?
 #define vk_F8		0x64
 #define vk_F9		0x65
 #define vk_F10		0x6D
@@ -196,26 +196,26 @@ UInt32      useAntialias_cached = 0x0;
 #define vk_F14		0x6B
 #define vk_F15		0x71
 
-#define vk_Clr		0x47	/* -> 1B (ESC) */
-#define vk_Enter	0x4C	/* -> 03 */
-
-#define vk_Space	0x31	/* -> 20 */
-#define vk_Tab		0x30	/* -> 09 */
-#define vk_Return	0x24	/* -> 0D */
-/* This is wrong for OSX, what is it for? */
-#define vk_Delete	0X08	/* -> 08 BackSpace */
-
-#define vk_Help		0x72	/* -> 05 */
-#define vk_Home		0x73	/* -> 01 */
-#define	vk_PageUp	0x74	/* -> 0D */
-#define vk_FwdDelete	0x75	/* -> 7F */
-#define	vk_End		0x77	/* -> 04 */
-#define vk_PageDown	0x79	/* -> 0C */
-
-#define vk_Up		0x7E	/* -> 1E */
-#define vk_Down		0x7D	/* -> 1F */
-#define	vk_Left		0x7B	/* -> 1C */
-#define vk_Right	0x7C	/* -> 1D */
+#define vk_Clr		0x47	// -> 1B (ESC)
+#define vk_Enter	0x4C	// -> 03
+
+#define vk_Space	0x31	// -> 20
+#define vk_Tab		0x30	// -> 09
+#define vk_Return	0x24	// -> 0D
+// This is wrong for OSX, what is it for?
+#define vk_Delete	0X08	// -> 08 BackSpace
+
+#define vk_Help		0x72	// -> 05
+#define vk_Home		0x73	// -> 01
+#define	vk_PageUp	0x74	// -> 0D
+#define vk_FwdDelete	0x75	// -> 7F
+#define	vk_End		0x77	// -> 04
+#define vk_PageDown	0x79	// -> 0C
+
+#define vk_Up		0x7E	// -> 1E
+#define vk_Down		0x7D	// -> 1F
+#define	vk_Left		0x7B	// -> 1C
+#define vk_Right	0x7C	// -> 1D
 
 #define vk_Undo		vk_F1
 #define vk_Cut		vk_F2
@@ -258,22 +258,22 @@ static struct
     {vk_F14,		'F', '4'},
     {vk_F15,		'F', '5'},
 
-/*  {XK_Help,		'%', '1'}, */
-/*  {XK_Undo,		'&', '8'}, */
-/*  {XK_BackSpace,	'k', 'b'}, */
-/*  {vk_Delete,		'k', 'b'}, */
+//  {XK_Help,		'%', '1'},
+//  {XK_Undo,		'&', '8'},
+//  {XK_BackSpace,	'k', 'b'},
+//  {vk_Delete,		'k', 'b'},
     {vk_Insert,		'k', 'I'},
     {vk_FwdDelete,	'k', 'D'},
     {vk_Home,		'k', 'h'},
     {vk_End,		'@', '7'},
-/*  {XK_Prior,		'k', 'P'}, */
-/*  {XK_Next,		'k', 'N'}, */
-/*  {XK_Print,		'%', '9'}, */
+//  {XK_Prior,		'k', 'P'},
+//  {XK_Next,		'k', 'N'},
+//  {XK_Print,		'%', '9'},
 
     {vk_PageUp,		'k', 'P'},
     {vk_PageDown,	'k', 'N'},
 
-    /* End of list marker: */
+    // End of list marker:
     {(KeySym)0,		0, 0}
 };
 
@@ -321,7 +321,7 @@ C2Pascal_save(char_u *Cstring)
 
     len = STRLEN(Cstring);
 
-    if (len > 255) /* Truncate if necessary */
+    if (len > 255) // Truncate if necessary
 	len = 255;
 
     PascalString = alloc(len + 1);
@@ -351,7 +351,7 @@ C2Pascal_save_and_remove_backslash(char_
 
     len = STRLEN(Cstring);
 
-    if (len > 255) /* Truncate if necessary */
+    if (len > 255) // Truncate if necessary
 	len = 255;
 
     PascalString = alloc(len + 1);
@@ -387,8 +387,8 @@ EventModifiers2VimMouseModifiers(EventMo
     if (macModifiers & (optionKey | rightOptionKey))
 	vimModifiers |= MOUSE_ALT;
 #if 0
-    /* Not yet supported */
-    if (macModifiers & (cmdKey)) /* There's no rightCmdKey */
+    // Not yet supported
+    if (macModifiers & (cmdKey)) // There's no rightCmdKey
 	vimModifiers |= MOUSE_CMD;
 #endif
     return (vimModifiers);
@@ -410,13 +410,14 @@ EventModifiers2VimModifiers(EventModifie
     if (macModifiers & (optionKey | rightOptionKey))
 	vimModifiers |= MOD_MASK_ALT;
 #ifdef USE_CMD_KEY
-    if (macModifiers & (cmdKey)) /* There's no rightCmdKey */
+    if (macModifiers & (cmdKey)) // There's no rightCmdKey
 	vimModifiers |= MOD_MASK_CMD;
 #endif
     return (vimModifiers);
 }
 
-/* Convert a string representing a point size into pixels. The string should
+/*
+ * Convert a string representing a point size into pixels. The string should
  * be a positive decimal number, with an optional decimal point (eg, "12", or
  * "10.5"). The pixel value is returned, and a pointer to the next unconverted
  * character is stored in *end. The flag "vertical" says whether this
@@ -435,7 +436,7 @@ points_to_pixels(char_u *str, char_u **e
     {
 	if (*str == '.' && divisor == 0)
 	{
-	    /* Start keeping a divisor, for later */
+	    // Start keeping a divisor, for later
 	    divisor = 1;
 	    continue;
 	}
@@ -479,8 +480,8 @@ menu_title_removing_mnemonic(vimmenu_T *
 
     if (name)
     {
-	/* Simple mnemonic-removal algorithm, assumes single parenthesized
-	 * mnemonic character towards the end of the menu text */
+	// Simple mnemonic-removal algorithm, assumes single parenthesized
+	// mnemonic character towards the end of the menu text
 	mnemonicStart = CFStringFind(name, CFSTR("("), kCFCompareBackwards);
 	displayLen = CFStringGetLength(name);
 
@@ -530,33 +531,33 @@ new_fnames_from_AEDesc(AEDesc *theList, 
     AEKeyword	dummyKeyword;
     DescType	dummyType;
 
-    /* Get number of files in list */
+    // Get number of files in list
     *error = AECountItems(theList, numFiles);
     if (*error)
 	return fnames;
 
-    /* Allocate the pointer list */
+    // Allocate the pointer list
     fnames = ALLOC_MULT(char_u *, *numFiles);
 
-    /* Empty out the list */
+    // Empty out the list
     for (fileCount = 0; fileCount < *numFiles; fileCount++)
 	fnames[fileCount] = NULL;
 
-    /* Scan the list of FSSpec */
+    // Scan the list of FSSpec
     for (fileCount = 1; fileCount <= *numFiles; fileCount++)
     {
-	/* Get the alias for the nth file, convert to an FSSpec */
+	// Get the alias for the nth file, convert to an FSSpec
 	newError = AEGetNthPtr(theList, fileCount, typeFSS,
 				&dummyKeyword, &dummyType,
 				(Ptr) &fileToOpen, sizeof(FSSpec), &actualSize);
 	if (newError)
 	{
-	    /* Caller is able to clean up */
-	    /* TODO: Should be clean up or not? For safety. */
+	    // Caller is able to clean up
+	    // TODO: Should be clean up or not? For safety.
 	    return fnames;
 	}
 
-	/* Convert the FSSpec to a pathname */
+	// Convert the FSSpec to a pathname
 	fnames[fileCount - 1] = FullPathFromFSSpec_save(fileToOpen);
     }
 
@@ -595,7 +596,7 @@ new_fnames_from_AEDesc(AEDesc *theList, 
  */
 
 typedef struct WindowSearch WindowSearch;
-struct WindowSearch /* for handling class 'KAHL', event 'SRCH', keyDirectObject typeChar*/
+struct WindowSearch // for handling class 'KAHL', event 'SRCH', keyDirectObject typeChar
 {
     FSSpec theFile; // identifies the file
     long *theDate; // where to put the modification date/time
@@ -668,7 +669,7 @@ Handle_KAHL_SRCH_AE(
  */
 
 typedef struct ModificationInfo ModificationInfo;
-struct ModificationInfo /* for replying to class 'KAHL', event 'MOD ', keyDirectObject typeAEList*/
+struct ModificationInfo // for replying to class 'KAHL', event 'MOD ', keyDirectObject typeAEList
 {
     FSSpec theFile; // identifies the file
     long theDate; // the date/time the file was last modified
@@ -693,11 +694,11 @@ Handle_KAHL_MOD_AE(
     if (error)
 	return error;
 
-    /* Send the reply */
-/*  replyObject.descriptorType = typeNull;
-    replyObject.dataHandle     = nil;*/
-
-/* AECreateDesc(typeChar, (Ptr)&title[1], title[0], &data) */
+    // Send the reply
+//  replyObject.descriptorType = typeNull;
+// replyObject.dataHandle     = nil;
+
+// AECreateDesc(typeChar, (Ptr)&title[1], title[0], &data)
     error = AECreateList(nil, 0, false, &replyList);
     if (error)
 	return error;
@@ -705,22 +706,21 @@ Handle_KAHL_MOD_AE(
 #if 0
     error = AECountItems(&replyList, &numFiles);
 
-    /* AEPutKeyDesc(&replyList, keyAEPnject, &aDesc)
-     * AEPutKeyPtr(&replyList, keyAEPosition, typeChar, (Ptr)&theType,
-     * sizeof(DescType))
-     */
-
-    /* AEPutDesc */
+    // AEPutKeyDesc(&replyList, keyAEPnject, &aDesc)
+    // AEPutKeyPtr(&replyList, keyAEPosition, typeChar, (Ptr)&theType,
+    // sizeof(DescType))
+
+    // AEPutDesc
 #endif
 
     numFiles = 0;
     FOR_ALL_BUFFERS(buf)
 	if (buf->b_ml.ml_mfp != NULL)
 	{
-	    /* Add this file to the list */
+	    // Add this file to the list
 	    theFile.theFile = buf->b_FSSpec;
 	    theFile.theDate = buf->b_mtime;
-/*	    theFile.theDate = time(NULL) & (time_t) 0xFFFFFFF0; */
+//	    theFile.theDate = time(NULL) & (time_t) 0xFFFFFFF0;
 	    error = AEPutPtr(&replyList, numFiles, typeChar, (Ptr) &theFile, sizeof(theFile));
 	};
 
@@ -728,7 +728,7 @@ Handle_KAHL_MOD_AE(
     error = AECountItems(&replyList, &numFiles);
 #endif
 
-    /* We can add data only if something to reply */
+    // We can add data only if something to reply
     error = AEPutParamDesc(theReply, keyDirectObject, &replyList);
 
     if (replyList.dataHandle)
@@ -764,12 +764,12 @@ Handle_KAHL_MOD_AE(
  */
 
 typedef struct CW_GetText CW_GetText;
-struct CW_GetText /* for handling class 'KAHL', event 'GTTX', keyDirectObject typeChar*/
-{
-    FSSpec theFile; /* identifies the file */
-    Handle theText; /* the location where you return the text (must be resized properly) */
-    long *unused;   /* 0 (not used) */
-    long *theDate;  /* where to put the modification date/time */
+struct CW_GetText // for handling class 'KAHL', event 'GTTX', keyDirectObject typeChar
+{
+    FSSpec theFile; // identifies the file
+    Handle theText; // the location where you return the text (must be resized properly)
+    long *unused;   // 0 (not used)
+    long *theDate;  // where to put the modification date/time
 };
 
     pascal OSErr
@@ -806,19 +806,19 @@ Handle_KAHL_GTTX_AE(
 
     if (foundFile)
     {
-	BufferSize = 0; /* GetHandleSize(GetTextData.theText); */
+	BufferSize = 0; // GetHandleSize(GetTextData.theText);
 	for (lineno = 0; lineno <= buf->b_ml.ml_line_count; lineno++)
 	{
-	    /* Must use the right buffer */
+	    // Must use the right buffer
 	    line = ml_get_buf(buf, (linenr_T) lineno, FALSE);
 	    linesize = STRLEN(line) + 1;
 	    lineStart = BufferSize;
 	    BufferSize += linesize;
-	    /* Resize handle to linesize+1 to include the linefeed */
+	    // Resize handle to linesize+1 to include the linefeed
 	    SetHandleSize(GetTextData.theText, BufferSize);
 	    if (GetHandleSize(GetTextData.theText) != BufferSize)
 	    {
-		break; /* Simple handling for now */
+		break; // Simple handling for now
 	    }
 	    else
 	    {
@@ -838,7 +838,7 @@ Handle_KAHL_GTTX_AE(
 	if (foundFile == false)
 	    *GetTextData.theDate = fnfErr;
 	else
-/*	    *GetTextData.theDate = time(NULL) & (time_t) 0xFFFFFFF0;*/
+//	    *GetTextData.theDate = time(NULL) & (time_t) 0xFFFFFFF0;
 	    *GetTextData.theDate = buf->b_mtime;
     }
 
@@ -851,7 +851,9 @@ Handle_KAHL_GTTX_AE(
  *
  */
 
-/* Taken from MoreAppleEvents:ProcessHelpers*/
+/*
+ * Taken from MoreAppleEvents:ProcessHelpers
+ */
     pascal	OSErr
 FindProcessBySignature(
 	const OSType		targetType,
@@ -915,7 +917,7 @@ Send_KAHL_MOD_AE(buf_T *buf)
 
 	AEDisposeDesc(&targetAppDesc);
 
-	/* Add the parms */
+	// Add the parms
 	ModData.theFile = buf->b_FSSpec;
 	ModData.theDate = buf->b_mtime;
 
@@ -931,12 +933,12 @@ Send_KAHL_MOD_AE(buf_T *buf)
 	    anErr = AESend(&theEvent, &theReply, sendMode, kAENormalPriority, kNoTimeOut, idleProcUPP, nil);
 	if (anErr == noErr  &&  sendMode == kAEWaitReply)
 	{
-/*	    anErr =  AEHGetHandlerError(&theReply);*/
+//	    anErr =  AEHGetHandlerError(&theReply);
 	}
 	(void) AEDisposeDesc(&theReply);
     }
 }
-#endif /* FEAT_CW_EDITOR */
+#endif // FEAT_CW_EDITOR
 
 /*
  * ------------------------------------------------------------
@@ -957,13 +959,13 @@ HandleUnusedParms(const AppleEvent *theA
     DescType	dummyType;
     AEKeyword	missedKeyword;
 
-    /* Get the "missed keyword" attribute from the AppleEvent. */
+    // Get the "missed keyword" attribute from the AppleEvent.
     error = AEGetAttributePtr(theAEvent, keyMissedKeywordAttr,
 			      typeKeyword, &dummyType,
 			      (Ptr)&missedKeyword, sizeof(missedKeyword),
 			      &actualSize);
 
-    /* If the descriptor isn't found, then we got the required parameters. */
+    // If the descriptor isn't found, then we got the required parameters.
     if (error == errAEDescNotFound)
     {
 	error = noErr;
@@ -971,7 +973,7 @@ HandleUnusedParms(const AppleEvent *theA
     else
     {
 #if 0
-	/* Why is this removed? */
+	// Why is this removed?
 	error = errAEEventNotHandled;
 #endif
     }
@@ -988,7 +990,7 @@ HandleUnusedParms(const AppleEvent *theA
  */
 
 typedef struct SelectionRange SelectionRange;
-struct SelectionRange /* for handling kCoreClassEvent:kOpenDocuments:keyAEPosition typeChar */
+struct SelectionRange // for handling kCoreClassEvent:kOpenDocuments:keyAEPosition typeChar
 {
     short unused1; // 0 (not used)
     short lineNum; // line to select (<0 to specify range)
@@ -1005,30 +1007,30 @@ static SelectionRange drop_thePosition;
     static void
 drop_callback(void *cookie UNUSED)
 {
-    /* TODO: Handle the goto/select line more cleanly */
+    // TODO: Handle the goto/select line more cleanly
     if ((drop_numFiles == 1) & (drop_gotPosition))
     {
 	if (drop_thePosition.lineNum >= 0)
 	{
 	    lnum = drop_thePosition.lineNum + 1;
-	/*  oap->motion_type = MLINE;
-	    setpcmark();*/
+	//  oap->motion_type = MLINE;
+	// setpcmark();
 	    if (lnum < 1L)
 		lnum = 1L;
 	    else if (lnum > curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count)
 		lnum = curbuf->b_ml.ml_line_count;
 	    curwin->w_cursor.lnum = lnum;
 	    curwin->w_cursor.col = 0;
-	/*  beginline(BL_SOL | BL_FIX);*/
+	//  beginline(BL_SOL | BL_FIX);
 	}
 	else
 	    goto_byte(drop_thePosition.startRange + 1);
     }
 
-    /* Update the screen display */
+    // Update the screen display
     update_screen(NOT_VALID);
 
-    /* Select the text if possible */
+    // Select the text if possible
     if (drop_gotPosition)
     {
 	VIsual_active = TRUE;
@@ -1047,14 +1049,14 @@ drop_callback(void *cookie UNUSED)
     }
 }
 
-/* The IDE uses the optional keyAEPosition parameter to tell the ed-
-   itor the selection range. If lineNum is zero or greater, scroll the text
-   to the specified line. If lineNum is less than zero, use the values in
-   startRange and endRange to select the specified characters. Scroll
-   the text to display the selection. If lineNum, startRange, and
-   endRange are all negative, there is no selection range specified.
+/*
+ * The IDE uses the optional keyAEPosition parameter to tell the ed-
+ * itor the selection range. If lineNum is zero or greater, scroll the text
+ * to the specified line. If lineNum is less than zero, use the values in
+ * startRange and endRange to select the specified characters. Scroll
+ * the text to display the selection. If lineNum, startRange, and
+ * endRange are all negative, there is no selection range specified.
  */
-
     pascal OSErr
 HandleODocAE(const AppleEvent *theAEvent, AppleEvent *theReply, long refCon)
 {
@@ -1076,7 +1078,7 @@ HandleODocAE(const AppleEvent *theAEvent
     short	gotPosition = false;
     long	lnum;
 
-    /* the direct object parameter is the list of aliases to files (one or more) */
+    // the direct object parameter is the list of aliases to files (one or more)
     error = AEGetParamDesc(theAEvent, keyDirectObject, typeAEList, &theList);
     if (error)
 	return error;
@@ -1111,7 +1113,7 @@ HandleODocAE(const AppleEvent *theAEvent
 
     if (error)
     {
-      /* TODO: empty fnames[] first */
+      // TODO: empty fnames[] first
       vim_free(fnames);
       return (error);
     }
@@ -1122,7 +1124,7 @@ HandleODocAE(const AppleEvent *theAEvent
 	char_u *p;
 	int fnum = -1;
 
-	/* these are the initial files dropped on the Vim icon */
+	// these are the initial files dropped on the Vim icon
 	for (i = 0 ; i < numFiles; i++)
 	{
 	    if (ga_grow(&global_alist.al_ga, 1) == FAIL
@@ -1134,8 +1136,8 @@ HandleODocAE(const AppleEvent *theAEvent
 		fnum = GARGLIST[GARGCOUNT - 1].ae_fnum;
 	}
 
-	/* If the file name was already in the buffer list we need to switch
-	 * to it. */
+	// If the file name was already in the buffer list we need to switch
+	// to it.
 	if (curbuf->b_fnum != fnum)
 	{
 	    char_u cmd[30];
@@ -1144,7 +1146,7 @@ HandleODocAE(const AppleEvent *theAEvent
 	    do_cmdline_cmd(cmd);
 	}
 
-	/* Change directory to the location of the first file. */
+	// Change directory to the location of the first file.
 	if (GARGCOUNT > 0
 		      && vim_chdirfile(alist_name(&GARGLIST[0]), "drop") == OK)
 	    shorten_fnames(TRUE);
@@ -1152,7 +1154,7 @@ HandleODocAE(const AppleEvent *theAEvent
 	goto finished;
     }
 
-    /* Handle the drop, :edit to get to the file */
+    // Handle the drop, :edit to get to the file
     drop_numFiles = numFiles;
     drop_gotPosition = gotPosition;
     drop_thePosition = thePosition;
@@ -1161,11 +1163,11 @@ HandleODocAE(const AppleEvent *theAEvent
     setcursor();
     out_flush();
 
-    /* Fake mouse event to wake from stall */
+    // Fake mouse event to wake from stall
     PostEvent(mouseUp, 0);
 
 finished:
-    AEDisposeDesc(&theList); /* dispose what we allocated */
+    AEDisposeDesc(&theList); // dispose what we allocated
 
     error = HandleUnusedParms(theAEvent);
     return error;
@@ -1174,7 +1176,6 @@ finished:
 /*
  *
  */
-
     pascal OSErr
 Handle_aevt_oapp_AE(
 	const AppleEvent    *theAEvent,
@@ -1190,7 +1191,6 @@ Handle_aevt_oapp_AE(
 /*
  *
  */
-
     pascal OSErr
 Handle_aevt_quit_AE(
 	const AppleEvent    *theAEvent,
@@ -1203,7 +1203,7 @@ Handle_aevt_quit_AE(
     if (error)
 	return error;
 
-    /* Need to fake a :confirm qa */
+    // Need to fake a :confirm qa
     do_cmdline_cmd((char_u *)"confirm qa");
 
     return error;
@@ -1212,7 +1212,6 @@ Handle_aevt_quit_AE(
 /*
  *
  */
-
     pascal OSErr
 Handle_aevt_pdoc_AE(
 	const AppleEvent    *theAEvent,
@@ -1253,30 +1252,31 @@ InstallAEHandlers(void)
 {
     OSErr   error;
 
-    /* install open application handler */
+    // install open application handler
     error = AEInstallEventHandler(kCoreEventClass, kAEOpenApplication,
 		    NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_aevt_oapp_AE), 0, false);
     if (error)
 	return error;
 
-    /* install quit application handler */
+    // install quit application handler
     error = AEInstallEventHandler(kCoreEventClass, kAEQuitApplication,
 		    NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_aevt_quit_AE), 0, false);
     if (error)
 	return error;
 
-    /* install open document handler */
+    // install open document handler
     error = AEInstallEventHandler(kCoreEventClass, kAEOpenDocuments,
 		    NewAEEventHandlerUPP(HandleODocAE), 0, false);
     if (error)
 	return error;
 
-    /* install print document handler */
+    // install print document handler
     error = AEInstallEventHandler(kCoreEventClass, kAEPrintDocuments,
 		    NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_aevt_pdoc_AE), 0, false);
 
-/* Install Core Suite */
-/*  error = AEInstallEventHandler(kAECoreSuite, kAEClone,
+// Install Core Suite
+#if 0
+    error = AEInstallEventHandler(kAECoreSuite, kAEClone,
 		    NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_unknown_AE), nil, false);
 
     error = AEInstallEventHandler(kAECoreSuite, kAEClose,
@@ -1314,7 +1314,7 @@ InstallAEHandlers(void)
 
     error = AEInstallEventHandler(kAECoreSuite, kAESetData,
 		    NewAEEventHandlerUPP(Handle_unknown_AE), nil, false);
-*/
+#endif
 
 #ifdef FEAT_CW_EDITOR
     /*
@@ -1335,7 +1335,7 @@ InstallAEHandlers(void)
     return error;
 
 }
-#endif /* USE_AEVENT */
+#endif // USE_AEVENT
 
 
 /*
@@ -1361,7 +1361,7 @@ FontPanelHandler(
 	FMFontSize newSize;
 	FMFontStyle newStyle;
 
-	/* Retrieve the font family ID number. */
+	// Retrieve the font family ID number.
 	status = GetEventParameter(inEvent, kEventParamFMFontFamily,
 		/*inDesiredType=*/typeFMFontFamily, /*outActualType=*/NULL,
 		/*inBufferSize=*/sizeof(FMFontFamily), /*outActualSize=*/NULL,
@@ -1369,13 +1369,13 @@ FontPanelHandler(
 	if (status == noErr)
 	    gFontPanelInfo.family = newFamily;
 
-	/* Retrieve the font size. */
+	// Retrieve the font size.
 	status = GetEventParameter(inEvent, kEventParamFMFontSize,
 		typeFMFontSize, NULL, sizeof(FMFontSize), NULL, &newSize);
 	if (status == noErr)
 	    gFontPanelInfo.size = newSize;
 
-	/* Retrieve the font style (bold, etc.).  Currently unused. */
+	// Retrieve the font style (bold, etc.).  Currently unused.
 	status = GetEventParameter(inEvent, kEventParamFMFontStyle,
 		typeFMFontStyle, NULL, sizeof(FMFontStyle), NULL, &newStyle);
 	if (status == noErr)
@@ -1390,7 +1390,7 @@ InstallFontPanelHandler(void)
 {
     EventTypeSpec eventTypes[2];
     EventHandlerUPP handlerUPP;
-    /* EventHandlerRef handlerRef; */
+    // EventHandlerRef handlerRef;
 
     eventTypes[0].eventClass = kEventClassFont;
     eventTypes[0].eventKind  = kEventFontSelection;
@@ -1422,20 +1422,20 @@ GetFontPanelSelection(char_u *outName)
 
     if (FMGetFontFamilyName(gFontPanelInfo.family, buf) == noErr)
     {
-	/* Canonicalize localized font names */
+	// Canonicalize localized font names
 	if (FMGetFontFromFontFamilyInstance(gFontPanelInfo.family,
 		    gFontPanelInfo.style, &fid, NULL) != noErr)
 	    return;
 
-	/* Request font name with Mac encoding (otherwise we could
-	 * get an unwanted utf-16 name) */
+	// Request font name with Mac encoding (otherwise we could
+	// get an unwanted utf-16 name)
 	if (ATSUFindFontName(fid, kFontFullName, kFontMacintoshPlatform,
 		    kFontNoScriptCode, kFontNoLanguageCode,
 		    255, (char *)outName, &fontNameLen, NULL) != noErr)
 	    return;
 
-	/* Only encode font size, because style (bold, italic, etc) is
-	 * already part of the font full name */
+	// Only encode font size, because style (bold, italic, etc) is
+	// already part of the font full name
 	vim_snprintf((char *)styleString, FONT_STYLE_BUFFER_SIZE, ":h%d",
 		gFontPanelInfo.size/*,
 		((gFontPanelInfo.style & bold)!=0 ? ":b" : ""),
@@ -1463,23 +1463,22 @@ GetFontPanelSelection(char_u *outName)
  *
  *  Returns the index inside the menu where
  */
-    short /* Should we return MenuItemIndex? */
+    short // Should we return MenuItemIndex?
 gui_mac_get_menu_item_index(vimmenu_T *pMenu)
 {
     short	index;
     short	itemIndex = -1;
     vimmenu_T	*pBrother;
 
-    /* Only menu without parent are the:
-     * -menu in the menubar
-     * -popup menu
-     * -toolbar (guess)
-     *
-     * Which are not items anyway.
-     */
+    // Only menu without parent are the:
+    // -menu in the menubar
+    // -popup menu
+    // -toolbar (guess)
+    //
+    // Which are not items anyway.
     if (pMenu->parent)
     {
-	/* Start from the Oldest Brother */
+	// Start from the Oldest Brother
 	pBrother = pMenu->parent->children;
 	index = 1;
 	while ((pBrother) && (itemIndex == -1))
@@ -1501,13 +1500,12 @@ gui_mac_get_vim_menu(short menuID, short
     vimmenu_T	*pElder = pMenu->parent;
 
 
-    /* Only menu without parent are the:
-     * -menu in the menubar
-     * -popup menu
-     * -toolbar (guess)
-     *
-     * Which are not items anyway.
-     */
+    // Only menu without parent are the:
+    // -menu in the menubar
+    // -popup menu
+    // -toolbar (guess)
+    //
+    // Which are not items anyway.
 
     if ((pElder) && (pElder->submenu_id == menuID))
     {
@@ -1554,12 +1552,12 @@ gui_mac_drag_thumb(ControlHandle theCont
     if (sb == NULL)
 	return;
 
-    /* Need to find value by diff between Old Poss New Pos */
+    // Need to find value by diff between Old Poss New Pos
     value = GetControl32BitValue(theControlToUse);
     dragging = (partCode != 0);
 
-    /* When "allow_scrollbar" is FALSE still need to remember the new
-     * position, but don't actually scroll by setting "dont_scroll". */
+    // When "allow_scrollbar" is FALSE still need to remember the new
+    // position, but don't actually scroll by setting "dont_scroll".
     dont_scroll = !allow_scrollbar;
     gui_drag_scrollbar(sb, value, dragging);
     dont_scroll = dont_scroll_save;
@@ -1569,7 +1567,7 @@ gui_mac_drag_thumb(ControlHandle theCont
     void
 gui_mac_scroll_action(ControlHandle theControl, short partCode)
 {
-    /* TODO: have live support */
+    // TODO: have live support
     scrollbar_T *sb, *sb_info;
     long	data;
     long	value;
@@ -1582,7 +1580,7 @@ gui_mac_scroll_action(ControlHandle theC
     if (sb == NULL)
 	return;
 
-    if (sb->wp != NULL)		/* Left or right scrollbar */
+    if (sb->wp != NULL)		// Left or right scrollbar
     {
 	/*
 	 * Careful: need to get scrollbar info out of first (left) scrollbar
@@ -1592,11 +1590,11 @@ gui_mac_scroll_action(ControlHandle theC
 	sb_info = &sb->wp->w_scrollbars[0];
 
 	if (sb_info->size > 5)
-	    page = sb_info->size - 2;	/* use two lines of context */
+	    page = sb_info->size - 2;	// use two lines of context
 	else
 	    page = sb_info->size;
     }
-    else			/* Bottom scrollbar */
+    else			// Bottom scrollbar
     {
 	sb_info = sb;
 	page = curwin->w_width - 5;
@@ -1612,13 +1610,13 @@ gui_mac_scroll_action(ControlHandle theC
     }
 
     value = sb_info->value + data;
-/*  if (value > sb_info->max)
-	value = sb_info->max;
-    else if (value < 0)
-	value = 0;*/
-
-    /* When "allow_scrollbar" is FALSE still need to remember the new
-     * position, but don't actually scroll by setting "dont_scroll". */
+//  if (value > sb_info->max)
+//      value = sb_info->max;
+//  else if (value < 0)
+//	value = 0;
+
+    // When "allow_scrollbar" is FALSE still need to remember the new
+    // position, but don't actually scroll by setting "dont_scroll".
     dont_scroll = !allow_scrollbar;
     gui_drag_scrollbar(sb, value, dragging);
     dont_scroll = dont_scroll_save;
@@ -1626,7 +1624,8 @@ gui_mac_scroll_action(ControlHandle theC
     out_flush();
     gui_mch_set_scrollbar_thumb(sb, value, sb_info->size, sb_info->max);
 
-/*  if (sb_info->wp != NULL)
+#if 0
+    if (sb_info->wp != NULL)
     {
 	win_T	*wp;
 	int	sb_num;
@@ -1642,7 +1641,8 @@ gui_mac_scroll_action(ControlHandle theC
 	    gui_do_scroll();
 	    gui_mch_set_scrollbar_thumb(sb, value, sb_info->size, sb_info->max);
 	}
-    }*/
+    }
+#endif
 }
 
 /*
@@ -1676,7 +1676,7 @@ gui_mac_doInContentClick(EventRecord *th
 
     if (theControl != NUL)
     {
-	/* We hit a scrollbar */
+	// We hit a scrollbar
 
 	if (thePortion != kControlIndicatorPart)
 	{
@@ -1692,24 +1692,24 @@ gui_mac_doInContentClick(EventRecord *th
 #else
 	    TrackControl(theControl, thePoint, NULL);
 #endif
-	    /* pass 0 as the part to tell gui_mac_drag_thumb, that the mouse
-	     * button has been released */
-	    gui_mac_drag_thumb(theControl, 0); /* Should it be thePortion ? (Dany) */
+	    // pass 0 as the part to tell gui_mac_drag_thumb, that the mouse
+	    // button has been released
+	    gui_mac_drag_thumb(theControl, 0); // Should it be thePortion ? (Dany)
 	    dragged_sb = NULL;
 	}
     }
     else
     {
-	/* We are inside the contents */
-
-	/* Convert the CTRL, OPTION, SHIFT and CMD key */
+	// We are inside the contents
+
+	// Convert the CTRL, OPTION, SHIFT and CMD key
 	vimModifiers = EventModifiers2VimMouseModifiers(theEvent->modifiers);
 
-	/* Defaults to MOUSE_LEFT as there's only one mouse button */
+	// Defaults to MOUSE_LEFT as there's only one mouse button
 	vimMouseButton = MOUSE_LEFT;
 
-	/* Convert the CTRL_MOUSE_LEFT to MOUSE_RIGHT */
-	/* TODO: NEEDED? */
+	// Convert the CTRL_MOUSE_LEFT to MOUSE_RIGHT
+	// TODO: NEEDED?
 	clickIsPopup = FALSE;
 
 	if (mouse_model_popup() && IsShowContextualMenuClick(theEvent))
@@ -1719,20 +1719,18 @@ gui_mac_doInContentClick(EventRecord *th
 	    clickIsPopup = TRUE;
 	}
 
-	/* Is it a double click ? */
+	// Is it a double click ?
 	dblClick = ((theEvent->when - lastMouseTick) < GetDblTime());
 
-	/* Send the mouse click to Vim */
+	// Send the mouse click to Vim
 	gui_send_mouse_event(vimMouseButton, thePoint.h,
 					  thePoint.v, dblClick, vimModifiers);
 
-	/* Create the rectangle around the cursor to detect
-	 * the mouse dragging
-	 */
+	// Create the rectangle around the cursor to detect
+	// the mouse dragging
 #if 0
-	/* TODO: Do we need to this even for the contextual menu?
-	 * It may be require for popup_setpos, but for popup?
-	 */
+	// TODO: Do we need to this even for the contextual menu?
+	// It may be require for popup_setpos, but for popup?
 	if (vimMouseButton == MOUSE_LEFT)
 #endif
 	{
@@ -1756,7 +1754,7 @@ gui_mac_doInDragClick(Point where, Windo
     Rect	movingLimits;
     Rect	*movingLimitsPtr = &movingLimits;
 
-    /* TODO: may try to prevent move outside screen? */
+    // TODO: may try to prevent move outside screen?
     movingLimitsPtr = GetRegionBounds(GetGrayRgn(), &movingLimits);
     DragWindow(whichWindow, where, movingLimitsPtr);
 }
@@ -1777,8 +1775,8 @@ gui_mac_doInGrowClick(Point where, Windo
 
     resizeLimitsPtr = GetRegionBounds(GetGrayRgn(), &resizeLimits);
 
-    /* Set the minimum size */
-    /* TODO: Should this come from Vim? */
+    // Set the minimum size
+    // TODO: Should this come from Vim?
     resizeLimits.top = 100;
     resizeLimits.left = 100;
 
@@ -1800,13 +1798,13 @@ gui_mac_doInZoomClick(EventRecord *theEv
     Point	p;
     short	thePart;
 
-    /* ideal width is current */
+    // ideal width is current
     p.h = Columns * gui.char_width + 2 * gui.border_offset;
     if (gui.which_scrollbars[SBAR_LEFT])
 	p.h += gui.scrollbar_width;
     if (gui.which_scrollbars[SBAR_RIGHT])
 	p.h += gui.scrollbar_width;
-    /* ideal height is as high as we can get */
+    // ideal height is as high as we can get
     p.v = 15 * 1024;
 
     thePart = IsWindowInStandardState(whichWindow, &p, &r)
@@ -1815,9 +1813,9 @@ gui_mac_doInZoomClick(EventRecord *theEv
     if (!TrackBox(whichWindow, theEvent->where, thePart))
 	return;
 
-    /* use returned width */
+    // use returned width
     p.h = r.right - r.left;
-    /* adjust returned height */
+    // adjust returned height
     p.v = r.bottom - r.top - 2 * gui.border_offset;
     if (gui.which_scrollbars[SBAR_BOTTOM])
 	p.v -= gui.scrollbar_height;
@@ -1861,46 +1859,42 @@ gui_mac_doUpdateEvent(EventRecord *event
     if (updateRgn == NULL)
 	return;
 
-    /* This could be done by the caller as we
-     * don't require anything else out of the event
-     */
+    // This could be done by the caller as we
+    // don't require anything else out of the event
     whichWindow = (WindowPtr) event->message;
 
-    /* Save Current Port */
+    // Save Current Port
     GetPort(&savePort);
 
-    /* Select the Window's Port */
+    // Select the Window's Port
     SetPortWindowPort(whichWindow);
 
-    /* Let's update the window */
+    // Let's update the window
       BeginUpdate(whichWindow);
-	/* Redraw the biggest rectangle covering the area
-	 * to be updated.
-	 */
+	// Redraw the biggest rectangle covering the area
+	// to be updated.
 	GetPortVisibleRegion(GetWindowPort(whichWindow), updateRgn);
 # if 0
-	/* Would be more appropriate to use the following but doesn't
-	 * seem to work under MacOS X (Dany)
-	 */
+	// Would be more appropriate to use the following but doesn't
+	// seem to work under MacOS X (Dany)
 	GetWindowRegion(whichWindow, kWindowUpdateRgn, updateRgn);
 # endif
 
-	/* Use the HLock useless in Carbon? Is it harmful?*/
+	// Use the HLock useless in Carbon? Is it harmful?
 	HLock((Handle) updateRgn);
 
 	  updateRectPtr = GetRegionBounds(updateRgn, &updateRect);
 # if 0
-	  /* Code from original Carbon Port (using GetWindowRegion.
-	   * I believe the UpdateRgn is already in local (Dany)
-	   */
-	  GlobalToLocal(&topLeft(updateRect)); /* preCarbon? */
+	  // Code from original Carbon Port (using GetWindowRegion.
+	  // I believe the UpdateRgn is already in local (Dany)
+	  GlobalToLocal(&topLeft(updateRect)); // preCarbon?
 	  GlobalToLocal(&botRight(updateRect));
 # endif
-	  /* Update the content (i.e. the text) */
+	  // Update the content (i.e. the text)
 	  gui_redraw(updateRectPtr->left, updateRectPtr->top,
 		      updateRectPtr->right - updateRectPtr->left,
 		      updateRectPtr->bottom   - updateRectPtr->top);
-	  /* Clear the border areas if needed */
+	  // Clear the border areas if needed
 	  gui_mch_set_bg_color(gui.back_pixel);
 	  if (updateRectPtr->left < FILL_X(0))
 	  {
@@ -1927,11 +1921,11 @@ gui_mac_doUpdateEvent(EventRecord *event
 	HUnlock((Handle) updateRgn);
 	DisposeRgn(updateRgn);
 
-	/* Update scrollbars */
+	// Update scrollbars
 	DrawControls(whichWindow);
 
-	/* Update the GrowBox */
-	/* Taken from FAQ 33-27 */
+	// Update the GrowBox
+	// Taken from FAQ 33-27
 	saveRgn = NewRgn();
 	GetWindowBounds(whichWindow, kWindowGrowRgn, &growRect);
 	GetClip(saveRgn);
@@ -1941,7 +1935,7 @@ gui_mac_doUpdateEvent(EventRecord *event
 	DisposeRgn(saveRgn);
       EndUpdate(whichWindow);
 
-    /* Restore original Port */
+    // Restore original Port
     SetPort(savePort);
 }
 
@@ -1955,7 +1949,7 @@ gui_mac_doActivateEvent(EventRecord *eve
     WindowPtr	whichWindow;
 
     whichWindow = (WindowPtr) event->message;
-    /* Dim scrollbars */
+    // Dim scrollbars
     if (whichWindow == gui.VimWindow)
     {
 	ControlRef rootControl;
@@ -1966,7 +1960,7 @@ gui_mac_doActivateEvent(EventRecord *eve
 	    DeactivateControl(rootControl);
     }
 
-    /* Activate */
+    // Activate
     gui_focus_change((event->modifiers) & activeFlag);
 }
 
@@ -1978,20 +1972,18 @@ gui_mac_doActivateEvent(EventRecord *eve
     void
 gui_mac_doSuspendEvent(EventRecord *event)
 {
-    /* The frontmost application just changed */
-
-    /* NOTE: the suspend may happen before the deactivate
-     *       seen on MacOS X
-     */
-
-    /* May not need to change focus as the window will
-     * get an activate/deactivate event
-     */
+    // The frontmost application just changed
+
+    // NOTE: the suspend may happen before the deactivate
+    //       seen on MacOS X
+
+    // May not need to change focus as the window will
+    // get an activate/deactivate event
     if (event->message & 1)
-	/* Resume */
+	// Resume
 	gui_focus_change(TRUE);
     else
-	/* Suspend */
+	// Suspend
 	gui_focus_change(FALSE);
 }
 
@@ -2068,8 +2060,8 @@ OSStatus gui_mac_update_input_area(
     return eventNotHandledErr;
 }
 
-static int dialog_busy = FALSE;	    /* TRUE when gui_mch_dialog() wants the
-				       keys */
+static int dialog_busy = FALSE;	    // TRUE when gui_mch_dialog() wants the
+				    // keys
 
 # define INLINE_KEY_BUFFER_SIZE 80
     static pascal OSStatus
@@ -2077,7 +2069,7 @@ gui_mac_unicode_key_event(
 	EventHandlerCallRef nextHandler,
 	EventRef	    theEvent)
 {
-    /* Multibyte-friendly key event handler */
+    // Multibyte-friendly key event handler
     OSStatus	err = -1;
     UInt32	actualSize;
     UniChar	*text;
@@ -2093,11 +2085,11 @@ gui_mac_unicode_key_event(
     int		i;
     EventRef	keyEvent;
 
-    /* Mask the mouse (as per user setting) */
+    // Mask the mouse (as per user setting)
     if (p_mh)
 	ObscureCursor();
 
-    /* Don't use the keys when the dialog wants them. */
+    // Don't use the keys when the dialog wants them.
     if (dialog_busy)
 	return eventNotHandledErr;
 
@@ -2131,13 +2123,13 @@ gui_mac_unicode_key_event(
 
 #ifndef USE_CMD_KEY
     if (modifiers & cmdKey)
-	goto done;  /* Let system handle Cmd+... */
+	goto done;  // Let system handle Cmd+...
 #endif
 
     key_char = charcode;
     vimModifiers = EventModifiers2VimModifiers(modifiers);
 
-    /* Find the special key (eg., for cursor keys) */
+    // Find the special key (eg., for cursor keys)
     if (actualSize <= sizeof(UniChar) &&
 	    ((text[0] < 0x20) || (text[0] == 0x7f)))
     {
@@ -2153,30 +2145,30 @@ gui_mac_unicode_key_event(
 	    }
     }
 
-    /* Intercept CMD-. and CTRL-c */
+    // Intercept CMD-. and CTRL-c
     if (((modifiers & controlKey) && key_char == 'c') ||
 	    ((modifiers & cmdKey) && key_char == '.'))
 	got_int = TRUE;
 
     if (!isSpecial)
     {
-	/* remove SHIFT for keys that are already shifted, e.g.,
-	 * '(' and '*' */
+	// remove SHIFT for keys that are already shifted, e.g.,
+	// '(' and '*'
 	if (key_char < 0x100 && !isalpha(key_char) && isprint(key_char))
 	    vimModifiers &= ~MOD_MASK_SHIFT;
 
-	/* remove CTRL from keys that already have it */
+	// remove CTRL from keys that already have it
 	if (key_char < 0x20)
 	    vimModifiers &= ~MOD_MASK_CTRL;
 
-	/* don't process unicode characters here */
+	// don't process unicode characters here
 	if (!IS_SPECIAL(key_char))
 	{
-	    /* Following code to simplify and consolidate vimModifiers
-	     * taken liberally from gui_w48.c */
+	    // Following code to simplify and consolidate vimModifiers
+	    // taken liberally from gui_w48.c
 	    key_char = simplify_key(key_char, (int *)&vimModifiers);
 
-	    /* Interpret META, include SHIFT, etc. */
+	    // Interpret META, include SHIFT, etc.
 	    key_char = extract_modifiers(key_char, (int *)&vimModifiers,
 		    TRUE, NULL);
 	    if (key_char == CSI)
@@ -2206,7 +2198,7 @@ gui_mac_unicode_key_event(
 	to = mac_utf16_to_enc(text, actualSize, &encLen);
 	if (to)
 	{
-	    /* This is basically add_to_input_buf_csi() */
+	    // This is basically add_to_input_buf_csi()
 	    for (i = 0; i < encLen && len < (INLINE_KEY_BUFFER_SIZE-1); ++i)
 	    {
 		result[len++] = to[i];
@@ -2227,8 +2219,8 @@ done:
     vim_free(text);
     if (err == noErr)
     {
-	/* Fake event to wake up WNE (required to get
-	 * key repeat working */
+	// Fake event to wake up WNE (required to get
+	// key repeat working
 	PostEvent(keyUp, 0);
 	return noErr;
     }
@@ -2239,7 +2231,7 @@ done:
     void
 gui_mac_doKeyEvent(EventRecord *theEvent)
 {
-    /* TODO: add support for COMMAND KEY */
+    // TODO: add support for COMMAND KEY
     long		menu;
     unsigned char	string[20];
     short		num, i;
@@ -2249,16 +2241,16 @@ gui_mac_doKeyEvent(EventRecord *theEvent
     int			modifiers;
     int			simplify = FALSE;
 
-    /* Mask the mouse (as per user setting) */
+    // Mask the mouse (as per user setting)
     if (p_mh)
 	ObscureCursor();
 
-    /* Get the key code and its ASCII representation */
+    // Get the key code and its ASCII representation
     key_sym = ((theEvent->message & keyCodeMask) >> 8);
     key_char = theEvent->message & charCodeMask;
     num = 1;
 
-    /* Intercept CTRL-C */
+    // Intercept CTRL-C
     if (theEvent->modifiers & controlKey)
     {
 	if (key_char == Ctrl_C && ctrl_c_interrupts)
@@ -2266,7 +2258,7 @@ gui_mac_doKeyEvent(EventRecord *theEvent
 	else if ((theEvent->modifiers & ~(controlKey|shiftKey)) == 0
 		&& (key_char == '2' || key_char == '6'))
 	{
-	    /* CTRL-^ and CTRL-@ don't work in the normal way. */
+	    // CTRL-^ and CTRL-@ don't work in the normal way.
 	    if (key_char == '2')
 		key_char = Ctrl_AT;
 	    else
@@ -2275,16 +2267,16 @@ gui_mac_doKeyEvent(EventRecord *theEvent
 	}
     }
 
-    /* Intercept CMD-. */
+    // Intercept CMD-.
     if (theEvent->modifiers & cmdKey)
 	if (key_char == '.')
 	    got_int = TRUE;
 
-    /* Handle command key as per menu */
-    /* TODO: should override be allowed? Require YAO or could use 'winaltkey' */
+    // Handle command key as per menu
+    // TODO: should override be allowed? Require YAO or could use 'winaltkey'
     if (theEvent->modifiers & cmdKey)
-	/* Only accept CMD alone or with CAPLOCKS and the mouse button.
-	 * Why the mouse button? */
+	// Only accept CMD alone or with CAPLOCKS and the mouse button.
+	// Why the mouse button?
 	if ((theEvent->modifiers & (~(cmdKey | btnState | alphaLock))) == 0)
 	{
 	    menu = MenuKey(key_char);
@@ -2295,23 +2287,23 @@ gui_mac_doKeyEvent(EventRecord *theEvent
 	    }
 	}
 
-    /* Convert the modifiers */
+    // Convert the modifiers
     modifiers = EventModifiers2VimModifiers(theEvent->modifiers);
 
 
-    /* Handle special keys. */
+    // Handle special keys.
 #if 0
-    /* Why has this been removed? */
+    // Why has this been removed?
     if	(!(theEvent->modifiers & (cmdKey | controlKey | rightControlKey)))
 #endif
     {
-	/* Find the special key (for non-printable keyt_char) */
+	// Find the special key (for non-printable keyt_char)
 	if  ((key_char < 0x20) || (key_char == 0x7f))
 	    for (i = 0; special_keys[i].key_sym != (KeySym)0; i++)
 		if (special_keys[i].key_sym == key_sym)
 		{
 # if 0
-		    /* We currently don't have not so special key */
+		    // We currently don't have not so special key
 		    if (special_keys[i].vim_code1 == NUL)
 			key_char = special_keys[i].vim_code0;
 		    else
@@ -2323,12 +2315,12 @@ gui_mac_doKeyEvent(EventRecord *theEvent
 		}
     }
 
-    /* For some keys the modifier is included in the char itself. */
+    // For some keys the modifier is included in the char itself.
     if (simplify || key_char == TAB || key_char == ' ')
 	key_char = simplify_key(key_char, &modifiers);
 
-    /* Add the modifier to the input bu if needed */
-    /* Do not want SHIFT-A or CTRL-A with modifier */
+    // Add the modifier to the input bu if needed
+    // Do not want SHIFT-A or CTRL-A with modifier
     if (!IS_SPECIAL(key_char)
 	    && key_sym != vk_Space
 	    && key_sym != vk_Tab
@@ -2337,7 +2329,7 @@ gui_mac_doKeyEvent(EventRecord *theEvent
 	    && key_sym != vk_Esc)
     {
 #if 1
-    /* Clear modifiers when only one modifier is set */
+    // Clear modifiers when only one modifier is set
 	if ((modifiers == MOD_MASK_SHIFT)
 		|| (modifiers == MOD_MASK_CTRL)
 		|| (modifiers == MOD_MASK_ALT))
@@ -2366,8 +2358,8 @@ gui_mac_doKeyEvent(EventRecord *theEvent
 	}
 	else
 	{
-	    /* Convert characters when needed (e.g., from MacRoman to latin1).
-	     * This doesn't work for the NUL byte. */
+	    // Convert characters when needed (e.g., from MacRoman to latin1).
+	    // This doesn't work for the NUL byte.
 	    if (input_conv.vc_type != CONV_NONE && key_char > 0)
 	    {
 		char_u	from[2], *to;
@@ -2400,7 +2392,7 @@ gui_mac_doKeyEvent(EventRecord *theEvent
 
 	if (len == 1 && string[0] == CSI)
 	{
-	    /* Turn CSI into K_CSI. */
+	    // Turn CSI into K_CSI.
 	    string[ len++ ] = KS_EXTRA;
 	    string[ len++ ] = KE_CSI;
 	}
@@ -2421,8 +2413,8 @@ gui_mac_doMouseDownEvent(EventRecord *th
     thePart = FindWindow(theEvent->where, &whichWindow);
 
 #ifdef FEAT_GUI_TABLINE
-    /* prevent that the vim window size changes if it's activated by a
-       click into the tab pane */
+    // prevent that the vim window size changes if it's activated by a
+    // click into the tab pane
     if (whichWindow == drawer)
 	return;
 #endif
@@ -2430,7 +2422,7 @@ gui_mac_doMouseDownEvent(EventRecord *th
     switch (thePart)
     {
 	case (inDesk):
-	    /* TODO: what to do? */
+	    // TODO: what to do?
 	    break;
 
 	case (inMenuBar):
@@ -2482,7 +2474,7 @@ gui_mac_doMouseMovedEvent(EventRecord *e
 	    gui_send_mouse_event(MOUSE_DRAG, thePoint.h,
 					     thePoint.v, FALSE, vimModifiers);
 
-    /* Reset the region from which we move in and out */
+    // Reset the region from which we move in and out
     SetRect(&dragRect, FILL_X(X_2_COL(thePoint.h)),
 			FILL_Y(Y_2_ROW(thePoint.v)),
 			FILL_X(X_2_COL(thePoint.h)+1),
@@ -2502,8 +2494,8 @@ gui_mac_doMouseUpEvent(EventRecord *theE
     Point   thePoint;
     int_u   vimModifiers;
 
-    /* TODO: Properly convert the Contextual menu mouse-up */
-    /*       Potential source of the double menu */
+    // TODO: Properly convert the Contextual menu mouse-up
+    //       Potential source of the double menu
     lastMouseTick = theEvent->when;
     dragRectEnbl = FALSE;
     dragRectControl = kCreateEmpty;
@@ -2533,7 +2525,7 @@ gui_mac_mouse_wheel(EventHandlerCallRef 
     if (noErr == GetEventParameter(theEvent, kEventParamMouseWheelAxis,
 			  typeMouseWheelAxis, NULL, sizeof(axis), NULL, &axis)
 	    && axis != kEventMouseWheelAxisY)
-	goto bail; /* Vim only does up-down scrolling */
+	goto bail; // Vim only does up-down scrolling
 
     if (noErr != GetEventParameter(theEvent, kEventParamMouseWheelDelta,
 			      typeSInt32, NULL, sizeof(SInt32), NULL, &delta))
@@ -2562,7 +2554,7 @@ gui_mac_mouse_wheel(EventHandlerCallRef 
     gui_send_mouse_event((delta > 0) ? MOUSE_4 : MOUSE_5,
 					    point.h, point.v, FALSE, vim_mod);
 
-    /* post a bogus event to wake up WaitNextEvent */
+    // post a bogus event to wake up WaitNextEvent
     PostEvent(keyUp, 0);
 
     return noErr;
@@ -2578,7 +2570,7 @@ bail:
      void
 gui_mch_mousehide(int hide)
 {
-    /* TODO */
+    // TODO
 }
 
 #if 0
@@ -2605,14 +2597,14 @@ gui_mac_handle_contextual_menu(EventReco
 
     if (CntxType == kCMMenuItemSelected)
     {
-	/* Handle the menu CntxMenuID, CntxMenuItem */
-	/* The submenu can be handle directly by gui_mac_handle_menu */
-	/* But what about the current menu, is the many changed by ContextualMenuSelect */
+	// Handle the menu CntxMenuID, CntxMenuItem
+	// The submenu can be handle directly by gui_mac_handle_menu
+	// But what about the current menu, is the many changed by ContextualMenuSelect
 	gui_mac_handle_menu((CntxMenuID << 16) + CntxMenuItem);
     }
     else if (CntxMenuID == kCMShowHelpSelected)
     {
-	/* Should come up with the help */
+	// Should come up with the help
     }
 
 }
@@ -2628,10 +2620,10 @@ gui_mac_handle_menu(long menuChoice)
     short	item = LoWord(menuChoice);
     vimmenu_T	*theVimMenu = root_menu;
 
-    if (menu == 256)  /* TODO: use constant or gui.xyz */
+    if (menu == 256)  // TODO: use constant or gui.xyz
     {
 	if (item == 1)
-	    gui_mch_beep(); /* TODO: Popup dialog or do :intro */
+	    gui_mch_beep(); // TODO: Popup dialog or do :intro
     }
     else if (item != 0)
     {
@@ -2652,7 +2644,7 @@ gui_mac_handle_event(EventRecord *event)
 {
     OSErr	error;
 
-    /* Handle contextual menu right now (if needed) */
+    // Handle contextual menu right now (if needed)
     if (IsShowContextualMenuClick(event))
     {
 # if 0
@@ -2663,7 +2655,7 @@ gui_mac_handle_event(EventRecord *event)
 	return;
     }
 
-    /* Handle normal event */
+    // Handle normal event
     switch (event->what)
     {
 #ifndef USE_CARBONKEYHANDLER
@@ -2673,7 +2665,7 @@ gui_mac_handle_event(EventRecord *event)
 	    break;
 #endif
 	case (keyUp):
-	    /* We don't care about when the key is released */
+	    // We don't care about when the key is released
 	    break;
 
 	case (mouseDown):
@@ -2689,7 +2681,7 @@ gui_mac_handle_event(EventRecord *event)
 	    break;
 
 	case (diskEvt):
-	    /* We don't need special handling for disk insertion */
+	    // We don't need special handling for disk insertion
 	    break;
 
 	case (activateEvt):
@@ -2699,10 +2691,10 @@ gui_mac_handle_event(EventRecord *event)
 	case (osEvt):
 	    switch ((event->message >> 24) & 0xFF)
 	    {
-		case (0xFA): /* mouseMovedMessage */
+		case (0xFA): // mouseMovedMessage
 		    gui_mac_doMouseMovedEvent(event);
 		    break;
-		case (0x01): /* suspendResumeMessage */
+		case (0x01): // suspendResumeMessage
 		    gui_mac_doSuspendEvent(event);
 		    break;
 	    }
@@ -2710,8 +2702,8 @@ gui_mac_handle_event(EventRecord *event)
 
 #ifdef USE_AEVENT
 	case (kHighLevelEvent):
-	    /* Someone's talking to us, through AppleEvents */
-	    error = AEProcessAppleEvent(event); /* TODO: Error Handling */
+	    // Someone's talking to us, through AppleEvents
+	    error = AEProcessAppleEvent(event); // TODO: Error Handling
 	    break;
 #endif
     }
@@ -2749,7 +2741,7 @@ gui_mac_find_font(char_u *font_name)
     pFontName[0] = STRLEN(font_name);
     *p = c;
 
-    /* Get the font name, minus the style suffix (:h, etc) */
+    // Get the font name, minus the style suffix (:h, etc)
     char_u fontName[256];
     char_u *styleStart = vim_strchr(font_name, ':');
     size_t fontNameLen = styleStart ? styleStart - font_name : STRLEN(fontName);
@@ -2795,7 +2787,7 @@ gui_mac_find_font(char_u *font_name)
     }
 
 #else
-    /* name = C2Pascal_save(menu->dname); */
+    // name = C2Pascal_save(menu->dname);
     fontNamePtr = C2Pascal_save_and_remove_backslash(font_name);
 
     GetFNum(fontNamePtr, &font_id);
@@ -2804,7 +2796,7 @@ gui_mac_find_font(char_u *font_name)
 
     if (font_id == 0)
     {
-	/* Oups, the system font was it the one the user want */
+	// Oups, the system font was it the one the user want
 
 	if (FMGetFontFamilyName(systemFont, systemFontname) != noErr)
 	    return NOFONT;
@@ -2814,7 +2806,7 @@ gui_mac_find_font(char_u *font_name)
     if (*p == ':')
     {
 	p++;
-	/* Set the values found after ':' */
+	// Set the values found after ':'
 	while (*p)
 	{
 	    switch (*p++)
@@ -2832,7 +2824,7 @@ gui_mac_find_font(char_u *font_name)
     }
 
     if (size < 1)
-	size = 1;   /* Avoid having a size of 0 with system font */
+	size = 1;   // Avoid having a size of 0 with system font
 
     font = (size << 16) + ((long) font_id & 0xFFFF);
 
@@ -2853,7 +2845,7 @@ gui_mac_find_font(char_u *font_name)
     void
 gui_mch_prepare(int *argc, char **argv)
 {
-    /* TODO: Move most of this stuff toward gui_mch_init */
+    // TODO: Move most of this stuff toward gui_mch_init
 #ifdef USE_EXE_NAME
     FSSpec	applDir;
 # ifndef USE_FIND_BUNDLE_PATH
@@ -2875,7 +2867,7 @@ gui_mch_prepare(int *argc, char **argv)
     (void) InstallAEHandlers();
 #endif
 
-    pomme = NewMenu(256, "\p\024"); /* 0x14= = Apple Menu */
+    pomme = NewMenu(256, "\p\024"); // 0x14= = Apple Menu
 
     AppendMenu(pomme, "\pAbout VIM");
 
@@ -2901,7 +2893,7 @@ gui_mch_prepare(int *argc, char **argv)
     gui.char_ascent = 6;
     gui.num_rows = 24;
     gui.num_cols = 80;
-    gui.in_focus = TRUE; /* For the moment -> syn. of front application */
+    gui.in_focus = TRUE; // For the moment -> syn. of front application
 
     gScrollAction = NewControlActionUPP(gui_mac_scroll_action);
     gScrollDrag   = NewControlActionUPP(gui_mac_drag_thumb);
@@ -2914,21 +2906,20 @@ gui_mch_prepare(int *argc, char **argv)
 #ifdef USE_EXE_NAME
 # ifndef USE_FIND_BUNDLE_PATH
     HGetVol(volName, &applVRefNum, &applDirID);
-    /* TN2015: mention a possible bad VRefNum */
+    // TN2015: mention a possible bad VRefNum
     FSMakeFSSpec(applVRefNum, applDirID, "\p", &applDir);
 # else
-    /* OSErr GetApplicationBundleFSSpec(FSSpecPtr theFSSpecPtr)
-     * of TN2015
-     */
+    // OSErr GetApplicationBundleFSSpec(FSSpecPtr theFSSpecPtr)
+    // of TN2015
     (void)GetCurrentProcess(&psn);
-    /* if (err != noErr) return err; */
+    // if (err != noErr) return err;
 
     (void)GetProcessBundleLocation(&psn, &applFSRef);
-    /* if (err != noErr) return err; */
+    // if (err != noErr) return err;
 
     (void)FSGetCatalogInfo(&applFSRef, kFSCatInfoNone, NULL, NULL, &applDir, NULL);
 
-    /* This technic return NIL when we disallow_gui */
+    // This technic return NIL when we disallow_gui
 # endif
     exe_name = FullPathFromFSSpec_save(applDir);
 #endif
@@ -2942,10 +2933,9 @@ gui_mch_prepare(int *argc, char **argv)
     int
 gui_mch_init_check(void)
 {
-    /* TODO: For MacOS X find a way to return FAIL, if the user logged in
-     * using the >console
-     */
-    if (disallow_gui) /* see main.c for reason to disallow */
+    // TODO: For MacOS X find a way to return FAIL, if the user logged in
+    // using the >console
+    if (disallow_gui) // see main.c for reason to disallow
 	return FAIL;
     return OK;
 }
@@ -2960,7 +2950,7 @@ receiveHandler(WindowRef theWindow, void
     int		count;
     int		i, j;
 
-    /* Get drop position, modifiers and count of items */
+    // Get drop position, modifiers and count of items
     {
 	Point	point;
 	SInt16	mouseUpModifiers;
@@ -2980,7 +2970,7 @@ receiveHandler(WindowRef theWindow, void
     if (fnames == NULL)
 	return dragNotAcceptedErr;
 
-    /* Get file names dropped */
+    // Get file names dropped
     for (i = j = 0; i < count; ++i)
     {
 	DragItemRef	item;
@@ -3003,7 +2993,7 @@ receiveHandler(WindowRef theWindow, void
 
     gui_handle_drop(x, y, modifiers, fnames, count);
 
-    /* Fake mouse event to wake from stall */
+    // Fake mouse event to wake from stall
     PostEvent(mouseUp, 0);
 
     return noErr;
@@ -3016,7 +3006,7 @@ receiveHandler(WindowRef theWindow, void
     int
 gui_mch_init(void)
 {
-    /* TODO: Move most of this stuff toward gui_mch_init */
+    // TODO: Move most of this stuff toward gui_mch_init
     Rect	    windRect;
     MenuHandle	    pomme;
     EventHandlerRef mouseWheelHandlerRef;
@@ -3024,7 +3014,7 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
     ControlRef	    rootControl;
 
     if (Gestalt(gestaltSystemVersion, &gMacSystemVersion) != noErr)
-	gMacSystemVersion = 0x1000; /* TODO: Default to minimum sensible value */
+	gMacSystemVersion = 0x1000; // TODO: Default to minimum sensible value
 
 #if 1
     InitCursor();
@@ -3035,7 +3025,7 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
     (void) InstallAEHandlers();
 #endif
 
-    pomme = NewMenu(256, "\p\024"); /* 0x14= = Apple Menu */
+    pomme = NewMenu(256, "\p\024"); // 0x14= = Apple Menu
 
     AppendMenu(pomme, "\pAbout VIM");
 
@@ -3063,12 +3053,12 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
     gui.char_ascent = 6;
     gui.num_rows = 24;
     gui.num_cols = 80;
-    gui.in_focus = TRUE; /* For the moment -> syn. of front application */
+    gui.in_focus = TRUE; // For the moment -> syn. of front application
 
     gScrollAction = NewControlActionUPP(gui_mac_scroll_action);
     gScrollDrag   = NewControlActionUPP(gui_mac_drag_thumb);
 
-    /* Install Carbon event callbacks. */
+    // Install Carbon event callbacks.
     (void)InstallFontPanelHandler();
 
     dragRectEnbl = FALSE;
@@ -3076,16 +3066,16 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
     dragRectControl = kCreateEmpty;
     cursorRgn = NewRgn();
 #endif
-    /* Display any pending error messages */
+    // Display any pending error messages
     display_errors();
 
-    /* Get background/foreground colors from system */
-    /* TODO: do the appropriate call to get real defaults */
+    // Get background/foreground colors from system
+    // TODO: do the appropriate call to get real defaults
     gui.norm_pixel = 0x00000000;
     gui.back_pixel = 0x00FFFFFF;
 
-    /* Get the colors from the "Normal" group (set in syntax.c or in a vimrc
-     * file). */
+    // Get the colors from the "Normal" group (set in syntax.c or in a vimrc
+    // file).
     set_normal_colors();
 
     /*
@@ -3096,8 +3086,8 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
     gui.def_norm_pixel = gui.norm_pixel;
     gui.def_back_pixel = gui.back_pixel;
 
-    /* Get the colors for the highlight groups (gui_check_colors() might have
-     * changed them) */
+    // Get the colors for the highlight groups (gui_check_colors() might have
+    // changed them)
     highlight_gui_started();
 
     /*
@@ -3106,11 +3096,11 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
 #ifdef FEAT_MENU
     gui.menu_height = 0;
 #endif
-    gui.scrollbar_height = gui.scrollbar_width = 15; /* cheat 1 overlap */
+    gui.scrollbar_height = gui.scrollbar_width = 15; // cheat 1 overlap
     gui.border_offset = gui.border_width = 2;
 
-    /* If Quartz-style text anti aliasing is available (see
-       gui_mch_draw_string() below), enable it for all font sizes. */
+    // If Quartz-style text anti aliasing is available (see
+    // gui_mch_draw_string() below), enable it for all font sizes.
     vim_setenv((char_u *)"QDTEXT_MINSIZE", (char_u *)"1");
 
     eventTypeSpec.eventClass = kEventClassMouse;
@@ -3128,10 +3118,10 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
     InterfaceTypeList supportedServices = { kUnicodeDocument };
     NewTSMDocument(1, supportedServices, &gTSMDocument, 0);
 
-    /* We don't support inline input yet, use input window by default */
+    // We don't support inline input yet, use input window by default
     UseInputWindow(gTSMDocument, TRUE);
 
-    /* Should we activate the document by default? */
+    // Should we activate the document by default?
     // ActivateTSMDocument(gTSMDocument);
 
     EventTypeSpec textEventTypes[] = {
@@ -3155,8 +3145,8 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
 	{ kEventClassWindow, kEventWindowDeactivated },
     };
 
-    /* Install window event handler to support TSMDocument activate and
-     * deactivate */
+    // Install window event handler to support TSMDocument activate and
+    // deactivate
     winEventHandlerUPP = NewEventHandlerUPP(gui_mac_handle_window_activate);
     if (noErr != InstallWindowEventHandler(gui.VimWindow,
 					   winEventHandlerUPP,
@@ -3175,7 +3165,7 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
     initialise_tabline();
 #endif
 
-    /* TODO: Load bitmap if using TOOLBAR */
+    // TODO: Load bitmap if using TOOLBAR
     return OK;
 }
 
@@ -3185,10 +3175,9 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
     void
 gui_mch_new_colors(void)
 {
-    /* TODO:
-     * This proc is called when Normal is set to a value
-     * so what must be done? I don't know
-     */
+    // TODO:
+    // This proc is called when Normal is set to a value
+    // so what must be done? I don't know
 }
 
 /*
@@ -3229,7 +3218,7 @@ gui_mac_dispose_atsui_style(void)
     void
 gui_mch_exit(int rc)
 {
-    /* TODO: find out all what is missing here? */
+    // TODO: find out all what is missing here?
     DisposeRgn(cursorRgn);
 
 #ifdef USE_CARBONKEYHANDLER
@@ -3250,7 +3239,7 @@ gui_mch_exit(int rc)
     DeleteTSMDocument(gTSMDocument);
 #endif
 
-    /* Exit to shell? */
+    // Exit to shell?
     exit(rc);
 }
 
@@ -3260,11 +3249,11 @@ gui_mch_exit(int rc)
     int
 gui_mch_get_winpos(int *x, int *y)
 {
-    /* TODO */
+    // TODO
     Rect	bounds;
     OSStatus	status;
 
-    /* Carbon >= 1.0.2, MacOS >= 8.5 */
+    // Carbon >= 1.0.2, MacOS >= 8.5
     status = GetWindowBounds(gui.VimWindow, kWindowStructureRgn, &bounds);
 
     if (status != noErr)
@@ -3281,9 +3270,8 @@ gui_mch_get_winpos(int *x, int *y)
     void
 gui_mch_set_winpos(int x, int y)
 {
-    /* TODO:  Should make sure the window is move within range
-     *	      e.g.: y > ~16 [Menu bar], x > 0, x < screen width
-     */
+    // TODO:  Should make sure the window is move within range
+    //	      e.g.: y > ~16 [Menu bar], x > 0, x < screen width
     MoveWindowStructure(gui.VimWindow, x, y);
 }
 
@@ -3304,9 +3292,9 @@ gui_mch_set_shellsize(
     {
 	VimPort = GetWindowPort(gui.VimWindow);
 	GetPortBounds(VimPort, &VimBound);
-	VimBound.left = -gui.scrollbar_width; /* + 1;*/
+	VimBound.left = -gui.scrollbar_width; // + 1;
 	SetPortBounds(VimPort, &VimBound);
-    /*	GetWindowBounds(gui.VimWindow, kWindowGlobalPortRgn, &winPortRect); ??*/
+    //	GetWindowBounds(gui.VimWindow, kWindowGlobalPortRgn, &winPortRect); ??
     }
     else
     {
@@ -3351,13 +3339,13 @@ gui_mac_select_font(char_u *font_name)
     OSStatus		    status;
     FontSelectionQDStyle    curr_font;
 
-    /* Initialize the Font Panel with the current font. */
+    // Initialize the Font Panel with the current font.
     curr_font.instance.fontFamily = gui.norm_font & 0xFFFF;
     curr_font.size = (gui.norm_font >> 16);
-    /* TODO: set fontStyle once styles are supported in gui_mac_find_font() */
+    // TODO: set fontStyle once styles are supported in gui_mac_find_font()
     curr_font.instance.fontStyle = 0;
     curr_font.hasColor = false;
-    curr_font.version = 0; /* version number of the style structure */
+    curr_font.version = 0; // version number of the style structure
     status = SetFontInfoForSelection(kFontSelectionQDType,
 	    /*numStyles=*/1, &curr_font, /*eventTarget=*/NULL);
 
@@ -3365,7 +3353,7 @@ gui_mac_select_font(char_u *font_name)
     gFontPanelInfo.style = curr_font.instance.fontStyle;
     gFontPanelInfo.size = curr_font.size;
 
-    /* Pop up the Font Panel. */
+    // Pop up the Font Panel.
     status = FPShowHideFontPanel();
     if (status == noErr)
     {
@@ -3412,7 +3400,7 @@ gui_mac_create_atsui_style(void)
     int
 gui_mch_init_font(char_u *font_name, int fontset)
 {
-    /* TODO: Add support for bold italic underline proportional etc... */
+    // TODO: Add support for bold italic underline proportional etc...
     Str255	suggestedFont = "\pMonaco";
     int		suggestedSize = 10;
     FontInfo	font_info;
@@ -3426,12 +3414,12 @@ gui_mch_init_font(char_u *font_name, int
 
     if (font_name == NULL)
     {
-	/* First try to get the suggested font */
+	// First try to get the suggested font
 	GetFNum(suggestedFont, &font_id);
 
 	if (font_id == 0)
 	{
-	    /* Then pickup the standard application font */
+	    // Then pickup the standard application font
 	    font_id = GetAppFont();
 	    STRCPY(used_font_name, "default");
 	}
@@ -3447,14 +3435,14 @@ gui_mch_init_font(char_u *font_name, int
 	if (font == NOFONT)
 	    return FAIL;
 
-	/* Set guifont to the name of the selected font. */
+	// Set guifont to the name of the selected font.
 	new_p_guifont = alloc(STRLEN(used_font_name) + 1);
 	if (new_p_guifont != NULL)
 	{
 	    STRCPY(new_p_guifont, used_font_name);
 	    vim_free(p_guifont);
 	    p_guifont = new_p_guifont;
-	    /* Replace spaces in the font name with underscores. */
+	    // Replace spaces in the font name with underscores.
 	    for ( ; *new_p_guifont; ++new_p_guifont)
 	    {
 		if (*new_p_guifont == ' ')
@@ -3587,8 +3575,8 @@ gui_mac_set_font_attributes(GuiFont font
 
 	if (has_mbyte)
 	{
-	    /* FIXME: we should use a more mbyte sensitive way to support
-	     * wide font drawing */
+	    // FIXME: we should use a more mbyte sensitive way to support
+	    // wide font drawing
 	    fontWidth = Long2Fix(gui.char_width * 2);
 
 	    if (ATSUSetAttributes(gWideFontStyle,
@@ -3615,7 +3603,7 @@ gui_mch_set_font(GuiFont font)
 
     if (p_macatsui && gFontStyle)
     {
-	/* Avoid setting same font again */
+	// Avoid setting same font again
 	if (ATSUGetAttribute(gFontStyle, kATSUMaxATSUITagValue + 1,
 		    sizeof(font), &currFont, &actualFontByteCount) == noErr
 		&& actualFontByteCount == (sizeof font))
@@ -3629,14 +3617,14 @@ gui_mch_set_font(GuiFont font)
 
     if (p_macatsui && !gIsFontFallbackSet)
     {
-	/* Setup automatic font substitution. The user's guifontwide
-	 * is tried first, then the system tries other fonts. */
-/*
+	// Setup automatic font substitution. The user's guifontwide
+	// is tried first, then the system tries other fonts.
+#if 0
 	ATSUAttributeTag fallbackTags[] = { kATSULineFontFallbacksTag };
 	ByteCount fallbackSizes[] = { sizeof(ATSUFontFallbacks) };
 	ATSUCreateFontFallbacks(&gFontFallbacks);
 	ATSUSetObjFontFallbacks(gFontFallbacks, );
-*/
+#endif
 	if (gui.wide_font)
 	{
 	    ATSUFontID fallbackFonts;
@@ -3652,9 +3640,7 @@ gui_mch_set_font(GuiFont font)
 				     &fallbackFonts,
 				     kATSUSequentialFallbacksPreferred);
 	    }
-/*
-	ATSUAttributeValuePtr fallbackValues[] = { };
-*/
+//	ATSUAttributeValuePtr fallbackValues[] = { };
 	}
     }
 #endif
@@ -3684,8 +3670,7 @@ gui_mch_free_font(GuiFont font)
     guicolor_T
 gui_mch_get_color(char_u *name)
 {
-    /* TODO: Add support for the new named color of MacOS 8
-     */
+    // TODO: Add support for the new named color of MacOS 8
     RGBColor	MacColor;
 
     if (STRICMP(name, "hilite") == 0)
@@ -3786,7 +3771,7 @@ draw_string_QD(int row, int col, char_u 
      */
     if (gMacSystemVersion >= 0x1020)
     {
-	/* Quartz antialiasing is available only in OS 10.2 and later. */
+	// Quartz antialiasing is available only in OS 10.2 and later.
 	UInt32 qd_flags = (p_antialias ?
 			     kQDUseCGTextRendering | kQDUseCGTextMetrics : 0);
 	QDSwapTextFlags(qd_flags);
@@ -3808,10 +3793,10 @@ draw_string_QD(int row, int col, char_u 
 
 	rc.left = FILL_X(col);
 	rc.top = FILL_Y(row);
-	/* Multibyte computation taken from gui_w32.c */
+	// Multibyte computation taken from gui_w32.c
 	if (has_mbyte)
 	{
-	    /* Compute the length in display cells. */
+	    // Compute the length in display cells.
 	    rc.right = FILL_X(col + mb_string2cells(s, len));
 	}
 	else
@@ -3831,7 +3816,7 @@ draw_string_QD(int row, int col, char_u 
 	    face |= underline;
 	TextFace(face);
 
-	/* Quartz antialiasing works only in srcOr transfer mode. */
+	// Quartz antialiasing works only in srcOr transfer mode.
 	TextMode(srcOr);
 
 	MoveTo(TEXT_X(col), TEXT_Y(row));
@@ -3839,11 +3824,11 @@ draw_string_QD(int row, int col, char_u 
     }
     else
     {
-	/* Use old-style, non-antialiased QuickDraw text rendering. */
+	// Use old-style, non-antialiased QuickDraw text rendering.
 	TextMode(srcCopy);
 	TextFace(normal);
 
-    /*  SelectFont(hdc, gui.currFont); */
+    //  SelectFont(hdc, gui.currFont);
 
 	if (flags & DRAW_TRANSP)
 	    TextMode(srcOr);
@@ -3881,13 +3866,13 @@ draw_string_QD(int row, int col, char_u 
     static void
 draw_string_ATSUI(int row, int col, char_u *s, int len, int flags)
 {
-    /* ATSUI requires utf-16 strings */
+    // ATSUI requires utf-16 strings
     UniCharCount utf16_len;
     UniChar *tofree = mac_enc_to_utf16(s, len, (size_t *)&utf16_len);
     utf16_len /= sizeof(UniChar);
 
-    /* - ATSUI automatically antialiases text (Someone)
-     * - for some reason it does not work... (Jussi) */
+    // - ATSUI automatically antialiases text (Someone)
+    // - for some reason it does not work... (Jussi)
 #ifdef MAC_ATSUI_DEBUG
     fprintf(stderr, "row = %d, col = %d, len = %d: '%c'\n",
 	    row, col, len, len == 1 ? s[0] : ' ');
@@ -3907,10 +3892,10 @@ draw_string_ATSUI(int row, int col, char
 
 	rc.left = FILL_X(col);
 	rc.top = FILL_Y(row);
-	/* Multibyte computation taken from gui_w32.c */
+	// Multibyte computation taken from gui_w32.c
 	if (has_mbyte)
 	{
-	    /* Compute the length in display cells. */
+	    // Compute the length in display cells.
 	    rc.right = FILL_X(col + mb_string2cells(s, len));
 	}
 	else
@@ -3924,7 +3909,7 @@ draw_string_ATSUI(int row, int col, char
 	TextMode(srcCopy);
 	TextFace(normal);
 
-	/*  SelectFont(hdc, gui.currFont); */
+	//  SelectFont(hdc, gui.currFont);
 	if (flags & DRAW_TRANSP)
 	    TextMode(srcOr);
 
@@ -3975,14 +3960,14 @@ draw_string_ATSUI(int row, int col, char
 	       ATSUSetRunStyle(textLayout, gFontStyle,
 	       kATSUFromTextBeginning, kATSUToTextEnd); */
 
-	    /* Compute the length in display cells. */
+	    // Compute the length in display cells.
 	    for (n = 0; n < len; n += MB_BYTE2LEN(s[n]))
 	    {
 		width_in_cell = (*mb_ptr2cells)(s + n);
 
-		/* probably we are switching from single byte character
-		 * to multibyte characters (which requires more than one
-		 * cell to draw) */
+		// probably we are switching from single byte character
+		// to multibyte characters (which requires more than one
+		// cell to draw)
 		if (width_in_cell != last_width_in_cell)
 		{
 #ifdef MAC_ATSUI_DEBUG
@@ -4007,7 +3992,7 @@ draw_string_ATSUI(int row, int col, char
 		fprintf(stderr, "\tn = %2d, (%d-%d), offset = %d, yet_to_draw = %d\n",
 			n, last_width_in_cell, width_in_cell, offset, yet_to_draw);
 #endif
-		/* finish the rest style */
+		// finish the rest style
 		textStyle = width_in_cell > 1 ? gWideFontStyle : gFontStyle;
 		ATSUSetRunStyle(textLayout, textStyle, offset, kATSUToTextEnd);
 	    }
@@ -4039,7 +4024,7 @@ draw_string_ATSUI(int row, int col, char
 	    }
 	}
 
-	/* drawing is done, now reset bold to normal */
+	// drawing is done, now reset bold to normal
 	if (gFontStyle && flags & DRAW_BOLD)
 	{
 	    Boolean attValue = false;
@@ -4065,10 +4050,10 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(int row, int col, ch
 {
 #if defined(USE_ATSUI_DRAWING)
     if (p_macatsui == 0 && p_macatsui_last != 0)
-	/* switch from macatsui to nomacatsui */
+	// switch from macatsui to nomacatsui
 	gui_mac_dispose_atsui_style();
     else if (p_macatsui != 0 && p_macatsui_last == 0)
-	/* switch from nomacatsui to macatsui */
+	// switch from nomacatsui to macatsui
 	gui_mac_create_atsui_style();
 
     if (p_macatsui)
@@ -4096,13 +4081,13 @@ gui_mch_haskey(char_u *name)
     void
 gui_mch_beep(void)
 {
-    SysBeep(1); /* Should this be 0? (????) */
+    SysBeep(1); // Should this be 0? (????)
 }
 
     void
 gui_mch_flash(int msec)
 {
-    /* Do a visual beep by reversing the foreground and background colors */
+    // Do a visual beep by reversing the foreground and background colors
     Rect    rc;
 
     /*
@@ -4114,7 +4099,7 @@ gui_mch_flash(int msec)
     rc.bottom = gui.num_rows * gui.char_height;
     InvertRect(&rc);
 
-    ui_delay((long)msec, TRUE);		/* wait for some msec */
+    ui_delay((long)msec, TRUE);		// wait for some msec
 
     InvertRect(&rc);
 }
@@ -4143,10 +4128,9 @@ gui_mch_invert_rectangle(int r, int c, i
     void
 gui_mch_iconify(void)
 {
-    /* TODO: find out what could replace iconify
-     *	     -window shade?
-     *	     -hide application?
-     */
+    // TODO: find out what could replace iconify
+    //	     -window shade?
+    //	     -hide application?
 }
 
 #if defined(FEAT_EVAL) || defined(PROTO)
@@ -4156,7 +4140,7 @@ gui_mch_iconify(void)
     void
 gui_mch_set_foreground(void)
 {
-    /* TODO */
+    // TODO
 }
 #endif
 
@@ -4192,7 +4176,7 @@ gui_mch_draw_part_cursor(int w, int h, g
     Rect rc;
 
 #ifdef FEAT_RIGHTLEFT
-    /* vertical line should be on the right of current point */
+    // vertical line should be on the right of current point
     if (CURSOR_BAR_RIGHT)
 	rc.left = FILL_X(gui.col + 1) - w;
     else
@@ -4219,14 +4203,13 @@ gui_mch_draw_part_cursor(int w, int h, g
     void
 gui_mch_update(void)
 {
-    /* TODO: find what to do
-     *	     maybe call gui_mch_wait_for_chars (0)
-     *	     more like look at EventQueue then
-     *	     call heart of gui_mch_wait_for_chars;
-     *
-     *	if (eventther)
-     *	    gui_mac_handle_event(&event);
-     */
+    // TODO: find what to do
+    //	     maybe call gui_mch_wait_for_chars (0)
+    //	     more like look at EventQueue then
+    //	     call heart of gui_mch_wait_for_chars;
+    //
+    //	if (eventther)
+    //	    gui_mac_handle_event(&event);
     EventRecord theEvent;
 
     if (EventAvail(everyEvent, &theEvent))
@@ -4266,13 +4249,12 @@ gui_mch_wait_for_chars(int wtime)
     long	currentTick;
     long	sleeppyTick;
 
-    /* If we are providing life feedback with the scrollbar,
-     * we don't want to try to wait for an event, or else
-     * there won't be any life feedback.
-     */
+    // If we are providing life feedback with the scrollbar,
+    // we don't want to try to wait for an event, or else
+    // there won't be any life feedback.
     if (dragged_sb != NULL)
 	return FAIL;
-	/* TODO: Check if FAIL is the proper return code */
+	// TODO: Check if FAIL is the proper return code
 
     entryTick = TickCount();
 
@@ -4280,12 +4262,15 @@ gui_mch_wait_for_chars(int wtime)
 
     do
     {
-/*	if (dragRectControl == kCreateEmpty)
+#if 0
+	if (dragRectControl == kCreateEmpty)
 	{
 	    dragRgn = NULL;
 	    dragRectControl = kNothing;
 	}
-	else*/ if (dragRectControl == kCreateRect)
+	else
+#endif
+	if (dragRectControl == kCreateRect)
 	{
 	    dragRgn = cursorRgn;
 	    RectRgn(dragRgn, &dragRect);
@@ -4297,7 +4282,7 @@ gui_mch_wait_for_chars(int wtime)
 	 * event arrives.  No need to check for input_buf_full because we are
 	 * returning as soon as it contains a single char.
 	 */
-	/* TODO: reduce wtime accordingly???  */
+	// TODO: reduce wtime accordingly???
 	if (wtime > -1)
 	    sleeppyTick = 60 * wtime / 1000;
 	else
@@ -4324,11 +4309,13 @@ gui_mch_wait_for_chars(int wtime)
  * Output routines.
  */
 
-/* Flush any output to the screen */
+/*
+ * Flush any output to the screen
+ */
     void
 gui_mch_flush(void)
 {
-    /* TODO: Is anything needed here? */
+    // TODO: Is anything needed here?
 }
 
 /*
@@ -4368,9 +4355,8 @@ gui_mch_clear_all(void)
 
     gui_mch_set_bg_color(gui.back_pixel);
     EraseRect(&rc);
-/*  gui_mch_set_fg_color(gui.norm_pixel);
-    FrameRect(&rc);
-*/
+//  gui_mch_set_fg_color(gui.norm_pixel);
+//    FrameRect(&rc);
 }
 
 /*
@@ -4382,7 +4368,7 @@ gui_mch_delete_lines(int row, int num_li
 {
     Rect	rc;
 
-    /* changed without checking! */
+    // changed without checking!
     rc.left = FILL_X(gui.scroll_region_left);
     rc.right = FILL_X(gui.scroll_region_right + 1);
     rc.top = FILL_Y(row);
@@ -4414,7 +4400,7 @@ gui_mch_insert_lines(int row, int num_li
 
     ScrollRect(&rc, 0, gui.char_height * num_lines, (RgnHandle) nil);
 
-    /* Update gui.cursor_row if the cursor scrolled or copied over */
+    // Update gui.cursor_row if the cursor scrolled or copied over
     if (gui.cursor_row >= gui.row
 	    && gui.cursor_col >= gui.scroll_region_left
 	    && gui.cursor_col <= gui.scroll_region_right)
@@ -4474,10 +4460,10 @@ clip_mch_request_selection(Clipboard_T *
 
     ReserveMem(scrapSize);
 
-    /* In CARBON we don't need a Handle, a pointer is good */
+    // In CARBON we don't need a Handle, a pointer is good
     textOfClip = NewHandle(scrapSize);
 
-    /* tempclip = alloc(scrapSize+1); */
+    // tempclip = alloc(scrapSize+1);
     HLock(textOfClip);
     error = GetScrapFlavorData(scrap,
 	    flavor ? VIMSCRAPFLAVOR : SCRAPTEXTFLAVOR,
@@ -4495,7 +4481,7 @@ clip_mch_request_selection(Clipboard_T *
 
 #ifdef MACOS_CONVERT
     {
-	/* Convert from utf-16 (clipboard) */
+	// Convert from utf-16 (clipboard)
 	size_t encLen = 0;
 	char_u *to = mac_utf16_to_enc((UniChar *)tempclip, scrapSize, &encLen);
 
@@ -4601,7 +4587,7 @@ gui_mch_set_text_area_pos(int x, int y, 
 {
     Rect	VimBound;
 
-/*  HideWindow(gui.VimWindow); */
+//  HideWindow(gui.VimWindow);
     GetWindowBounds(gui.VimWindow, kWindowGlobalPortRgn, &VimBound);
 
     if (gui.which_scrollbars[SBAR_LEFT])
@@ -4647,33 +4633,33 @@ gui_mch_add_menu(vimmenu_T *menu, int id
      *       Carbon Help suggest to use only id between 1 and 235
      */
     static long	 next_avail_id = 128;
-    long	 menu_after_me = 0; /* Default to the end */
+    long	 menu_after_me = 0; // Default to the end
     CFStringRef name;
     short	 index;
     vimmenu_T	*parent = menu->parent;
     vimmenu_T	*brother = menu->next;
 
-    /* Cannot add a menu if ... */
+    // Cannot add a menu if ...
     if ((parent != NULL && parent->submenu_id == 0))
 	return;
 
-    /* menu ID greater than 1024 are reserved for ??? */
+    // menu ID greater than 1024 are reserved for ???
     if (next_avail_id == 1024)
 	return;
 
-    /* My brother could be the PopUp, find my real brother */
+    // My brother could be the PopUp, find my real brother
     while ((brother != NULL) && (!menu_is_menubar(brother->name)))
 	brother = brother->next;
 
-    /*  Find where to insert the menu (for MenuBar) */
+    //  Find where to insert the menu (for MenuBar)
     if ((parent == NULL) && (brother != NULL))
 	menu_after_me = brother->submenu_id;
 
-    /* If the menu is not part of the menubar (and its submenus), add it 'nowhere' */
+    // If the menu is not part of the menubar (and its submenus), add it 'nowhere'
     if (!menu_is_menubar(menu->name))
 	menu_after_me = hierMenu;
 
-    /* Convert the name */
+    // Convert the name
 #ifdef MACOS_CONVERT
     name = menu_title_removing_mnemonic(menu);
 #else
@@ -4682,12 +4668,11 @@ gui_mch_add_menu(vimmenu_T *menu, int id
     if (name == NULL)
 	return;
 
-    /* Create the menu unless it's the help menu */
+    // Create the menu unless it's the help menu
     {
-	/* Carbon suggest use of
-	 * OSStatus CreateNewMenu(MenuID, MenuAttributes, MenuRef *);
-	 * OSStatus SetMenuTitle(MenuRef, ConstStr255Param title);
-	 */
+	// Carbon suggest use of
+	// OSStatus CreateNewMenu(MenuID, MenuAttributes, MenuRef *);
+	// OSStatus SetMenuTitle(MenuRef, ConstStr255Param title);
 	menu->submenu_id = next_avail_id;
 	if (CreateNewMenu(menu->submenu_id, 0, (MenuRef *)&menu->submenu_handle) == noErr)
 	    SetMenuTitleWithCFString((MenuRef)menu->submenu_handle, name);
@@ -4696,29 +4681,27 @@ gui_mch_add_menu(vimmenu_T *menu, int id
 
     if (parent == NULL)
     {
-	/* Adding a menu to the menubar, or in the no mans land (for PopUp) */
-
-	/* TODO: Verify if we could only Insert Menu if really part of the
-	 * menubar The Inserted menu are scanned or the Command-key combos
-	 */
-
-	/* Insert the menu */
-	InsertMenu(menu->submenu_handle, menu_after_me); /* insert before */
+	// Adding a menu to the menubar, or in the no mans land (for PopUp)
+
+	// TODO: Verify if we could only Insert Menu if really part of the
+	// menubar The Inserted menu are scanned or the Command-key combos
+
+	// Insert the menu
+	InsertMenu(menu->submenu_handle, menu_after_me); // insert before
 #if 1
-	/* Vim should normally update it. TODO: verify */
+	// Vim should normally update it. TODO: verify
 	DrawMenuBar();
 #endif
     }
     else
     {
-	/* Adding as a submenu */
+	// Adding as a submenu
 
 	index = gui_mac_get_menu_item_index(menu);
 
-	/* Call InsertMenuItem followed by SetMenuItemText
-	 * to avoid special character recognition by InsertMenuItem
-	 */
-	InsertMenuItem(parent->submenu_handle, "\p ", idx); /* afterItem */
+	// Call InsertMenuItem followed by SetMenuItemText
+	// to avoid special character recognition by InsertMenuItem
+	InsertMenuItem(parent->submenu_handle, "\p ", idx); // afterItem
 	SetMenuItemTextWithCFString(parent->submenu_handle, idx+1, name);
 	SetItemCmd(parent->submenu_handle, idx+1, 0x1B);
 	SetItemMark(parent->submenu_handle, idx+1, menu->submenu_id);
@@ -4728,7 +4711,7 @@ gui_mch_add_menu(vimmenu_T *menu, int id
     CFRelease(name);
 
 #if 0
-    /* Done by Vim later on */
+    // Done by Vim later on
     DrawMenuBar();
 #endif
 }
@@ -4743,31 +4726,30 @@ gui_mch_add_menu_item(vimmenu_T *menu, i
     vimmenu_T	*parent = menu->parent;
     int		menu_inserted;
 
-    /* Cannot add item, if the menu have not been created */
+    // Cannot add item, if the menu have not been created
     if (parent->submenu_id == 0)
 	return;
 
-    /* Could call SetMenuRefCon [CARBON] to associate with the Menu,
-       for older OS call GetMenuItemData (menu, item, isCommandID?, data) */
-
-    /* Convert the name */
+    // Could call SetMenuRefCon [CARBON] to associate with the Menu,
+    // for older OS call GetMenuItemData (menu, item, isCommandID?, data)
+
+    // Convert the name
 #ifdef MACOS_CONVERT
     name = menu_title_removing_mnemonic(menu);
 #else
     name = C2Pascal_save(menu->dname);
 #endif
 
-    /* Where are just a menu item, so no handle, no id */
+    // Where are just a menu item, so no handle, no id
     menu->submenu_id = 0;
     menu->submenu_handle = NULL;
 
     menu_inserted = 0;
     if (menu->actext)
     {
-	/* If the accelerator text for the menu item looks like it describes
-	 * a command key (e.g., "<D-S-t>" or "<C-7>"), display it as the
-	 * item's command equivalent.
-	 */
+	// If the accelerator text for the menu item looks like it describes
+	// a command key (e.g., "<D-S-t>" or "<C-7>"), display it as the
+	// item's command equivalent.
 	int	    key = 0;
 	int	    modifiers = 0;
 	char_u	    *p_actext;
@@ -4776,39 +4758,36 @@ gui_mch_add_menu_item(vimmenu_T *menu, i
 	key = find_special_key(&p_actext, &modifiers, FALSE, FALSE, FALSE,
 								   TRUE, NULL);
 	if (*p_actext != 0)
-	    key = 0; /* error: trailing text */
-	/* find_special_key() returns a keycode with as many of the
-	 * specified modifiers as appropriate already applied (e.g., for
-	 * "<D-C-x>" it returns Ctrl-X as the keycode and MOD_MASK_CMD
-	 * as the only modifier).  Since we want to display all of the
-	 * modifiers, we need to convert the keycode back to a printable
-	 * character plus modifiers.
-	 * TODO: Write an alternative find_special_key() that doesn't
-	 * apply modifiers.
-	 */
+	    key = 0; // error: trailing text
+	// find_special_key() returns a keycode with as many of the
+	// specified modifiers as appropriate already applied (e.g., for
+	// "<D-C-x>" it returns Ctrl-X as the keycode and MOD_MASK_CMD
+	// as the only modifier).  Since we want to display all of the
+	// modifiers, we need to convert the keycode back to a printable
+	// character plus modifiers.
+	// TODO: Write an alternative find_special_key() that doesn't
+	// apply modifiers.
 	if (key > 0 && key < 32)
 	{
-	    /* Convert a control key to an uppercase letter.  Note that
-	     * by this point it is no longer possible to distinguish
-	     * between, e.g., Ctrl-S and Ctrl-Shift-S.
-	     */
+	    // Convert a control key to an uppercase letter.  Note that
+	    // by this point it is no longer possible to distinguish
+	    // between, e.g., Ctrl-S and Ctrl-Shift-S.
 	    modifiers |= MOD_MASK_CTRL;
 	    key += '@';
 	}
-	/* If the keycode is an uppercase letter, set the Shift modifier.
-	 * If it is a lowercase letter, don't set the modifier, but convert
-	 * the letter to uppercase for display in the menu.
-	 */
+	// If the keycode is an uppercase letter, set the Shift modifier.
+	// If it is a lowercase letter, don't set the modifier, but convert
+	// the letter to uppercase for display in the menu.
 	else if (key >= 'A' && key <= 'Z')
 	    modifiers |= MOD_MASK_SHIFT;
 	else if (key >= 'a' && key <= 'z')
 	    key += 'A' - 'a';
-	/* Note: keycodes below 0x22 are reserved by Apple. */
+	// Note: keycodes below 0x22 are reserved by Apple.
 	if (key >= 0x22 && vim_isprintc_strict(key))
 	{
 	    int		valid = 1;
 	    char_u      mac_mods = kMenuNoModifiers;
-	    /* Convert Vim modifier codes to Menu Manager equivalents. */
+	    // Convert Vim modifier codes to Menu Manager equivalents.
 	    if (modifiers & MOD_MASK_SHIFT)
 		mac_mods |= kMenuShiftModifier;
 	    if (modifiers & MOD_MASK_CTRL)
@@ -4816,30 +4795,29 @@ gui_mch_add_menu_item(vimmenu_T *menu, i
 	    if (!(modifiers & MOD_MASK_CMD))
 		mac_mods |= kMenuNoCommandModifier;
 	    if (modifiers & MOD_MASK_ALT || modifiers & MOD_MASK_MULTI_CLICK)
-		valid = 0; /* TODO: will Alt someday map to Option? */
+		valid = 0; // TODO: will Alt someday map to Option?
 	    if (valid)
 	    {
 		char_u	    item_txt[10];
-		/* Insert the menu item after idx, with its command key. */
+		// Insert the menu item after idx, with its command key.
 		item_txt[0] = 3; item_txt[1] = ' '; item_txt[2] = '/';
 		item_txt[3] = key;
 		InsertMenuItem(parent->submenu_handle, item_txt, idx);
-		/* Set the modifier keys. */
+		// Set the modifier keys.
 		SetMenuItemModifiers(parent->submenu_handle, idx+1, mac_mods);
 		menu_inserted = 1;
 	    }
 	}
     }
-    /* Call InsertMenuItem followed by SetMenuItemText
-     * to avoid special character recognition by InsertMenuItem
-     */
+    // Call InsertMenuItem followed by SetMenuItemText
+    // to avoid special character recognition by InsertMenuItem
     if (!menu_inserted)
-	InsertMenuItem(parent->submenu_handle, "\p ", idx); /* afterItem */
-    /* Set the menu item name. */
+	InsertMenuItem(parent->submenu_handle, "\p ", idx); // afterItem
+    // Set the menu item name.
     SetMenuItemTextWithCFString(parent->submenu_handle, idx+1, name);
 
 #if 0
-    /* Called by Vim */
+    // Called by Vim
     DrawMenuBar();
 #endif
 
@@ -4849,7 +4827,7 @@ gui_mch_add_menu_item(vimmenu_T *menu, i
     void
 gui_mch_toggle_tearoffs(int enable)
 {
-    /* no tearoff menus */
+    // no tearoff menus
 }
 
 /*
@@ -4865,10 +4843,10 @@ gui_mch_destroy_menu(vimmenu_T *menu)
       if (menu->parent)
       {
 	{
-	    /* For now just don't delete help menu items. (Huh? Dany) */
+	    // For now just don't delete help menu items. (Huh? Dany)
 	    DeleteMenuItem(menu->parent->submenu_handle, index);
 
-	    /* Delete the Menu if it was a hierarchical Menu */
+	    // Delete the Menu if it was a hierarchical Menu
 	    if (menu->submenu_id != 0)
 	    {
 		DeleteMenu(menu->submenu_id);
@@ -4890,7 +4868,7 @@ gui_mch_destroy_menu(vimmenu_T *menu)
 	    DisposeMenu(menu->submenu_handle);
 	}
     }
-    /* Shouldn't this be already done by Vim. TODO: Check */
+    // Shouldn't this be already done by Vim. TODO: Check
     DrawMenuBar();
 }
 
@@ -4900,7 +4878,7 @@ gui_mch_destroy_menu(vimmenu_T *menu)
     void
 gui_mch_menu_grey(vimmenu_T *menu, int grey)
 {
-    /* TODO: Check if menu really exists */
+    // TODO: Check if menu really exists
     short index = gui_mac_get_menu_item_index(menu);
 /*
     index = menu->index;
@@ -4929,7 +4907,7 @@ gui_mch_menu_grey(vimmenu_T *menu, int g
     void
 gui_mch_menu_hidden(vimmenu_T *menu, int hidden)
 {
-    /* There's no hidden mode on MacOS */
+    // There's no hidden mode on MacOS
     gui_mch_menu_grey(menu, hidden);
 }
 
@@ -4988,7 +4966,8 @@ gui_mch_set_scrollbar_pos(
 	int h)
 {
     gui_mch_set_bg_color(gui.back_pixel);
-/*  if (gui.which_scrollbars[SBAR_LEFT])
+#if 0
+  if (gui.which_scrollbars[SBAR_LEFT])
     {
 	MoveControl(sb->id, x-16, y);
 	SizeControl(sb->id, w + 1, h);
@@ -4997,7 +4976,8 @@ gui_mch_set_scrollbar_pos(
     {
 	MoveControl(sb->id, x, y);
 	SizeControl(sb->id, w + 1, h);
-    }*/
+    }
+#endif
     if (sb == &gui.bottom_sbar)
 	h += 1;
     else
@@ -5016,7 +4996,7 @@ gui_mch_set_scrollbar_pos(
     void
 gui_mch_create_scrollbar(
 	scrollbar_T *sb,
-	int orient)	/* SBAR_VERT or SBAR_HORIZ */
+	int orient)	// SBAR_VERT or SBAR_HORIZ
 {
     Rect bounds;
 
@@ -5029,9 +5009,9 @@ gui_mch_create_scrollbar(
 			 &bounds,
 			 "\pScrollBar",
 			 TRUE,
-			 0, /* current*/
-			 0, /* top */
-			 0, /* bottom */
+			 0, // current
+			 0, // top
+			 0, // bottom
 			 kControlScrollBarLiveProc,
 			 (long) sb->ident);
 #ifdef DEBUG_MAC_SB
@@ -5072,10 +5052,12 @@ gui_mch_is_blink_off(void)
     void
 gui_mch_set_blinking(long wait, long on, long off)
 {
-    /* TODO: TODO: TODO: TODO: */
-/*    blink_waittime = wait;
+#if 0
+    // TODO: TODO: TODO: TODO:
+    blink_waittime = wait;
     blink_ontime = on;
-    blink_offtime = off;*/
+    blink_offtime = off;
+#endif
 }
 
 /*
@@ -5086,11 +5068,13 @@ gui_mch_stop_blink(int may_call_gui_upda
 {
     if (may_call_gui_update_cursor)
 	gui_update_cursor(TRUE, FALSE);
-    /* TODO: TODO: TODO: TODO: */
-/*    gui_w32_rm_blink_timer();
+#if 0
+    // TODO: TODO: TODO: TODO:
+    gui_w32_rm_blink_timer();
     if (blink_state == BLINK_OFF)
     gui_update_cursor(TRUE, FALSE);
-    blink_state = BLINK_NONE;*/
+    blink_state = BLINK_NONE;
+#endif
 }
 
 /*
@@ -5101,17 +5085,19 @@ gui_mch_stop_blink(int may_call_gui_upda
 gui_mch_start_blink(void)
 {
     gui_update_cursor(TRUE, FALSE);
-    /* TODO: TODO: TODO: TODO: */
-/*    gui_w32_rm_blink_timer(); */
-
-    /* Only switch blinking on if none of the times is zero */
-/*    if (blink_waittime && blink_ontime && blink_offtime)
+    // TODO: TODO: TODO: TODO:
+//    gui_w32_rm_blink_timer();
+
+    // Only switch blinking on if none of the times is zero
+#if 0
+    if (blink_waittime && blink_ontime && blink_offtime)
     {
     blink_timer = SetTimer(NULL, 0, (UINT)blink_waittime,
 			    (TIMERPROC)_OnBlinkTimer);
     blink_state = BLINK_ON;
     gui_update_cursor(TRUE, FALSE);
-    }*/
+    }
+#endif
 }
 
 /*
@@ -5153,7 +5139,7 @@ gui_mch_browse(
     char_u *initdir,
     char_u *filter)
 {
-    /* TODO: Add Ammon's safety check (Dany) */
+    // TODO: Add Ammon's safety check (Dany)
     NavReplyRecord	reply;
     char_u		*fname = NULL;
     char_u		**fnames = NULL;
@@ -5161,33 +5147,32 @@ gui_mch_browse(
     NavDialogOptions	navOptions;
     OSErr		error;
 
-    /* Get Navigation Service Defaults value */
+    // Get Navigation Service Defaults value
     NavGetDefaultDialogOptions(&navOptions);
 
 
-    /* TODO: If we get a :browse args, set the Multiple bit. */
+    // TODO: If we get a :browse args, set the Multiple bit.
     navOptions.dialogOptionFlags =  kNavAllowInvisibleFiles
 				 |  kNavDontAutoTranslate
 				 |  kNavDontAddTranslateItems
-			    /*	 |  kNavAllowMultipleFiles */
+			    //	 |  kNavAllowMultipleFiles
 				 |  kNavAllowStationery;
 
     (void) C2PascalString(title,   &navOptions.message);
     (void) C2PascalString(dflt,    &navOptions.savedFileName);
-    /* Could set clientName?
-     *		 windowTitle? (there's no title bar?)
-     */
+    // Could set clientName?
+    //		 windowTitle? (there's no title bar?)
 
     if (saving)
     {
-	/* Change first parm AEDesc (typeFSS) *defaultLocation to match dflt */
+	// Change first parm AEDesc (typeFSS) *defaultLocation to match dflt
 	NavPutFile(NULL, &reply, &navOptions, NULL, 'TEXT', 'VIM!', NULL);
 	if (!reply.validRecord)
 	    return NULL;
     }
     else
     {
-	/* Change first parm AEDesc (typeFSS) *defaultLocation to match dflt */
+	// Change first parm AEDesc (typeFSS) *defaultLocation to match dflt
 	NavGetFile(NULL, &reply, &navOptions, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL);
 	if (!reply.validRecord)
 	    return NULL;
@@ -5203,10 +5188,10 @@ gui_mch_browse(
 	vim_free(fnames);
     }
 
-    /* TODO: Shorten the file name if possible */
+    // TODO: Shorten the file name if possible
     return fname;
 }
-#endif /* FEAT_BROWSE */
+#endif // FEAT_BROWSE
 
 #ifdef FEAT_GUI_DIALOG
 /*
@@ -5233,9 +5218,9 @@ gui_mch_browse(
 typedef struct
 {
     short   idx;
-    short   width;	/* Size of the text in pixel */
+    short   width;	// Size of the text in pixel
     Rect    box;
-} vgmDlgItm; /* Vim Gui_Mac.c Dialog Item */
+} vgmDlgItm; // Vim Gui_Mac.c Dialog Item
 
 #define MoveRectTo(r,x,y) OffsetRect(r,x-r->left,y-r->top)
 
@@ -5247,8 +5232,8 @@ macMoveDialogItem(
     short	Y,
     Rect	*inBox)
 {
-#if 0 /* USE_CARBONIZED */
-    /* Untested */
+#if 0 // USE_CARBONIZED
+    // Untested
     MoveDialogItem(theDialog, itemNumber, X, Y);
     if (inBox != nil)
 	GetDialogItem(theDialog, itemNumber, &itemType, &itemHandle, inBox);
@@ -5264,9 +5249,9 @@ macMoveDialogItem(
     GetDialogItem(theDialog, itemNumber, &itemType, &itemHandle, itemBox);
     OffsetRect(itemBox, -itemBox->left, -itemBox->top);
     OffsetRect(itemBox, X, Y);
-    /* To move a control (like a button) we need to call both
-     * MoveControl and SetDialogItem. FAQ 6-18 */
-    if (1) /*(itemType & kControlDialogItem) */
+    // To move a control (like a button) we need to call both
+    // MoveControl and SetDialogItem. FAQ 6-18
+    if (1) //(itemType & kControlDialogItem)
 	MoveControl((ControlRef) itemHandle, X, Y);
     SetDialogItem(theDialog, itemNumber, itemType, itemHandle, itemBox);
 #endif
@@ -5285,25 +5270,25 @@ macSizeDialogItem(
 
     GetDialogItem(theDialog, itemNumber, &itemType, &itemHandle, &itemBox);
 
-    /* When width or height is zero do not change it */
+    // When width or height is zero do not change it
     if (width  == 0)
 	width  = itemBox.right  - itemBox.left;
     if (height == 0)
 	height = itemBox.bottom - itemBox.top;
 
-#if 0 /* USE_CARBONIZED */
-    SizeDialogItem(theDialog, itemNumber, width, height); /* Untested */
+#if 0 // USE_CARBONIZED
+    SizeDialogItem(theDialog, itemNumber, width, height); // Untested
 #else
-    /* Resize the bounding box */
+    // Resize the bounding box
     itemBox.right  = itemBox.left + width;
     itemBox.bottom = itemBox.top  + height;
 
-    /* To resize a control (like a button) we need to call both
-     * SizeControl and SetDialogItem. (deducted from FAQ 6-18) */
+    // To resize a control (like a button) we need to call both
+    // SizeControl and SetDialogItem. (deducted from FAQ 6-18)
     if (itemType & kControlDialogItem)
 	SizeControl((ControlRef) itemHandle, width, height);
 
-    /* Configure back the item */
+    // Configure back the item
     SetDialogItem(theDialog, itemNumber, itemType, itemHandle, &itemBox);
 #endif
 }
@@ -5327,7 +5312,8 @@ macSetDialogItemText(
 }
 
 
-/* ModalDialog() handler for message dialogs that have hotkey accelerators.
+/*
+ * ModalDialog() handler for message dialogs that have hotkey accelerators.
  * Expects a mapping of hotkey char to control index in gDialogHotKeys;
  * setting gDialogHotKeys to NULL disables any hotkey handling.
  */
@@ -5350,26 +5336,26 @@ DialogHotkeyFilterProc (
 #endif
 	    *itemHit = gDialogHotKeys[keyHit];
 
-	    /* When handing off to StdFilterProc, pretend that the user
-	     * clicked the control manually. Note that this is also supposed
-	     * to cause the button to hilite briefly (to give some user
-	     * feedback), but this seems not to actually work (or it's too
-	     * fast to be seen).
-	     */
+	    // When handing off to StdFilterProc, pretend that the user
+	    // clicked the control manually. Note that this is also supposed
+	    // to cause the button to hilite briefly (to give some user
+	    // feedback), but this seems not to actually work (or it's too
+	    // fast to be seen).
 	    event->what = kEventControlSimulateHit;
 
-	    return true; /* we took care of it */
+	    return true; // we took care of it
 	}
 
-	/* Defer to the OS's standard behavior for this event.
-	 * This ensures that Enter will still activate the default button. */
+	// Defer to the OS's standard behavior for this event.
+	// This ensures that Enter will still activate the default button.
 	return StdFilterProc(theDialog, event, itemHit);
     }
-    return false;      /* Let ModalDialog deal with it */
+    return false;      // Let ModalDialog deal with it
 }
 
 
-/* TODO: There have been some crashes with dialogs, check your inbox
+/*
+ * TODO: There have been some crashes with dialogs, check your inbox
  * (Jussi)
  */
     int
@@ -5390,12 +5376,12 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     Handle	iconHandle;
     DialogPtr	theDialog;
     char_u	len;
-    char_u	PascalTitle[256];	/* place holder for the title */
+    char_u	PascalTitle[256];	// place holder for the title
     char_u	name[256];
     GrafPtr	oldPort;
     short	itemHit;
     char_u	*buttonChar;
-    short	hotKeys[256];		/* map of hotkey -> control ID */
+    short	hotKeys[256];		// map of hotkey -> control ID
     char_u	aHotKey;
     Rect	box;
     short	button;
@@ -5403,14 +5389,14 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     short	itemType;
     short	useIcon;
     short	width;
-    short	totalButtonWidth = 0;   /* the width of all buttons together
-					   including spacing */
+    short	totalButtonWidth = 0;   // the width of all buttons together
+					// including spacing
     short	widestButton = 0;
-    short	dfltButtonEdge     = 20;  /* gut feeling */
-    short	dfltElementSpacing = 13;  /* from IM:V.2-29 */
-    short       dfltIconSideSpace  = 23;  /* from IM:V.2-29 */
-    short	maximumWidth       = 400; /* gut feeling */
-    short	maxButtonWidth	   = 175; /* gut feeling */
+    short	dfltButtonEdge     = 20;  // gut feeling
+    short	dfltElementSpacing = 13;  // from IM:V.2-29
+    short       dfltIconSideSpace  = 23;  // from IM:V.2-29
+    short	maximumWidth       = 400; // gut feeling
+    short	maxButtonWidth	   = 175; // gut feeling
 
     short	vertical;
     short	dialogHeight;
@@ -5426,51 +5412,50 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 
     ModalFilterUPP dialogUPP;
 
-    /* Check 'v' flag in 'guioptions': vertical button placement. */
+    // Check 'v' flag in 'guioptions': vertical button placement.
     vertical = (vim_strchr(p_go, GO_VERTICAL) != NULL);
 
-    /* Create a new Dialog Box from template. */
+    // Create a new Dialog Box from template.
     theDialog = GetNewDialog(129, nil, (WindowRef) -1);
 
-    /* Get the WindowRef */
+    // Get the WindowRef
     theWindow = GetDialogWindow(theDialog);
 
-    /* Hide the window.
-     * 1. to avoid seeing slow drawing
-     * 2. to prevent a problem seen while moving dialog item
-     *    within a visible window. (non-Carbon MacOS 9)
-     * Could be avoided by changing the resource.
-     */
+    // Hide the window.
+    // 1. to avoid seeing slow drawing
+    // 2. to prevent a problem seen while moving dialog item
+    //    within a visible window. (non-Carbon MacOS 9)
+    // Could be avoided by changing the resource.
     HideWindow(theWindow);
 
-    /* Change the graphical port to the dialog,
-     * so we can measure the text with the proper font */
+    // Change the graphical port to the dialog,
+    // so we can measure the text with the proper font
     GetPort(&oldPort);
     SetPortDialogPort(theDialog);
 
-    /* Get the info about the default text,
-     * used to calculate the height of the message
-     * and of the  text field */
+    // Get the info about the default text,
+    // used to calculate the height of the message
+    // and of the  text field
     GetFontInfo(&textFontInfo);
 
-    /*	Set the dialog title */
+    //	Set the dialog title
     if (title != NULL)
     {
 	(void) C2PascalString(title, &PascalTitle);
 	SetWTitle(theWindow, PascalTitle);
     }
 
-    /* Creates the buttons and add them to the Dialog Box. */
+    // Creates the buttons and add them to the Dialog Box.
     buttonDITL = GetResource('DITL', 130);
     buttonChar = buttons;
     button = 0;
 
-    /* initialize the hotkey mapping */
+    // initialize the hotkey mapping
     vim_memset(hotKeys, 0, sizeof(hotKeys));
 
     for (;*buttonChar != 0;)
     {
-	/* Get the name of the button */
+	// Get the name of the button
 	button++;
 	len = 0;
 	for (;((*buttonChar != DLG_BUTTON_SEP) && (*buttonChar != 0) && (len < 255)); buttonChar++)
@@ -5493,16 +5478,16 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 	  buttonChar++;
 	name[0] = len;
 
-	/* Add the button */
-	AppendDITL(theDialog, buttonDITL, overlayDITL); /* appendDITLRight); */
-
-	/* Change the button's name */
+	// Add the button
+	AppendDITL(theDialog, buttonDITL, overlayDITL); // appendDITLRight);
+
+	// Change the button's name
 	macSetDialogItemText(theDialog, button, name);
 
-	/* Resize the button to fit its name */
+	// Resize the button to fit its name
 	width = StringWidth(name) + 2 * dfltButtonEdge;
-	/* Limit the size of any button to an acceptable value. */
-	/* TODO: Should be based on the message width */
+	// Limit the size of any button to an acceptable value.
+	// TODO: Should be based on the message width
 	if (width > maxButtonWidth)
 	    width = maxButtonWidth;
 	macSizeDialogItem(theDialog, button, width, 0);
@@ -5515,7 +5500,7 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     ReleaseResource(buttonDITL);
     lastButton = button;
 
-    /* Add the icon to the Dialog Box. */
+    // Add the icon to the Dialog Box.
     iconItm.idx = lastButton + 1;
     iconDITL = GetResource('DITL', 131);
     switch (type)
@@ -5530,11 +5515,11 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     AppendDITL(theDialog, iconDITL, overlayDITL);
     ReleaseResource(iconDITL);
     GetDialogItem(theDialog, iconItm.idx, &itemType, &itemHandle, &box);
-    /* TODO: Should the item be freed? */
+    // TODO: Should the item be freed?
     iconHandle = GetIcon(useIcon);
     SetDialogItem(theDialog, iconItm.idx, itemType, iconHandle, &box);
 
-    /* Add the message to the Dialog box. */
+    // Add the message to the Dialog box.
     messageItm.idx = lastButton + 2;
     messageDITL = GetResource('DITL', 132);
     AppendDITL(theDialog, messageDITL, overlayDITL);
@@ -5544,62 +5529,62 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     SetDialogItemText(itemHandle, name);
     messageItm.width = StringWidth(name);
 
-    /* Add the input box if needed */
+    // Add the input box if needed
     if (textfield != NULL)
     {
-	/* Cheat for now reuse the message and convert to text edit */
+	// Cheat for now reuse the message and convert to text edit
 	inputItm.idx = lastButton + 3;
 	inputDITL = GetResource('DITL', 132);
 	AppendDITL(theDialog, inputDITL, overlayDITL);
 	ReleaseResource(inputDITL);
 	GetDialogItem(theDialog, inputItm.idx, &itemType, &itemHandle, &box);
-/*	  SetDialogItem(theDialog, inputItm.idx, kEditTextDialogItem, itemHandle, &box);*/
+//	  SetDialogItem(theDialog, inputItm.idx, kEditTextDialogItem, itemHandle, &box);
 	(void) C2PascalString(textfield, &name);
 	SetDialogItemText(itemHandle, name);
 	inputItm.width = StringWidth(name);
 
-	/* Hotkeys don't make sense if there's a text field */
+	// Hotkeys don't make sense if there's a text field
 	gDialogHotKeys = NULL;
     }
     else
-	/* Install hotkey table */
+	// Install hotkey table
 	gDialogHotKeys = (short *)&hotKeys;
 
-    /* Set the <ENTER> and <ESC> button. */
+    // Set the <ENTER> and <ESC> button.
     SetDialogDefaultItem(theDialog, dfltbutton);
     SetDialogCancelItem(theDialog, 0);
 
-    /* Reposition element */
-
-    /* Check if we need to force vertical */
+    // Reposition element
+
+    // Check if we need to force vertical
     if (totalButtonWidth > maximumWidth)
 	vertical = TRUE;
 
-    /* Place icon */
+    // Place icon
     macMoveDialogItem(theDialog, iconItm.idx, dfltIconSideSpace, dfltElementSpacing, &box);
     iconItm.box.right = box.right;
     iconItm.box.bottom = box.bottom;
 
-    /* Place Message */
+    // Place Message
     messageItm.box.left = iconItm.box.right + dfltIconSideSpace;
     macSizeDialogItem(theDialog, messageItm.idx, 0,  messageLines * (textFontInfo.ascent + textFontInfo.descent));
     macMoveDialogItem(theDialog, messageItm.idx, messageItm.box.left, dfltElementSpacing, &messageItm.box);
 
-    /* Place Input */
+    // Place Input
     if (textfield != NULL)
     {
 	inputItm.box.left = messageItm.box.left;
 	inputItm.box.top  = messageItm.box.bottom + dfltElementSpacing;
 	macSizeDialogItem(theDialog, inputItm.idx, 0, textFontInfo.ascent + textFontInfo.descent);
 	macMoveDialogItem(theDialog, inputItm.idx, inputItm.box.left, inputItm.box.top, &inputItm.box);
-	/* Convert the static text into a text edit.
-	 * For some reason this change need to be done last (Dany) */
+	// Convert the static text into a text edit.
+	// For some reason this change need to be done last (Dany)
 	GetDialogItem(theDialog, inputItm.idx, &itemType, &itemHandle, &inputItm.box);
 	SetDialogItem(theDialog, inputItm.idx, kEditTextDialogItem, itemHandle, &inputItm.box);
 	SelectDialogItemText(theDialog, inputItm.idx, 0, 32767);
     }
 
-    /* Place Button */
+    // Place Button
     if (textfield != NULL)
     {
 	buttonItm.box.left = inputItm.box.left;
@@ -5615,47 +5600,47 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     {
 
 	macMoveDialogItem(theDialog, button, buttonItm.box.left, buttonItm.box.top, &box);
-	/* With vertical, it's better to have all buttons the same length */
+	// With vertical, it's better to have all buttons the same length
 	if (vertical)
 	{
 	    macSizeDialogItem(theDialog, button, widestButton, 0);
 	    GetDialogItem(theDialog, button, &itemType, &itemHandle, &box);
 	}
-	/* Calculate position of next button */
+	// Calculate position of next button
 	if (vertical)
 	    buttonItm.box.top  = box.bottom + dfltElementSpacing;
 	else
 	    buttonItm.box.left  = box.right + dfltElementSpacing;
     }
 
-    /* Resize the dialog box */
+    // Resize the dialog box
     dialogHeight = box.bottom + dfltElementSpacing;
     SizeWindow(theWindow, maximumWidth, dialogHeight, TRUE);
 
-    /* Magic resize */
+    // Magic resize
     AutoSizeDialog(theDialog);
-    /* Need a horizontal resize anyway so not that useful */
-
-    /* Display it */
+    // Need a horizontal resize anyway so not that useful
+
+    // Display it
     ShowWindow(theWindow);
-/*  BringToFront(theWindow); */
+//  BringToFront(theWindow);
     SelectWindow(theWindow);
 
-/*  DrawDialog(theDialog); */
+//  DrawDialog(theDialog);
 #if 0
     GetPort(&oldPort);
     SetPortDialogPort(theDialog);
 #endif
 
 #ifdef USE_CARBONKEYHANDLER
-    /* Avoid that we use key events for the main window. */
+    // Avoid that we use key events for the main window.
     dialog_busy = TRUE;
 #endif
 
-    /* Prepare the shortcut-handling filterProc for handing to the dialog */
+    // Prepare the shortcut-handling filterProc for handing to the dialog
     dialogUPP = NewModalFilterUPP(DialogHotkeyFilterProc);
 
-    /* Hang until one of the button is hit */
+    // Hang until one of the button is hit
     do
 	ModalDialog(dialogUPP, &itemHit);
     while ((itemHit < 1) || (itemHit > lastButton));
@@ -5664,26 +5649,26 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     dialog_busy = FALSE;
 #endif
 
-    /* Copy back the text entered by the user into the param */
+    // Copy back the text entered by the user into the param
     if (textfield != NULL)
     {
 	GetDialogItem(theDialog, inputItm.idx, &itemType, &itemHandle, &box);
 	GetDialogItemText(itemHandle, (char_u *) &name);
 #if IOSIZE < 256
-	/* Truncate the name to IOSIZE if needed */
+	// Truncate the name to IOSIZE if needed
 	if (name[0] > IOSIZE)
 	    name[0] = IOSIZE - 1;
 #endif
 	vim_strncpy(textfield, &name[1], name[0]);
     }
 
-    /* Restore the original graphical port */
+    // Restore the original graphical port
     SetPort(oldPort);
 
-    /* Free the modal filterProc */
+    // Free the modal filterProc
     DisposeRoutineDescriptor(dialogUPP);
 
-    /* Get ride of the dialog (free memory) */
+    // Get ride of the dialog (free memory)
     DisposeDialog(theDialog);
 
     return itemHit;
@@ -5696,7 +5681,7 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
  * AutoSizeDialog():	    Magic resize of dialog based on text length
  */
 }
-#endif /* FEAT_DIALOG_GUI */
+#endif // FEAT_DIALOG_GUI
 
 /*
  * Display the saved error message(s).
@@ -5711,7 +5696,7 @@ display_errors(void)
     if (error_ga.ga_data == NULL)
 	return;
 
-    /* avoid putting up a message box with blanks only */
+    // avoid putting up a message box with blanks only
     for (p = (char *)error_ga.ga_data; *p; ++p)
 	if (!isspace(*p))
 	{
@@ -5724,10 +5709,9 @@ display_errors(void)
 	    ParamText(pError, nil, nil, nil);
 	    Alert(128, nil);
 	    break;
-	    /* TODO: handled message longer than 256 chars
-	     *	 use auto-sizeable alert
-	     *	 or dialog with scrollbars (TextEdit zone)
-	     */
+	    // TODO: handled message longer than 256 chars
+	    //	 use auto-sizeable alert
+	    //	 or dialog with scrollbars (TextEdit zone)
 	}
     ga_clear(&error_ga);
 }
@@ -5750,9 +5734,9 @@ gui_mch_getmouse(int *x, int *y)
     void
 gui_mch_setmouse(int x, int y)
 {
-    /* TODO */
+    // TODO
 #if 0
-    /* From FAQ 3-11 */
+    // From FAQ 3-11
 
     CursorDevicePtr myMouse;
     Point	    where;
@@ -5760,7 +5744,7 @@ gui_mch_setmouse(int x, int y)
     if (   NGetTrapAddress(_CursorDeviceDispatch, ToolTrap)
 	!= NGetTrapAddress(_Unimplemented,   ToolTrap))
     {
-	/* New way */
+	// New way
 
 	/*
 	 * Get first device with one button.
@@ -5773,7 +5757,7 @@ gui_mch_setmouse(int x, int y)
 
 	do
 	{
-	    /* Get the next cursor device */
+	    // Get the next cursor device
 	    CursorDeviceNextDevice(&myMouse);
 	}
 	while ((myMouse != nil) && (myMouse->cntButtons != 1));
@@ -5782,7 +5766,7 @@ gui_mch_setmouse(int x, int y)
     }
     else
     {
-	/* Old way */
+	// Old way
 	where.h = x;
 	where.v = y;
 
@@ -5811,16 +5795,16 @@ gui_mch_show_popupmenu(vimmenu_T *menu)
     Str255	HelpName = "";
     GrafPtr	savePort;
 
-    /* Save Current Port: On MacOS X we seem to lose the port */
-    GetPort(&savePort); /*OSX*/
+    // Save Current Port: On MacOS X we seem to lose the port
+    GetPort(&savePort); //OSX
 
     GetMouse(&where);
-    LocalToGlobal(&where); /*OSX*/
+    LocalToGlobal(&where); //OSX
     CntxMenu = menu->submenu_handle;
 
-    /* TODO: Get the text selection from Vim */
-
-    /* Call to Handle Popup */
+    // TODO: Get the text selection from Vim
+
+    // Call to Handle Popup
     status = ContextualMenuSelect(CntxMenu, where, false, kCMHelpItemRemoveHelp,
 		       HelpName, NULL, &CntxType, &CntxMenuID, &CntxMenuItem);
 
@@ -5828,24 +5812,24 @@ gui_mch_show_popupmenu(vimmenu_T *menu)
     {
 	if (CntxType == kCMMenuItemSelected)
 	{
-	    /* Handle the menu CntxMenuID, CntxMenuItem */
-	    /* The submenu can be handle directly by gui_mac_handle_menu */
-	    /* But what about the current menu, is the menu changed by
-	     * ContextualMenuSelect */
+	    // Handle the menu CntxMenuID, CntxMenuItem
+	    // The submenu can be handle directly by gui_mac_handle_menu
+	    // But what about the current menu, is the menu changed by
+	    // ContextualMenuSelect
 	    gui_mac_handle_menu((CntxMenuID << 16) + CntxMenuItem);
 	}
 	else if (CntxMenuID == kCMShowHelpSelected)
 	{
-	    /* Should come up with the help */
+	    // Should come up with the help
 	}
     }
 
-    /* Restore original Port */
-    SetPort(savePort); /*OSX*/
+    // Restore original Port
+    SetPort(savePort); //OSX
 }
 
 #if defined(FEAT_CW_EDITOR) || defined(PROTO)
-/* TODO: Is it need for MACOS_X? (Dany) */
+// TODO: Is it need for MACOS_X? (Dany)
     void
 mch_post_buffer_write(buf_T *buf)
 {
@@ -5862,9 +5846,8 @@ mch_post_buffer_write(buf_T *buf)
     void
 gui_mch_settitle(char_u *title, char_u *icon)
 {
-    /* TODO: Get vim to make sure maxlen (from p_titlelen) is smaller
-     *       that 256. Even better get it to fit nicely in the titlebar.
-     */
+    // TODO: Get vim to make sure maxlen (from p_titlelen) is smaller
+    //       that 256. Even better get it to fit nicely in the titlebar.
 #ifdef MACOS_CONVERT
     CFStringRef windowTitle;
     size_t	windowTitleLen;
@@ -5872,7 +5855,7 @@ gui_mch_settitle(char_u *title, char_u *
     char_u   *pascalTitle;
 #endif
 
-    if (title == NULL)		/* nothing to do */
+    if (title == NULL)		// nothing to do
 	return;
 
 #ifdef MACOS_CONVERT
@@ -5925,7 +5908,7 @@ C2PascalString(char_u *CString, Str255 *
     int
 GetFSSpecFromPath(char_u *file, FSSpec *fileFSSpec)
 {
-    /* From FAQ 8-12 */
+    // From FAQ 8-12
     Str255      filePascal;
     CInfoPBRec	myCPB;
     OSErr	err;
@@ -5939,10 +5922,10 @@ GetFSSpecFromPath(char_u *file, FSSpec *
 
     err= PBGetCatInfo(&myCPB, false);
 
-    /*    vRefNum, dirID, name */
+    //    vRefNum, dirID, name
     FSMakeFSSpec(0, 0, filePascal, fileFSSpec);
 
-    /* TODO: Use an error code mechanism */
+    // TODO: Use an error code mechanism
     return 0;
 }
 
@@ -5976,36 +5959,36 @@ char_u *FullPathFromFSSpec_save(FSSpec f
 #endif
 
 #ifdef USE_UNIXFILENAME
-    /* Get the default volume */
-    /* TODO: Remove as this only work if Vim is on the Boot Volume*/
+    // Get the default volume
+    // TODO: Remove as this only work if Vim is on the Boot Volume
     error=HGetVol(NULL, &dfltVol_vRefNum, &dfltVol_dirID);
 
     if (error)
       return NULL;
 #endif
 
-    /* Start filling fname with file.name  */
+    // Start filling fname with file.name
     vim_strncpy(filenamePtr, &file.name[1], file.name[0]);
 
-    /* Get the info about the file specified in FSSpec */
+    // Get the info about the file specified in FSSpec
     theCPB.dirInfo.ioFDirIndex = 0;
     theCPB.dirInfo.ioNamePtr   = file.name;
     theCPB.dirInfo.ioVRefNum   = file.vRefNum;
-    /*theCPB.hFileInfo.ioDirID   = 0;*/
+    //theCPB.hFileInfo.ioDirID   = 0;
     theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrDirID   = file.parID;
 
-    /* As ioFDirIndex = 0, get the info of ioNamePtr,
-       which is relative to ioVrefNum, ioDirID */
+    // As ioFDirIndex = 0, get the info of ioNamePtr,
+    // which is relative to ioVrefNum, ioDirID
     error = PBGetCatInfo(&theCPB, false);
 
-    /* If we are called for a new file we expect fnfErr */
+    // If we are called for a new file we expect fnfErr
     if ((error) && (error != fnfErr))
       return NULL;
 
-    /* Check if it's a file or folder       */
-    /* default to file if file don't exist  */
+    // Check if it's a file or folder
+    // default to file if file don't exist
     if (((theCPB.hFileInfo.ioFlAttrib & ioDirMask) == 0) || (error))
-      folder = 0; /* It's not a folder */
+      folder = 0; // It's not a folder
     else
       folder = 1;
 
@@ -6016,12 +5999,12 @@ char_u *FullPathFromFSSpec_save(FSSpec f
      */
     if (error == fnfErr)
     {
-	/* If the file to be saved does not already exist, it isn't possible
-	   to convert its FSSpec into an FSRef.  But we can construct an
-	   FSSpec for the file's parent folder (since we have its volume and
-	   directory IDs), and since that folder does exist, we can convert
-	   that FSSpec into an FSRef, convert the FSRef in turn into a path,
-	   and, finally, append the filename. */
+	// If the file to be saved does not already exist, it isn't possible
+	// to convert its FSSpec into an FSRef.  But we can construct an
+	// FSSpec for the file's parent folder (since we have its volume and
+	// directory IDs), and since that folder does exist, we can convert
+	// that FSSpec into an FSRef, convert the FSRef in turn into a path,
+	// and, finally, append the filename.
 	FSSpec dirSpec;
 	FSRef dirRef;
 	Str255 emptyFilename = "\p";
@@ -6043,8 +6026,8 @@ char_u *FullPathFromFSSpec_save(FSSpec f
     }
     else
     {
-	/* If the file to be saved already exists, we can get its full path
-	   by converting its FSSpec into an FSRef. */
+	// If the file to be saved already exists, we can get its full path
+	// by converting its FSSpec into an FSRef.
 	error=FSpMakeFSRef(&file, &refFile);
 	if (error)
 	    return NULL;
@@ -6054,18 +6037,18 @@ char_u *FullPathFromFSSpec_save(FSSpec f
 	    return NULL;
     }
 
-    /* Add a slash at the end if needed */
+    // Add a slash at the end if needed
     if (folder)
 	STRCAT(path, "/");
 
     return (vim_strsave(path));
 #else
-    /* TODO: Get rid of all USE_UNIXFILENAME below */
-    /* Set ioNamePtr, it's the same area which is always reused. */
+    // TODO: Get rid of all USE_UNIXFILENAME below
+    // Set ioNamePtr, it's the same area which is always reused.
     theCPB.dirInfo.ioNamePtr = directoryName;
 
-    /* Trick for first entry, set ioDrParID to the first value
-     * we want for ioDrDirID*/
+    // Trick for first entry, set ioDrParID to the first value
+    // we want for ioDrDirID
     theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrParID = file.parID;
     theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrDirID = file.parID;
 
@@ -6073,53 +6056,53 @@ char_u *FullPathFromFSSpec_save(FSSpec f
     do
     {
 	theCPB.dirInfo.ioFDirIndex = -1;
-     /* theCPB.dirInfo.ioNamePtr   = directoryName; Already done above. */
+     // theCPB.dirInfo.ioNamePtr   = directoryName; Already done above.
 	theCPB.dirInfo.ioVRefNum   = file.vRefNum;
-     /* theCPB.dirInfo.ioDirID     = irrelevant when ioFDirIndex = -1 */
+     // theCPB.dirInfo.ioDirID     = irrelevant when ioFDirIndex = -1
 	theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrDirID   = theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrParID;
 
-	/* As ioFDirIndex = -1, get the info of ioDrDirID, */
-	/*  *ioNamePtr[0 TO 31] will be updated		   */
+	// As ioFDirIndex = -1, get the info of ioDrDirID,
+	//  *ioNamePtr[0 TO 31] will be updated
 	error = PBGetCatInfo(&theCPB,false);
 
 	if (error)
 	  return NULL;
 
-	/* Put the new directoryName in front of the current fname */
+	// Put the new directoryName in front of the current fname
 	STRCPY(temporaryPtr, filenamePtr);
 	vim_strncpy(filenamePtr, &directoryName[1], directoryName[0]);
 	STRCAT(filenamePtr, ":");
 	STRCAT(filenamePtr, temporaryPtr);
     }
-#if 1 /* def USE_UNIXFILENAME */
-    while ((theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrParID != fsRtDirID) /* && */
-	 /*  (theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrDirID != fsRtDirID)*/);
+#if 1 // def USE_UNIXFILENAME
+    while ((theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrParID != fsRtDirID)
+	 /* && (theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrDirID != fsRtDirID)*/);
 #else
     while (theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrDirID != fsRtDirID);
 #endif
 
-    /* Get the information about the volume on which the file reside */
+    // Get the information about the volume on which the file reside
     theCPB.dirInfo.ioFDirIndex = -1;
- /* theCPB.dirInfo.ioNamePtr   = directoryName; Already done above. */
+ // theCPB.dirInfo.ioNamePtr   = directoryName; Already done above.
     theCPB.dirInfo.ioVRefNum   = file.vRefNum;
- /* theCPB.dirInfo.ioDirID     = irrelevant when ioFDirIndex = -1 */
+ // theCPB.dirInfo.ioDirID     = irrelevant when ioFDirIndex = -1
     theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrDirID   = theCPB.dirInfo.ioDrParID;
 
-    /* As ioFDirIndex = -1, get the info of ioDrDirID, */
-    /*	*ioNamePtr[0 TO 31] will be updated	       */
+    // As ioFDirIndex = -1, get the info of ioDrDirID,
+    //	*ioNamePtr[0 TO 31] will be updated
     error = PBGetCatInfo(&theCPB,false);
 
     if (error)
       return NULL;
 
-    /* For MacOS Classic always add the volume name	     */
-    /* For MacOS X add the volume name preceded by "Volumes" */
-    /*	when we are not referring to the boot volume	     */
+    // For MacOS Classic always add the volume name
+    // For MacOS X add the volume name preceded by "Volumes"
+    //	when we are not referring to the boot volume
 #ifdef USE_UNIXFILENAME
     if (file.vRefNum != dfltVol_vRefNum)
 #endif
     {
-	/* Add the volume name */
+	// Add the volume name
 	STRCPY(temporaryPtr, filenamePtr);
 	vim_strncpy(filenamePtr, &directoryName[1], directoryName[0]);
 	STRCAT(filenamePtr, ":");
@@ -6127,20 +6110,20 @@ char_u *FullPathFromFSSpec_save(FSSpec f
 
 #ifdef USE_UNIXFILENAME
 	STRCPY(temporaryPtr, filenamePtr);
-	filenamePtr[0] = 0; /* NULL terminate the string */
+	filenamePtr[0] = 0; // NULL terminate the string
 	STRCAT(filenamePtr, "Volumes:");
 	STRCAT(filenamePtr, temporaryPtr);
 #endif
     }
 
-    /* Append final path separator if it's a folder */
+    // Append final path separator if it's a folder
     if (folder)
 	STRCAT(fname, ":");
 
-    /* As we use Unix File Name for MacOS X convert it */
+    // As we use Unix File Name for MacOS X convert it
 #ifdef USE_UNIXFILENAME
-    /* Need to insert leading / */
-    /* TODO: get the above code to use directly the / */
+    // Need to insert leading /
+    // TODO: get the above code to use directly the /
     STRCPY(&temporaryPtr[1], filenamePtr);
     temporaryPtr[0] = '/';
     STRCPY(filenamePtr, temporaryPtr);
@@ -6168,7 +6151,7 @@ char_u *FullPathFromFSSpec_save(FSSpec f
 im_set_position(int row, int col)
 {
 # if 0
-    /* TODO: Implement me! */
+    // TODO: Implement me!
     im_start_row = row;
     im_start_col = col;
 # endif
@@ -6197,7 +6180,7 @@ im_on_window_switch(int active)
     {
 	im_initialized = 1;
 
-	/* save default TSM component (should be U.S.) to default */
+	// save default TSM component (should be U.S.) to default
 	GetDefaultInputMethodOfClass(&gTSCDefault, &gTSLDefault,
 				     kKeyboardInputMethodClass);
     }
@@ -6250,7 +6233,7 @@ im_set_active(int active)
     {
 	im_initialized = 1;
 
-	/* save default TSM component (should be U.S.) to default */
+	// save default TSM component (should be U.S.) to default
 	GetDefaultInputMethodOfClass(&gTSCDefault, &gTSLDefault,
 				     kKeyboardInputMethodClass);
     }
@@ -6282,8 +6265,8 @@ im_set_active(int active)
 	    GetDefaultInputMethodOfClass(&gTSCInsert, slptr,
 					 kKeyboardInputMethodClass);
 
-	/* restore to default when switch to normal mode, so than we could
-	 * enter commands easier */
+	// restore to default when switch to normal mode, so than we could
+	// enter commands easier
 	SetDefaultInputMethodOfClass(gTSCDefault, &gTSLDefault,
 				     kKeyboardInputMethodClass);
 	SetTextServiceLanguage(&gTSLDefault);
--- a/src/gui_motif.c
+++ b/src/gui_motif.c
@@ -49,7 +49,7 @@
 # include <Xm/Notebook.h>
 #endif
 
-#include "gui_xmebw.h"	/* for our Enhanced Button Widget */
+#include "gui_xmebw.h"	// for our Enhanced Button Widget
 
 #if defined(FEAT_GUI_DIALOG) && defined(HAVE_XPM)
 # include "../pixmaps/alert.xpm"
@@ -80,7 +80,7 @@ static Widget footer;
 #endif
 #ifdef FEAT_MENU
 # if (XmVersion >= 1002)
-/* remember the last set value for the tearoff item */
+// remember the last set value for the tearoff item
 static int tearoff_val = (int)XmTEAR_OFF_ENABLED;
 # endif
 static Widget menuBar;
@@ -178,10 +178,10 @@ tabline_scroller_clicked(
 	XtVaGetValues(tab_scroll_w, XmNx, &pos_x, XmNy, &pos_y, XmNwidth,
 		      &width, XmNheight, &height, NULL);
 	if (pos_x >= 0) {
-	    /* Tab scroller (next) is visible */
+	    // Tab scroller (next) is visible
 	    if ((event->x >= pos_x) && (event->x <= pos_x + width) &&
 		(event->y >= pos_y) && (event->y <= pos_y + height)) {
-		/* Clicked on the scroller */
+		// Clicked on the scroller
 		return TRUE;
 	    }
 	}
@@ -238,7 +238,7 @@ tabline_menu_cb(
     if (event->button != Button3)
 	return;
 
-    /* When ignoring events don't show the menu. */
+    // When ignoring events don't show the menu.
     if (hold_gui_events
 # ifdef FEAT_CMDWIN
 	    || cmdwin_type != 0
@@ -249,7 +249,7 @@ tabline_menu_cb(
     if (event->subwindow != None)
     {
 	tab_w = XtWindowToWidget(XtDisplay(w), event->subwindow);
-	/* LINTED: avoid warning: dubious operation on enum */
+	// LINTED: avoid warning: dubious operation on enum
 	if (tab_w != (Widget)0 && XmIsPushButton(tab_w))
 	    XtVaGetValues(tab_w, XmNpageNumber, &tab_idx, NULL);
     }
@@ -316,7 +316,7 @@ label_expose(Widget _w, XEvent *_event, 
 
 	_XmFontListGetDefaultFont(lw->label.font, &fs);
 
-	/* FIXME: we should be doing the whole drawing ourself here. */
+	// FIXME: we should be doing the whole drawing ourself here.
 	insensitiveGC = lw->label.insensitive_GC;
 
 	mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
@@ -407,7 +407,7 @@ gui_x11_create_widgets(void)
     XmRepTypeInstallTearOffModelConverter();
 #endif
 
-    /* Make sure the "Quit" menu entry of the window manager is ignored */
+    // Make sure the "Quit" menu entry of the window manager is ignored
     XtVaSetValues(vimShell, XmNdeleteResponse, XmDO_NOTHING, NULL);
 
     vimForm = XtVaCreateManagedWidget("vimForm",
@@ -423,7 +423,7 @@ gui_x11_create_widgets(void)
 
 #ifdef FEAT_MENU
     {
-	Arg al[7]; /* Make sure there is enough room for arguments! */
+	Arg al[7]; // Make sure there is enough room for arguments!
 	int ac = 0;
 
 # if (XmVersion >= 1002)
@@ -433,14 +433,14 @@ gui_x11_create_widgets(void)
 	XtSetArg(al[ac], XmNtopAttachment,   XmATTACH_FORM); ac++;
 	XtSetArg(al[ac], XmNrightAttachment, XmATTACH_FORM); ac++;
 # ifndef FEAT_TOOLBAR
-	/* Always stick to right hand side. */
+	// Always stick to right hand side.
 	XtSetArg(al[ac], XmNrightOffset, 0); ac++;
 # endif
 	XtSetArg(al[ac], XmNmarginHeight, 0); ac++;
 	menuBar = XmCreateMenuBar(vimForm, "menuBar", al, ac);
 	XtManageChild(menuBar);
 
-	/* Remember the default colors, needed for ":hi clear". */
+	// Remember the default colors, needed for ":hi clear".
 	XtVaGetValues(menuBar,
 	    XmNbackground, &gui.menu_def_bg_pixel,
 	    XmNforeground, &gui.menu_def_fg_pixel,
@@ -483,7 +483,7 @@ gui_x11_create_widgets(void)
 #endif
 
 #ifdef FEAT_GUI_TABLINE
-    /* Create the Vim GUI tabline */
+    // Create the Vim GUI tabline
     n = 0;
     XtSetArg(args[n], XmNbindingType, XmNONE); n++;
     XtSetArg(args[n], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); n++;
@@ -603,7 +603,7 @@ gui_x11_create_widgets(void)
      */
     gui_x11_callbacks(textArea, vimForm);
 
-    /* Pretend we don't have input focus, we will get an event if we do. */
+    // Pretend we don't have input focus, we will get an event if we do.
     gui.in_focus = FALSE;
 }
 
@@ -627,7 +627,7 @@ gui_mch_set_text_area_pos(
     int	    h UNUSED)
 {
 #ifdef FEAT_TOOLBAR
-    /* Give keyboard focus to the textArea instead of the toolbar. */
+    // Give keyboard focus to the textArea instead of the toolbar.
     reset_focus();
 #endif
 }
@@ -659,19 +659,19 @@ manage_centered(Widget dialog_child)
     int x, y, win_x, win_y, maxX, maxY;
     Boolean mappedWhenManaged;
 
-    /* Temporarily set value of XmNmappedWhenManaged
-       to stop the dialog from popping up right away */
+    // Temporarily set value of XmNmappedWhenManaged
+    // to stop the dialog from popping up right away
     XtVaGetValues(shell, XmNmappedWhenManaged, &mappedWhenManaged, NULL);
     XtVaSetValues(shell, XmNmappedWhenManaged, False, NULL);
 
     XtManageChild(dialog_child);
 
-    /* Get the pointer position (x, y) */
+    // Get the pointer position (x, y)
     XQueryPointer(XtDisplay(shell), XtWindow(shell), &root, &child,
 		  &x, &y, &win_x, &win_y, &mask);
 
-    /* Translate the pointer position (x, y) into a position for the new
-       window that will place the pointer at its center */
+    // Translate the pointer position (x, y) into a position for the new
+    // window that will place the pointer at its center
     XGetGeometry(XtDisplay(shell), XtWindow(shell), &root, &win_x, &win_y,
 		 &width, &height, &border_width, &depth);
     width += 2 * border_width;
@@ -679,7 +679,7 @@ manage_centered(Widget dialog_child)
     x -= width / 2;
     y -= height / 2;
 
-    /* Ensure that the dialog remains on screen */
+    // Ensure that the dialog remains on screen
     maxX = XtScreen(shell)->width - width;
     maxY = XtScreen(shell)->height - height;
     if (x < 0)
@@ -691,13 +691,13 @@ manage_centered(Widget dialog_child)
     if (y > maxY)
 	y = maxY;
 
-    /* Set desired window position in the DialogShell */
+    // Set desired window position in the DialogShell
     XtVaSetValues(shell, XmNx, x, XmNy, y, NULL);
 
-    /* Map the widget */
+    // Map the widget
     XtMapWidget(shell);
 
-    /* Restore the value of XmNmappedWhenManaged */
+    // Restore the value of XmNmappedWhenManaged
     XtVaSetValues(shell, XmNmappedWhenManaged, mappedWhenManaged, NULL);
 }
 
@@ -712,10 +712,10 @@ gui_motif_create_fontlist(XFontStruct *f
     XmFontList font_list;
 
 # if (XmVersion <= 1001)
-    /* Motif 1.1 method */
+    // Motif 1.1 method
     font_list = XmFontListCreate(font, STRING_TAG);
 # else
-    /* Motif 1.2 method */
+    // Motif 1.2 method
     XmFontListEntry font_list_entry;
 
     font_list_entry = XmFontListEntryCreate(STRING_TAG, XmFONT_IS_FONT,
@@ -732,7 +732,7 @@ gui_motif_fontset2fontlist(XFontSet *fon
 {
     XmFontList font_list;
 
-    /* Motif 1.2 method */
+    // Motif 1.2 method
     XmFontListEntry font_list_entry;
 
     font_list_entry = XmFontListEntryCreate(STRING_TAG,
@@ -770,7 +770,7 @@ gui_mch_enable_menu(int flag)
 #ifdef FEAT_TOOLBAR
 	if (XtIsManaged(XtParent(toolBar)))
 	{
-	    /* toolBar is attached to top form */
+	    // toolBar is attached to top form
 	    XtVaSetValues(XtParent(toolBar),
 		XmNtopAttachment, XmATTACH_WIDGET,
 		XmNtopWidget, menuBar,
@@ -909,8 +909,8 @@ gui_mch_add_menu(vimmenu_T *menu, int id
 	Arg arg[2];
 	int n = 0;
 
-	/* Only create the popup menu when it's actually used, otherwise there
-	 * is a delay when using the right mouse button. */
+	// Only create the popup menu when it's actually used, otherwise there
+	// is a delay when using the right mouse button.
 # if (XmVersion <= 1002)
 	if (mouse_model_popup())
 # endif
@@ -940,7 +940,7 @@ gui_mch_add_menu(vimmenu_T *menu, int id
 	    XmNlabelString, label,
 	    XmNmnemonic, p_wak[0] == 'n' ? NUL : menu->mnemonic,
 #if (XmVersion >= 1002)
-	    /* submenu: count the tearoff item (needed for LessTif) */
+	    // submenu: count the tearoff item (needed for LessTif)
 	    XmNpositionIndex, idx + (parent != NULL
 			   && tearoff_val == (int)XmTEAR_OFF_ENABLED ? 1 : 0),
 #endif
@@ -949,10 +949,10 @@ gui_mch_add_menu(vimmenu_T *menu, int id
     gui_motif_menu_fontlist(menu->id);
     XmStringFree(label);
 
-    if (menu->id == (Widget)0)		/* failed */
+    if (menu->id == (Widget)0)		// failed
 	return;
 
-    /* add accelerator text */
+    // add accelerator text
     gui_motif_add_actext(menu);
 
     shell = XtVaCreateWidget("subMenuShell",
@@ -967,11 +967,11 @@ gui_mch_add_menu(vimmenu_T *menu, int id
 	NULL);
     gui_motif_menu_colors(menu->submenu_id);
 
-    if (menu->submenu_id == (Widget)0)		/* failed */
+    if (menu->submenu_id == (Widget)0)		// failed
 	return;
 
 #if (XmVersion >= 1002)
-    /* Set the colors for the tear off widget */
+    // Set the colors for the tear off widget
     toggle_tearoff(menu->submenu_id);
 #endif
 
@@ -1005,7 +1005,7 @@ gui_motif_add_actext(vimmenu_T *menu)
 {
     XmString	label;
 
-    /* Add accelerator text, if there is one */
+    // Add accelerator text, if there is one
     if (menu->actext != NULL && menu->id != (Widget)0)
     {
 	label = XmStringCreate((char *)menu->actext, STRING_TAG);
@@ -1077,12 +1077,12 @@ gui_mch_text_area_extra_height(void)
  */
     void
 gui_mch_compute_menu_height(
-    Widget	id)		    /* can be NULL when deleting menu */
+    Widget	id)		    // can be NULL when deleting menu
 {
     Dimension	y, maxy;
     Dimension	margin, shadow;
     vimmenu_T	*mp;
-    static Dimension	height = 21;	/* normal height of a menu item */
+    static Dimension	height = 21;	// normal height of a menu item
 
     /*
      * Get the height of the new item, before managing it, because it will
@@ -1092,7 +1092,7 @@ gui_mch_compute_menu_height(
     if (id != (Widget)0)
 	XtVaGetValues(id, XmNheight, &height, NULL);
 
-    /* Find any menu Widget, to be able to call XtManageChild() */
+    // Find any menu Widget, to be able to call XtManageChild()
     else
 	for (mp = root_menu; mp != NULL; mp = mp->next)
 	    if (mp->id != (Widget)0 && menu_is_menubar(mp->name))
@@ -1139,9 +1139,9 @@ gui_mch_compute_menu_height(
      */
     gui.menu_height = maxy + height - 2 * shadow + 2 * margin + 4;
 
-    /* Somehow the menu bar doesn't resize automatically.  Set it here,
-     * even though this is a catch 22.  Don't do this when starting up,
-     * somehow the menu gets very high then. */
+    // Somehow the menu bar doesn't resize automatically.  Set it here,
+    // even though this is a catch 22.  Don't do this when starting up,
+    // somehow the menu gets very high then.
     if (gui.shell_created)
 	XtVaSetValues(menuBar, XmNheight, gui.menu_height, NULL);
 }
@@ -1168,7 +1168,7 @@ check_xpm(char_u *path)
 
     attrs.valuemask = 0;
 
-    /* Create the "sensitive" pixmap */
+    // Create the "sensitive" pixmap
     status = XpmReadFileToPixmap(gui.dpy,
 	    RootWindow(gui.dpy, DefaultScreen(gui.dpy)),
 	    (char *)path, &map, &mask, &attrs);
@@ -1189,20 +1189,20 @@ check_xpm(char_u *path)
     static char **
 get_toolbar_pixmap(vimmenu_T *menu, char **fname)
 {
-    char_u	buf[MAXPATHL];		/* buffer storing expanded pathname */
-    char	**xpm = NULL;		/* xpm array */
+    char_u	buf[MAXPATHL];		// buffer storing expanded pathname
+    char	**xpm = NULL;		// xpm array
     int		res;
 
     *fname = NULL;
-    buf[0] = NUL;			/* start with NULL path */
+    buf[0] = NUL;			// start with NULL path
 
     if (menu->iconfile != NULL)
     {
-	/* Use the "icon="  argument. */
+	// Use the "icon="  argument.
 	gui_find_iconfile(menu->iconfile, buf, "xpm");
 	res = check_xpm(buf);
 
-	/* If it failed, try using the menu name. */
+	// If it failed, try using the menu name.
 	if (res == FAIL && gui_find_bitmap(menu->name, buf, "xpm") == OK)
 	    res = check_xpm(buf);
 	if (res == OK)
@@ -1245,7 +1245,7 @@ add_pixmap_args(vimmenu_T *menu, Arg *ar
     }
     return n;
 }
-#endif /* FEAT_TOOLBAR */
+#endif // FEAT_TOOLBAR
 
     void
 gui_mch_add_menu_item(vimmenu_T *menu, int idx)
@@ -1258,7 +1258,7 @@ gui_mch_add_menu_item(vimmenu_T *menu, i
 # endif
 
 # if (XmVersion <= 1002)
-    /* Don't add Popup menu items when the popup menu isn't used. */
+    // Don't add Popup menu items when the popup menu isn't used.
     if (menu_is_child_of_popup(menu) && !mouse_model_popup())
 	return;
 # endif
@@ -1267,7 +1267,7 @@ gui_mch_add_menu_item(vimmenu_T *menu, i
     if (menu_is_toolbar(parent->name))
     {
 	WidgetClass	type;
-	XmString	xms = NULL;    /* fallback label if pixmap not found */
+	XmString	xms = NULL;    // fallback label if pixmap not found
 	int		n;
 	Arg		args[18];
 
@@ -1295,17 +1295,16 @@ gui_mch_add_menu_item(vimmenu_T *menu, i
 	}
 	else
 	{
-	    /* Without shadows one can't sense whatever the button has been
-	     * pressed or not! However we want to save a bit of space...
-	     * Need the highlightThickness to see the focus.
-	     */
+	    // Without shadows one can't sense whatever the button has been
+	    // pressed or not! However we want to save a bit of space...
+	    // Need the highlightThickness to see the focus.
 	    XtSetArg(args[n], XmNhighlightThickness, 1); n++;
 	    XtSetArg(args[n], XmNhighlightOnEnter, True); n++;
 	    XtSetArg(args[n], XmNmarginWidth, 0); n++;
 	    XtSetArg(args[n], XmNmarginHeight, 0); n++;
 	    XtSetArg(args[n], XmNtraversalOn, False); n++;
-	    /* Set the label here, so that we can switch between icons/text
-	     * by changing the XmNlabelType resource. */
+	    // Set the label here, so that we can switch between icons/text
+	    // by changing the XmNlabelType resource.
 	    xms = XmStringCreate((char *)menu->dname, STRING_TAG);
 	    XtSetArg(args[n], XmNlabelString, xms); n++;
 
@@ -1342,28 +1341,28 @@ gui_mch_add_menu_item(vimmenu_T *menu, i
 
 	menu->parent = parent;
 	menu->submenu_id = NULL;
-	/* When adding first item to toolbar it might have to be enabled .*/
+	// When adding first item to toolbar it might have to be enabled .
 	if (!XtIsManaged(XtParent(toolBar))
 		    && vim_strchr(p_go, GO_TOOLBAR) != NULL)
 	    gui_mch_show_toolbar(TRUE);
 	gui.toolbar_height = gui_mch_compute_toolbar_height();
 	return;
-    } /* toolbar menu item */
+    } // toolbar menu item
 # endif
 
-    /* No parent, must be a non-menubar menu */
+    // No parent, must be a non-menubar menu
     if (parent->submenu_id == (Widget)0)
 	return;
 
     menu->submenu_id = (Widget)0;
 
-    /* Add menu separator */
+    // Add menu separator
     if (menu_is_separator(menu->name))
     {
 	menu->id = XtVaCreateWidget("subMenu",
 		xmSeparatorGadgetClass, parent->submenu_id,
 #if (XmVersion >= 1002)
-		/* count the tearoff item (needed for LessTif) */
+		// count the tearoff item (needed for LessTif)
 		XmNpositionIndex, idx + (tearoff_val == (int)XmTEAR_OFF_ENABLED
 								     ? 1 : 0),
 #endif
@@ -1380,7 +1379,7 @@ gui_mch_add_menu_item(vimmenu_T *menu, i
 	XmNlabelString, label,
 	XmNmnemonic, menu->mnemonic,
 #if (XmVersion >= 1002)
-	/* count the tearoff item (needed for LessTif) */
+	// count the tearoff item (needed for LessTif)
 	XmNpositionIndex, idx + (tearoff_val == (int)XmTEAR_OFF_ENABLED
 								     ? 1 : 0),
 #endif
@@ -1393,7 +1392,7 @@ gui_mch_add_menu_item(vimmenu_T *menu, i
     {
 	XtAddCallback(menu->id, XmNactivateCallback, gui_x11_menu_cb,
 		(XtPointer)menu);
-	/* add accelerator text */
+	// add accelerator text
 	gui_motif_add_actext(menu);
     }
 }
@@ -1410,7 +1409,7 @@ gui_motif_update_mousemodel(vimmenu_T *m
 {
     int		idx = 0;
 
-    /* When GUI hasn't started the menus have not been created. */
+    // When GUI hasn't started the menus have not been created.
     if (!gui.in_use)
       return;
 
@@ -1422,13 +1421,13 @@ gui_motif_update_mousemodel(vimmenu_T *m
 	  {
 	      if (mouse_model_popup())
 	      {
-		  /* Popup menu will be used.  Create the popup menus. */
+		  // Popup menu will be used.  Create the popup menus.
 		  gui_mch_add_menu(menu, idx);
 		  gui_motif_update_mousemodel(menu->children);
 	      }
 	      else
 	      {
-		  /* Popup menu will not be used.  Destroy the popup menus. */
+		  // Popup menu will not be used.  Destroy the popup menus.
 		  gui_motif_update_mousemodel(menu->children);
 		  gui_mch_destroy_menu(menu);
 	      }
@@ -1520,7 +1519,7 @@ gui_mch_new_tooltip_colors(void)
     static void
 submenu_change(
     vimmenu_T	*menu,
-    int		colors)		/* TRUE for colors, FALSE for font */
+    int		colors)		// TRUE for colors, FALSE for font
 {
     vimmenu_T	*mp;
 
@@ -1532,8 +1531,8 @@ submenu_change(
 	    {
 		gui_motif_menu_colors(mp->id);
 #ifdef FEAT_TOOLBAR
-		/* For a toolbar item: Free the pixmap and allocate a new one,
-		 * so that the background color is right. */
+		// For a toolbar item: Free the pixmap and allocate a new one,
+		// so that the background color is right.
 		if (mp->xpm != NULL)
 		{
 		    int		n = 0;
@@ -1543,7 +1542,7 @@ submenu_change(
 		    XtSetValues(mp->id, args, n);
 		}
 # ifdef FEAT_BEVAL_GUI
-		/* If we have a tooltip, then we need to change its font */
+		// If we have a tooltip, then we need to change its font
 		if (mp->tip != NULL)
 		{
 		    Arg args[2];
@@ -1561,7 +1560,7 @@ submenu_change(
 	    {
 		gui_motif_menu_fontlist(mp->id);
 #ifdef FEAT_BEVAL_GUI
-		/* If we have a tooltip, then we need to change its font */
+		// If we have a tooltip, then we need to change its font
 		if (mp->tip != NULL)
 		{
 		    Arg args[1];
@@ -1578,7 +1577,7 @@ submenu_change(
 	if (mp->children != NULL)
 	{
 #if (XmVersion >= 1002)
-	    /* Set the colors/font for the tear off widget */
+	    // Set the colors/font for the tear off widget
 	    if (mp->submenu_id != (Widget)0)
 	    {
 		if (colors)
@@ -1588,7 +1587,7 @@ submenu_change(
 		toggle_tearoff(mp->submenu_id);
 	    }
 #endif
-	    /* Set the colors for the children */
+	    // Set the colors for the children
 	    submenu_change(mp->children, colors);
 	}
     }
@@ -1600,13 +1599,12 @@ submenu_change(
     void
 gui_mch_destroy_menu(vimmenu_T *menu)
 {
-    /* Please be sure to destroy the parent widget first (i.e. menu->id).
-     * On the other hand, problems have been reported that the submenu must be
-     * deleted first...
-     *
-     * This code should be basically identical to that in the file gui_athena.c
-     * because they are both Xt based.
-     */
+    // Please be sure to destroy the parent widget first (i.e. menu->id).
+    // On the other hand, problems have been reported that the submenu must be
+    // deleted first...
+    //
+    // This code should be basically identical to that in the file gui_athena.c
+    // because they are both Xt based.
     if (menu->submenu_id != (Widget)0)
     {
 	XtDestroyWidget(menu->submenu_id);
@@ -1621,15 +1619,14 @@ gui_mch_destroy_menu(vimmenu_T *menu)
 #if defined(FEAT_TOOLBAR) && defined(FEAT_BEVAL_GUI)
 	if (parent == toolBar && menu->tip != NULL)
 	{
-	    /* We try to destroy this before the actual menu, because there are
-	     * callbacks, etc. that will be unregistered during the tooltip
-	     * destruction.
-	     *
-	     * If you call "gui_mch_destroy_beval_area()" after destroying
-	     * menu->id, then the tooltip's window will have already been
-	     * deallocated by Xt, and unknown behaviour will ensue (probably
-	     * a core dump).
-	     */
+	    // We try to destroy this before the actual menu, because there are
+	    // callbacks, etc. that will be unregistered during the tooltip
+	    // destruction.
+	    //
+	    // If you call "gui_mch_destroy_beval_area()" after destroying
+	    // menu->id, then the tooltip's window will have already been
+	    // deallocated by Xt, and unknown behaviour will ensue (probably
+	    // a core dump).
 	    gui_mch_destroy_beval_area(menu->tip);
 	    menu->tip = NULL;
 	}
@@ -1643,7 +1640,7 @@ gui_mch_destroy_menu(vimmenu_T *menu)
 	{
 	    Cardinal    num_children;
 
-	    /* When removing last toolbar item, don't display the toolbar. */
+	    // When removing last toolbar item, don't display the toolbar.
 	    XtVaGetValues(toolBar, XmNnumChildren, &num_children, NULL);
 	    if (num_children == 0)
 		gui_mch_show_toolbar(FALSE);
@@ -1663,7 +1660,7 @@ gui_mch_show_popupmenu(vimmenu_T *menu U
 #endif
 }
 
-#endif /* FEAT_MENU */
+#endif // FEAT_MENU
 
 /*
  * Set the menu and scrollbar colors to their default values.
@@ -1673,8 +1670,8 @@ gui_mch_def_colors(void)
 {
     if (gui.in_use)
     {
-	/* Use the values saved when starting up.  These should come from the
-	 * window manager or a resources file. */
+	// Use the values saved when starting up.  These should come from the
+	// window manager or a resources file.
 	gui.menu_fg_pixel = gui.menu_def_fg_pixel;
 	gui.menu_bg_pixel = gui.menu_def_bg_pixel;
 	gui.scroll_fg_pixel = gui.scroll_def_fg_pixel;
@@ -1705,7 +1702,7 @@ gui_mch_set_scrollbar_thumb(
 		  XmNvalue, val,
 		  XmNsliderSize, size,
 		  XmNpageIncrement, (size > 2 ? size - 2 : 1),
-		  XmNmaximum, max + 1,	    /* Motif has max one past the end */
+		  XmNmaximum, max + 1,	    // Motif has max one past the end
 		  NULL);
 }
 
@@ -1775,8 +1772,8 @@ gui_mch_enable_scrollbar(scrollbar_T *sb
 	{
 	    if (!gui.which_scrollbars[sb->type])
 	    {
-		/* The scrollbars of this type are all disabled, adjust the
-		 * textArea attachment offset. */
+		// The scrollbars of this type are all disabled, adjust the
+		// textArea attachment offset.
 		switch (sb->type)
 		{
 		    case SBAR_LEFT:
@@ -1801,7 +1798,7 @@ gui_mch_enable_scrollbar(scrollbar_T *sb
     void
 gui_mch_create_scrollbar(
     scrollbar_T *sb,
-    int		orient)	/* SBAR_VERT or SBAR_HORIZ */
+    int		orient)	// SBAR_VERT or SBAR_HORIZ
 {
     Arg		args[16];
     int		n;
@@ -1835,7 +1832,7 @@ gui_mch_create_scrollbar(
     sb->id = XtCreateWidget("scrollBar",
 	    xmScrollBarWidgetClass, textAreaForm, args, n);
 
-    /* Remember the default colors, needed for ":hi clear". */
+    // Remember the default colors, needed for ":hi clear".
     if (gui.scroll_def_bg_pixel == (guicolor_T)0
 	    && gui.scroll_def_fg_pixel == (guicolor_T)0)
 	XtVaGetValues(sb->id,
@@ -1887,7 +1884,7 @@ gui_mch_set_scrollbar_colors(scrollbar_T
 		    NULL);
     }
 
-    /* This is needed for the rectangle below the vertical scrollbars. */
+    // This is needed for the rectangle below the vertical scrollbars.
     if (sb == &gui.bottom_sbar && textAreaForm != (Widget)0)
 	gui_motif_scroll_colors(textAreaForm);
 }
@@ -2082,8 +2079,8 @@ set_fontlist(Widget id)
 	    {
 		XtUnmanageChild(id);
 		XtVaSetValues(id, XmNfontList, fl, NULL);
-		/* We should force the widget to recalculate its
-		 * geometry now. */
+		// We should force the widget to recalculate its
+		// geometry now.
 		XtManageChild(id);
 	    }
 	    else
@@ -2101,8 +2098,8 @@ set_fontlist(Widget id)
 	    {
 		XtUnmanageChild(id);
 		XtVaSetValues(id, XmNfontList, fl, NULL);
-		/* We should force the widget to recalculate its
-		 * geometry now. */
+		// We should force the widget to recalculate its
+		// geometry now.
 		XtManageChild(id);
 	    }
 	    else
@@ -2125,14 +2122,14 @@ set_fontlist(Widget id)
 
 typedef struct dialog_callback_arg
 {
-    char *  args;   /* not used right now */
+    char *  args;   // not used right now
     int	    id;
 } dcbarg_T;
 
 static Widget dialog_wgt;
 static char *browse_fname = NULL;
 static XmStringCharSet charset = (XmStringCharSet) XmSTRING_DEFAULT_CHARSET;
-				/* used to set up XmStrings */
+				// used to set up XmStrings
 
 static void DialogCancelCB(Widget, XtPointer, XtPointer);
 static void DialogAcceptCB(Widget, XtPointer, XtPointer);
@@ -2208,22 +2205,21 @@ set_predefined_fontlist(Widget parent, S
  */
     char_u *
 gui_mch_browse(
-    int		saving UNUSED,	/* select file to write */
-    char_u	*title,		/* title for the window */
-    char_u	*dflt,		/* default name */
-    char_u	*ext UNUSED,	/* not used (extension added) */
-    char_u	*initdir,	/* initial directory, NULL for current dir */
-    char_u	*filter)	/* file name filter */
+    int		saving UNUSED,	// select file to write
+    char_u	*title,		// title for the window
+    char_u	*dflt,		// default name
+    char_u	*ext UNUSED,	// not used (extension added)
+    char_u	*initdir,	// initial directory, NULL for current dir
+    char_u	*filter)	// file name filter
 {
     char_u	dirbuf[MAXPATHL];
     char_u	dfltbuf[MAXPATHL];
     char_u	*pattern;
     char_u	*tofree = NULL;
 
-    /* There a difference between the resource name and value, Therefore, we
-     * avoid to (ab-)use the (maybe internationalized!) dialog title as a
-     * dialog name.
-     */
+    // There a difference between the resource name and value, Therefore, we
+    // avoid to (ab-)use the (maybe internationalized!) dialog title as a
+    // dialog name.
 
     dialog_wgt = XmCreateFileSelectionDialog(vimShell, "browseDialog", NULL, 0);
 
@@ -2237,16 +2233,16 @@ gui_mch_browse(
 	dflt = (char_u *)"";
     else if (STRLEN(initdir) + STRLEN(dflt) + 2 < MAXPATHL)
     {
-	/* The default selection should be the full path, "dflt" is only the
-	 * file name. */
+	// The default selection should be the full path, "dflt" is only the
+	// file name.
 	STRCPY(dfltbuf, initdir);
 	add_pathsep(dfltbuf);
 	STRCAT(dfltbuf, dflt);
 	dflt = dfltbuf;
     }
 
-    /* Can only use one pattern for a file name.  Get the first pattern out of
-     * the filter.  An empty pattern means everything matches. */
+    // Can only use one pattern for a file name.  Get the first pattern out of
+    // the filter.  An empty pattern means everything matches.
     if (filter == NULL)
 	pattern = (char_u *)"";
     else
@@ -2256,9 +2252,9 @@ gui_mch_browse(
 	s = filter;
 	for (p = filter; *p != NUL; ++p)
 	{
-	    if (*p == '\t')	/* end of description, start of pattern */
+	    if (*p == '\t')	// end of description, start of pattern
 		s = p + 1;
-	    if (*p == ';' || *p == '\n')	/* end of (first) pattern */
+	    if (*p == ';' || *p == '\n')	// end of (first) pattern
 		break;
 	}
 	pattern = vim_strnsave(s, p - s);
@@ -2287,9 +2283,8 @@ gui_mch_browse(
     set_predefined_label(dialog_wgt, "OK", _("&OK"));
     set_predefined_label(dialog_wgt, "Selection", _("Selection"));
 
-    /* This is to save us from silly external settings using not fixed with
-     * fonts for file selection.
-     */
+    // This is to save us from silly external settings using not fixed with
+    // fonts for file selection.
     set_predefined_fontlist(dialog_wgt, "DirListSW.DirList");
     set_predefined_fontlist(dialog_wgt, "ItemsListSW.ItemsList");
 
@@ -2299,14 +2294,14 @@ gui_mch_browse(
 
     XtAddCallback(dialog_wgt, XmNokCallback, DialogAcceptCB, (XtPointer)0);
     XtAddCallback(dialog_wgt, XmNcancelCallback, DialogCancelCB, (XtPointer)0);
-    /* We have no help in this window, so hide help button */
+    // We have no help in this window, so hide help button
     XtUnmanageChild(XmFileSelectionBoxGetChild(dialog_wgt,
 					(unsigned char)XmDIALOG_HELP_BUTTON));
 
     manage_centered(dialog_wgt);
     activate_dialog_mnemonics(dialog_wgt);
 
-    /* sit in a loop until the dialog box has gone away */
+    // sit in a loop until the dialog box has gone away
     do
     {
 	XtAppProcessEvent(XtWidgetToApplicationContext(dialog_wgt),
@@ -2333,9 +2328,9 @@ gui_mch_browse(
  */
     static void
 DialogCancelCB(
-    Widget	w UNUSED,		/*  widget id		*/
-    XtPointer	client_data UNUSED,	/*  data from application   */
-    XtPointer	call_data UNUSED)	/*  data from widget class  */
+    Widget	w UNUSED,		//  widget id
+    XtPointer	client_data UNUSED,	//  data from application
+    XtPointer	call_data UNUSED)	//  data from widget class
 {
     if (browse_fname != NULL)
     {
@@ -2350,9 +2345,9 @@ DialogCancelCB(
  */
     static void
 DialogAcceptCB(
-    Widget	w UNUSED,		/*  widget id		*/
-    XtPointer	client_data UNUSED,	/*  data from application   */
-    XtPointer	call_data)		/*  data from widget class  */
+    Widget	w UNUSED,		//  widget id
+    XtPointer	client_data UNUSED,	//  data from application
+    XtPointer	call_data)		//  data from widget class
 {
     XmFileSelectionBoxCallbackStruct *fcb;
 
@@ -2363,14 +2358,14 @@ DialogAcceptCB(
     }
     fcb = (XmFileSelectionBoxCallbackStruct *)call_data;
 
-    /* get the filename from the file selection box */
+    // get the filename from the file selection box
     XmStringGetLtoR(fcb->value, charset, &browse_fname);
 
-    /* popdown the file selection box */
+    // popdown the file selection box
     XtUnmanageChild(dialog_wgt);
 }
 
-#endif /* FEAT_BROWSE */
+#endif // FEAT_BROWSE
 
 #if defined(FEAT_GUI_DIALOG) || defined(PROTO)
 
@@ -2483,7 +2478,7 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     char_u	*message,
     char_u	*button_names,
     int		dfltbutton,
-    char_u	*textfield,		/* buffer of size IOSIZE */
+    char_u	*textfield,		// buffer of size IOSIZE
     int		ex_cmd UNUSED)
 {
     char_u		*buts;
@@ -2509,15 +2504,15 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     if (title == NULL)
 	title = (char_u *)_("Vim dialog");
 
-    /* if our pointer is currently hidden, then we should show it. */
+    // if our pointer is currently hidden, then we should show it.
     gui_mch_mousehide(FALSE);
 
     dialogform = XmCreateFormDialog(vimShell, (char *)"dialog", NULL, 0);
 
-    /* Check 'v' flag in 'guioptions': vertical button placement. */
+    // Check 'v' flag in 'guioptions': vertical button placement.
     vertical = (vim_strchr(p_go, GO_VERTICAL) != NULL);
 
-    /* Set the title of the Dialog window */
+    // Set the title of the Dialog window
     label = XmStringCreateSimple((char *)title);
     if (label == NULL)
 	return -1;
@@ -2528,12 +2523,12 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 	    NULL);
     XmStringFree(label);
 
-    /* make a copy, so that we can insert NULs */
+    // make a copy, so that we can insert NULs
     buts = vim_strsave(button_names);
     if (buts == NULL)
 	return -1;
 
-    /* Count the number of buttons and allocate buttons[]. */
+    // Count the number of buttons and allocate buttons[].
     butcount = 1;
     for (p = buts; *p; ++p)
 	if (*p == DLG_BUTTON_SEP)
@@ -2588,7 +2583,7 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 	XmStringFree(label);
 	gui_motif_menu_fontlist(buttons[butcount]);
 
-	/* Layout properly. */
+	// Layout properly.
 
 	if (butcount > 0)
 	{
@@ -2605,7 +2600,7 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 			    XmNrightOffset, 4,
 			    NULL);
 
-		    /* fill in a form as invisible separator */
+		    // fill in a form as invisible separator
 		    sep_form = XtVaCreateWidget("separatorForm",
 			    xmFormWidgetClass,	dialogform,
 			    XmNleftAttachment, XmATTACH_WIDGET,
@@ -2635,7 +2630,7 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 			XmNrightOffset, 4,
 			NULL);
 
-		/* fill in a form as invisible separator */
+		// fill in a form as invisible separator
 		sep_form = XtVaCreateWidget("separatorForm",
 			xmFormWidgetClass, dialogform,
 			XmNleftAttachment, XmATTACH_FORM,
@@ -2663,7 +2658,7 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     separator = (Widget) 0;
     if (butcount > 0)
     {
-	/* Create the separator for beauty. */
+	// Create the separator for beauty.
 	n = 0;
 	XtSetArg(args[n], XmNorientation, XmHORIZONTAL); n++;
 	XtSetArg(args[n], XmNbottomAttachment, XmATTACH_WIDGET); n++;
@@ -2699,7 +2694,7 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 			    (XtEventHandler)keyhit_callback, (XtPointer)NULL);
     }
 
-    /* Form holding both message and pixmap labels */
+    // Form holding both message and pixmap labels
     form = XtVaCreateWidget("separatorForm",
 	    xmFormWidgetClass, dialogform,
 	    XmNleftAttachment, XmATTACH_FORM,
@@ -2709,7 +2704,7 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     XtManageChild(form);
 
 #ifdef HAVE_XPM
-    /* Add a pixmap, left of the message. */
+    // Add a pixmap, left of the message.
     switch (type)
     {
 	case VIM_GENERIC:
@@ -2744,12 +2739,11 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     XtManageChild(dialogpixmap);
 #endif
 
-    /* Create the dialog message.
-     * Since LessTif is apparently having problems with the creation of
-     * properly localized string, we use LtoR here. The symptom is that the
-     * string sill not show properly in multiple lines as it does in native
-     * Motif.
-     */
+    // Create the dialog message.
+    // Since LessTif is apparently having problems with the creation of
+    // properly localized string, we use LtoR here. The symptom is that the
+    // string sill not show properly in multiple lines as it does in native
+    // Motif.
     label = XmStringCreateLtoR((char *)message, STRING_TAG);
     if (label == NULL)
 	return -1;
@@ -2811,7 +2805,7 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 
     if (textfield != NULL && *textfield != NUL)
     {
-	/* This only works after the textfield has been realised. */
+	// This only works after the textfield has been realised.
 	XmTextFieldSetSelection(dialogtextfield,
 			 (XmTextPosition)0, (XmTextPosition)STRLEN(textfield),
 					   XtLastTimestampProcessed(gui.dpy));
@@ -2821,7 +2815,7 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 
     app = XtWidgetToApplicationContext(dialogform);
 
-    /* Loop until a button is pressed or the dialog is killed somehow. */
+    // Loop until a button is pressed or the dialog is killed somehow.
     dialogStatus = -1;
     for (;;)
     {
@@ -2847,17 +2841,17 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 
     return dialogStatus;
 }
-#endif /* FEAT_GUI_DIALOG */
+#endif // FEAT_GUI_DIALOG
 
 #if defined(FEAT_FOOTER) || defined(PROTO)
 
     static int
 gui_mch_compute_footer_height(void)
 {
-    Dimension	height;		    /* total Toolbar height */
-    Dimension	top;		    /* XmNmarginTop */
-    Dimension	bottom;		    /* XmNmarginBottom */
-    Dimension	shadow;		    /* XmNshadowThickness */
+    Dimension	height;		    // total Toolbar height
+    Dimension	top;		    // XmNmarginTop
+    Dimension	bottom;		    // XmNmarginBottom
+    Dimension	shadow;		    // XmNshadowThickness
 
     XtVaGetValues(footer,
 	    XmNheight, &height,
@@ -2905,16 +2899,15 @@ gui_mch_set_footer(char_u *s)
     void
 gui_mch_show_toolbar(int showit)
 {
-    Cardinal	numChildren;	    /* how many children toolBar has */
+    Cardinal	numChildren;	    // how many children toolBar has
 
     if (toolBar == (Widget)0)
 	return;
     XtVaGetValues(toolBar, XmNnumChildren, &numChildren, NULL);
     if (showit && numChildren > 0)
     {
-	/* Assume that we want to show the toolbar if p_toolbar contains
-	 * valid option settings, therefore p_toolbar must not be NULL.
-	 */
+	// Assume that we want to show the toolbar if p_toolbar contains
+	// valid option settings, therefore p_toolbar must not be NULL.
 	WidgetList  children;
 
 	XtVaGetValues(toolBar, XmNchildren, &children, NULL);
@@ -2938,12 +2931,11 @@ gui_mch_show_toolbar(int showit)
 		for (toolbar = root_menu; toolbar; toolbar = toolbar->next)
 		    if (menu_is_toolbar(toolbar->dname))
 			break;
-		/* Assumption: toolbar is NULL if there is no toolbar,
-		 *	       otherwise it contains the toolbar menu structure.
-		 *
-		 * Assumption: "numChildren" == the number of items in the list
-		 *	       of items beginning with toolbar->children.
-		 */
+		// Assumption: toolbar is NULL if there is no toolbar,
+		//	       otherwise it contains the toolbar menu structure.
+		//
+		// Assumption: "numChildren" == the number of items in the list
+		//	       of items beginning with toolbar->children.
 		if (toolbar)
 		{
 		    for (cur = toolbar->children; cur; cur = cur->next)
@@ -2951,8 +2943,8 @@ gui_mch_show_toolbar(int showit)
 			Arg	    args[1];
 			int	    n = 0;
 
-			/* Enable/Disable tooltip (OK to enable while
-			 * currently enabled). */
+			// Enable/Disable tooltip (OK to enable while
+			// currently enabled).
 			if (cur->tip != NULL)
 			    (*action)(cur->tip);
 			if (!menu_is_separator(cur->name))
@@ -3068,16 +3060,16 @@ reset_focus(void)
 gui_mch_compute_toolbar_height(void)
 {
     Dimension	borders;
-    Dimension	height;		    /* total Toolbar height */
-    Dimension	whgt;		    /* height of each widget */
-    WidgetList	children;	    /* list of toolBar's children */
-    Cardinal	numChildren;	    /* how many children toolBar has */
+    Dimension	height;		    // total Toolbar height
+    Dimension	whgt;		    // height of each widget
+    WidgetList	children;	    // list of toolBar's children
+    Cardinal	numChildren;	    // how many children toolBar has
     int		i;
 
     borders = 0;
     height = 0;
     if (toolBar != (Widget)0 && toolBarFrame != (Widget)0)
-    {				    /* get height of XmFrame parent */
+    {				    // get height of XmFrame parent
 	Dimension	fst;
 	Dimension	fmh;
 	Dimension	tst;
@@ -3103,7 +3095,7 @@ gui_mch_compute_toolbar_height(void)
 	}
     }
 #ifdef LESSTIF_VERSION
-    /* Hack: When starting up we get wrong dimensions. */
+    // Hack: When starting up we get wrong dimensions.
     if (height < 10)
 	height = 24;
 #endif
@@ -3256,7 +3248,7 @@ gui_mch_update_tabline(void)
     if (tabLine == (Widget)0)
 	return;
 
-    /* Add a label for each tab page.  They all contain the same text area. */
+    // Add a label for each tab page.  They all contain the same text area.
     for (tp = first_tabpage; tp != NULL; tp = tp->tp_next, ++nr)
     {
 	if (tp == curtab)
@@ -3266,7 +3258,7 @@ gui_mch_update_tabline(void)
 	if (page_status == XmPAGE_INVALID
 		|| page_info.major_tab_widget == (Widget)0)
 	{
-	    /* Add the tab */
+	    // Add the tab
 	    n = 0;
 	    XtSetArg(args[n], XmNnotebookChildType, XmMAJOR_TAB); n++;
 	    XtSetArg(args[n], XmNtraversalOn, False); n++;
@@ -3309,7 +3301,7 @@ gui_mch_update_tabline(void)
 
     XtVaGetValues(tabLine, XmNlastPageNumber, &last_page, NULL);
 
-    /* Remove any old labels. */
+    // Remove any old labels.
     while (nr <= last_page)
     {
 	if (XmNotebookGetPageInfo(tabLine, nr, &page_info) != XmPAGE_INVALID
@@ -3400,8 +3392,8 @@ gui_motif_menu_fontlist(Widget id UNUSED
 	    {
 		XtUnmanageChild(id);
 		XtVaSetValues(id, XmNfontList, fl, NULL);
-		/* We should force the widget to recalculate its
-		 * geometry now. */
+		// We should force the widget to recalculate its
+		// geometry now.
 		XtManageChild(id);
 	    }
 	    else
@@ -3421,8 +3413,8 @@ gui_motif_menu_fontlist(Widget id UNUSED
 	    {
 		XtUnmanageChild(id);
 		XtVaSetValues(id, XmNfontList, fl, NULL);
-		/* We should force the widget to recalculate its
-		 * geometry now. */
+		// We should force the widget to recalculate its
+		// geometry now.
 		XtManageChild(id);
 	    }
 	    else
@@ -3441,17 +3433,17 @@ gui_motif_menu_fontlist(Widget id UNUSED
 
 typedef struct _SharedFindReplace
 {
-    Widget dialog;	/* the main dialog widget */
-    Widget wword;	/* 'Exact match' check button */
-    Widget mcase;	/* 'match case' check button */
-    Widget up;		/* search direction 'Up' radio button */
-    Widget down;	/* search direction 'Down' radio button */
-    Widget what;	/* 'Find what' entry text widget */
-    Widget with;	/* 'Replace with' entry text widget */
-    Widget find;	/* 'Find Next' action button */
-    Widget replace;	/* 'Replace With' action button */
-    Widget all;		/* 'Replace All' action button */
-    Widget undo;	/* 'Undo' action button */
+    Widget dialog;	// the main dialog widget
+    Widget wword;	// 'Exact match' check button
+    Widget mcase;	// 'match case' check button
+    Widget up;		// search direction 'Up' radio button
+    Widget down;	// search direction 'Down' radio button
+    Widget what;	// 'Find what' entry text widget
+    Widget with;	// 'Replace with' entry text widget
+    Widget find;	// 'Find Next' action button
+    Widget replace;	// 'Replace With' action button
+    Widget all;		// 'Replace All' action button
+    Widget undo;	// 'Undo' action button
 
     Widget cancel;
 } SharedFindReplace;
@@ -3468,7 +3460,7 @@ find_replace_destroy_callback(
     SharedFindReplace *cd = (SharedFindReplace *)client_data;
 
     if (cd != NULL)
-       /* suppress_dialog_mnemonics(cd->dialog); */
+       // suppress_dialog_mnemonics(cd->dialog);
 	cd->dialog = (Widget)0;
 }
 
@@ -3510,7 +3502,7 @@ find_replace_callback(
     {
 	char_u	*save_cpo = p_cpo;
 
-	/* No need to be Vi compatible here. */
+	// No need to be Vi compatible here.
 	p_cpo = (char_u *)"";
 	u_undo(1);
 	p_cpo = save_cpo;
@@ -3518,7 +3510,7 @@ find_replace_callback(
 	return;
     }
 
-    /* Get the search/replace strings from the dialog */
+    // Get the search/replace strings from the dialog
     if (flags == FRD_FINDNEXT)
     {
 	repl_text = NULL;
@@ -3560,7 +3552,7 @@ find_replace_keypress(
 
     keysym = XLookupKeysym(event, 0);
 
-    /* the scape key pops the whole dialog down */
+    // the scape key pops the whole dialog down
     if (keysym == XK_Escape)
 	XtUnmanageChild(frdp->dialog);
 }
@@ -3625,15 +3617,15 @@ find_replace_dialog_create(char_u *arg, 
 
     frdp = do_replace ? &repl_widgets : &find_widgets;
 
-    /* Get the search string to use. */
+    // Get the search string to use.
     entry_text = get_find_dialog_text(arg, &wword, &mcase);
 
-    /* If the dialog already exists, just raise it. */
+    // If the dialog already exists, just raise it.
     if (frdp->dialog)
     {
 	gui_motif_synch_fonts();
 
-	/* If the window is already up, just pop it to the top */
+	// If the window is already up, just pop it to the top
 	if (XtIsManaged(frdp->dialog))
 	    XMapRaised(XtDisplay(frdp->dialog),
 					    XtWindow(XtParent(frdp->dialog)));
@@ -3650,7 +3642,7 @@ find_replace_dialog_create(char_u *arg, 
 	return;
     }
 
-    /* Create a fresh new dialog window */
+    // Create a fresh new dialog window
     if (do_replace)
 	 str = XmStringCreateSimple(_("VIM - Search and Replace..."));
     else
@@ -3832,8 +3824,7 @@ find_replace_dialog_create(char_u *arg, 
 			    (XtEventHandler)find_replace_keypress,
 			    (XtPointer)frdp);
 
-	/* Get the maximum width between the label widgets and line them up.
-	 */
+	// Get the maximum width between the label widgets and line them up.
 	n = 0;
 	XtSetArg(args[n], XmNwidth, &width); n++;
 	XtGetValues(label_what, args, n);
@@ -3990,15 +3981,15 @@ gui_motif_synch_fonts(void)
     XFontStruct	    *font;
     XmFontList	    font_list;
 
-    /* FIXME: Unless we find out how to create a XmFontList from a XFontSet,
-     * we just give up here on font synchronization. */
+    // FIXME: Unless we find out how to create a XmFontList from a XFontSet,
+    // we just give up here on font synchronization.
     font = (XFontStruct *)gui.norm_font;
     if (font == NULL)
 	return;
 
     font_list = gui_motif_create_fontlist(font);
 
-    /* OK this loop is a bit tricky... */
+    // OK this loop is a bit tricky...
     for (do_replace = 0; do_replace <= 1; ++do_replace)
     {
 	frdp = (do_replace) ? (&repl_widgets) : (&find_widgets);
--- a/src/gui_photon.c
+++ b/src/gui_photon.c
@@ -13,7 +13,7 @@
 
 #include "vim.h"
 
-/* cproto fails on missing include files */
+// cproto fails on missing include files
 #ifndef PROTO
 # ifdef FEAT_TOOLBAR
 #  include <photon/PxImage.h>
@@ -21,7 +21,7 @@
 #endif
 
 #if !defined(__QNX__)
-/* Used when generating prototypes. */
+// Used when generating prototypes.
 # define PgColor_t	int
 # define PhEvent_t	int
 # define PhPoint_t	int
@@ -39,11 +39,11 @@
 
 #define EVENT_BUFFER_SIZE sizeof(PhEvent_t) + 1000
 
-/* Some defines for gui_mch_mousehide() */
+// Some defines for gui_mch_mousehide()
 #define MOUSE_HIDE		TRUE
 #define MOUSE_SHOW		FALSE
 
-/* Optional support for using a PtPanelGroup widget, needs work */
+// Optional support for using a PtPanelGroup widget, needs work
 #undef USE_PANEL_GROUP
 
 #ifdef USE_PANEL_GROUP
@@ -53,15 +53,15 @@ static ushort_t	num_panels = 0;
 static short pg_margin_left, pg_margin_right, pg_margin_top, pg_margin_bottom;
 #endif
 
-#define GUI_PH_MARGIN		4	/* Size of the bevel */
+#define GUI_PH_MARGIN		4	// Size of the bevel
 
 #define GUI_PH_MOUSE_TYPE		Ph_CURSOR_INSERT
 static PgColor_t gui_ph_mouse_color =	Pg_BLACK;
 
 static PhPoint_t    gui_ph_raw_offset;
-static PtWidget_t   *gui_ph_timer_cursor;   /* handle cursor blinking */
-static PtWidget_t   *gui_ph_timer_timeout;  /* used in gui_mch_wait_for_chars */
-static short	    is_timeout;		    /* Has the timeout occurred? */
+static PtWidget_t   *gui_ph_timer_cursor;   // handle cursor blinking
+static PtWidget_t   *gui_ph_timer_timeout;  // used in gui_mch_wait_for_chars
+static short	    is_timeout;		    // Has the timeout occurred?
 
 /*
  * This is set inside the mouse callback for a right mouse
@@ -69,10 +69,10 @@ static short	    is_timeout;		    /* Has
  */
 static PhPoint_t    abs_mouse;
 
-/* Try and avoid redraws while a resize is in progress */
+// Try and avoid redraws while a resize is in progress
 static int is_ignore_draw = FALSE;
 
-/* Used for converting to/from utf-8 and other charsets */
+// Used for converting to/from utf-8 and other charsets
 static struct PxTransCtrl *charset_translate;
 
 /*
@@ -160,23 +160,23 @@ static struct
     {Pk_KP_Multiply,'K', '9'},
     {Pk_KP_Enter,   'K', 'A'},
 
-    {Pk_KP_0,	    KS_EXTRA, KE_KINS}, /* Insert    */
-    {Pk_KP_Decimal, KS_EXTRA, KE_KDEL}, /* Delete    */
-
-    {Pk_KP_4,	    'k', 'l'}, /* Left	    */
-    {Pk_KP_6,	    'k', 'r'}, /* Right	    */
-    {Pk_KP_8,	    'k', 'u'}, /* Up	    */
-    {Pk_KP_2,	    'k', 'd'}, /* Down	    */
-
-    {Pk_KP_7,	    'K', '1'}, /* Home	    */
-    {Pk_KP_1,	    'K', '4'}, /* End	    */
-
-    {Pk_KP_9,	    'K', '3'}, /* Page Up   */
-    {Pk_KP_3,	    'K', '5'}, /* Page Down */
-
-    {Pk_KP_5,	    '&', '8'}, /* Undo	    */
-
-    /* Keys that we want to be able to use any modifier with: */
+    {Pk_KP_0,	    KS_EXTRA, KE_KINS}, // Insert
+    {Pk_KP_Decimal, KS_EXTRA, KE_KDEL}, // Delete
+
+    {Pk_KP_4,	    'k', 'l'}, // Left
+    {Pk_KP_6,	    'k', 'r'}, // Right
+    {Pk_KP_8,	    'k', 'u'}, // Up
+    {Pk_KP_2,	    'k', 'd'}, // Down
+
+    {Pk_KP_7,	    'K', '1'}, // Home
+    {Pk_KP_1,	    'K', '4'}, // End
+
+    {Pk_KP_9,	    'K', '3'}, // Page Up
+    {Pk_KP_3,	    'K', '5'}, // Page Down
+
+    {Pk_KP_5,	    '&', '8'}, // Undo
+
+    // Keys that we want to be able to use any modifier with:
     {Pk_Return,	    CAR,  NUL},
     {Pk_space,	    ' ', NUL},
     {Pk_Tab,	    TAB, NUL},
@@ -184,12 +184,12 @@ static struct
     {NL,	    NL,	 NUL},
     {CAR,	    CAR,  NUL},
 
-    /* End of list marker: */
+    // End of list marker:
     {0,		0, 0}
 };
 
 
-/****************************************************************************/
+////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
 
 static PtCallbackF_t gui_ph_handle_timer_cursor;
 static PtCallbackF_t gui_ph_handle_timer_timeout;
@@ -201,11 +201,11 @@ static PtCallbackF_t gui_ph_handle_keybo
 static PtCallbackF_t gui_ph_handle_mouse;
 static PtCallbackF_t gui_ph_handle_pulldown_menu;
 static PtCallbackF_t gui_ph_handle_menu;
-static PtCallbackF_t gui_ph_handle_focus;	/* focus change of text area */
+static PtCallbackF_t gui_ph_handle_focus;	// focus change of text area
 
 static PtCallbackF_t gui_ph_handle_menu_resize;
 
-/* When a menu is unrealized, give focus back to vimTextArea */
+// When a menu is unrealized, give focus back to vimTextArea
 static PtCallbackF_t gui_ph_handle_menu_unrealized;
 
 #ifdef USE_PANEL_GROUP
@@ -215,7 +215,7 @@ static void gui_ph_get_panelgroup_margin
 static void gui_ph_draw_start(void);
 static void gui_ph_draw_end(void);
 
-/* Set the text for the balloon */
+// Set the text for the balloon
 static PtWidget_t * gui_ph_show_tooltip(PtWidget_t *window,
 			     PtWidget_t *widget,
 			     int position,
@@ -224,7 +224,7 @@ static PtWidget_t * gui_ph_show_tooltip(
 			     PgColor_t fill_color,
 			     PgColor_t text_color);
 
-/****************************************************************************/
+////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
 
 static PtWidget_t * gui_ph_show_tooltip(PtWidget_t *window,
 			     PtWidget_t *widget,
@@ -241,7 +241,7 @@ static PtWidget_t * gui_ph_show_tooltip(
     PtSetArg(&arg, Pt_ARG_POINTER, &menu, 0);
     PtGetResources(widget, 1, &arg);
 
-    /* Override the text and position */
+    // Override the text and position
 
     tooltip = text;
     if (menu != NULL)
@@ -254,8 +254,8 @@ static PtWidget_t * gui_ph_show_tooltip(
     return PtInflateBalloon(
 	    window,
 	    widget,
-	    /* Don't put the balloon at the bottom,
-	     * it gets drawn over by gfx done in the PtRaw */
+	    // Don't put the balloon at the bottom,
+	    // it gets drawn over by gfx done in the PtRaw
 	    Pt_BALLOON_TOP,
 	    tooltip,
 	    font,
@@ -287,9 +287,9 @@ gui_ph_handle_menu_resize(
 
     height = sizes->new_dim.h;
 
-    /* Because vim treats the toolbar and menubar separately,
-     * and here they're lumped together into a PtToolbarGroup,
-     * we only need either menu_height or toolbar_height set at once */
+    // Because vim treats the toolbar and menubar separately,
+    // and here they're lumped together into a PtToolbarGroup,
+    // we only need either menu_height or toolbar_height set at once
     if (gui.menu_is_active)
     {
 	gui.menu_height = height;
@@ -368,7 +368,7 @@ gui_ph_handle_window_cb(PtWidget_t *widg
 	    break;
 
 	case Ph_WM_FOCUS:
-	    /* Just in case it's hidden and needs to be shown */
+	    // Just in case it's hidden and needs to be shown
 	    gui_mch_mousehide(MOUSE_SHOW);
 
 	    if (we->event_state == Ph_WM_EVSTATE_FOCUS)
@@ -424,7 +424,7 @@ gui_ph_handle_scrollbar(PtWidget_t *widg
 		break;
 
 	    case Pt_SCROLL_SET:
-		/* FIXME: return straight away here? */
+		// FIXME: return straight away here?
 		return Pt_CONTINUE;
 		break;
 	}
@@ -449,7 +449,7 @@ gui_ph_handle_keyboard(PtWidget_t *widge
     if (p_mh)
 	gui_mch_mousehide(MOUSE_HIDE);
 
-    /* We're a good lil photon program, aren't we? yes we are, yeess wee arrr */
+    // We're a good lil photon program, aren't we? yes we are, yeess wee arrr
     if (key->key_flags & Pk_KF_Compose)
 	return Pt_CONTINUE;
 
@@ -469,7 +469,7 @@ gui_ph_handle_keyboard(PtWidget_t *widge
 	      (*p_wak == 'm' &&
 		gui_is_menu_shortcut(key->key_cap))))
 	{
-	    /* Fallthrough and let photon look for the hotkey */
+	    // Fallthrough and let photon look for the hotkey
 	    return Pt_CONTINUE;
 	}
 #endif
@@ -483,13 +483,13 @@ gui_ph_handle_keyboard(PtWidget_t *widge
 		    ch = special_keys[i].vim_code0;
 		else
 		{
-		    /* Detect if a keypad number key has been pressed
-		     * and change the key if Num Lock is on */
+		    // Detect if a keypad number key has been pressed
+		    // and change the key if Num Lock is on
 		    if (key->key_cap >= Pk_KP_Enter && key->key_cap <= Pk_KP_9
 			    && (key->key_mods & Pk_KM_Num_Lock))
 		    {
-			/* FIXME: For now, just map the key to a ascii value
-			 * (see <photon/PkKeyDef.h>) */
+			// FIXME: For now, just map the key to a ascii value
+			// (see <photon/PkKeyDef.h>)
 			ch = key->key_cap - 0xf080;
 		    }
 		    else
@@ -507,7 +507,7 @@ gui_ph_handle_keyboard(PtWidget_t *widge
 	if (key->key_mods & Pk_KM_Shift)
 	    modifiers |= MOD_MASK_SHIFT;
 
-	/* Is this not a special key? */
+	// Is this not a special key?
 	if (special_keys[i].key_sym == 0)
 	{
 	    ch = PhTo8859_1(key);
@@ -542,7 +542,7 @@ gui_ph_handle_keyboard(PtWidget_t *widge
 		ch = key->key_cap;
 		if (ch < 0xff)
 		{
-		    /* FIXME: is this the right thing to do? */
+		    // FIXME: is this the right thing to do?
 		    if (modifiers & MOD_MASK_CTRL)
 		    {
 			modifiers &= ~MOD_MASK_CTRL;
@@ -605,7 +605,7 @@ gui_ph_handle_keyboard(PtWidget_t *widge
 
 	if (len == 1 && string[0] == CSI)
 	{
-	    /* Turn CSI into K_CSI. */
+	    // Turn CSI into K_CSI.
 	    string[ len++ ] = KS_EXTRA;
 	    string[ len++ ] = KE_CSI;
 	}
@@ -663,7 +663,7 @@ gui_ph_handle_mouse(PtWidget_t *widget, 
     if (pointer->buttons & Ph_BUTTON_MENU)
     {
 	button = MOUSE_RIGHT;
-	/* Need the absolute coordinates for the popup menu */
+	// Need the absolute coordinates for the popup menu
 	abs_mouse.x = pointer->pos.x;
 	abs_mouse.y = pointer->pos.y;
     }
@@ -671,7 +671,7 @@ gui_ph_handle_mouse(PtWidget_t *widget, 
     if (pointer->buttons & Ph_BUTTON_ADJUST)
 	button = MOUSE_MIDDLE;
 
-    /* Catch a real release (not phantom or other releases */
+    // Catch a real release (not phantom or other releases
     if (info->event->type == Ph_EV_BUT_RELEASE)
 	button = MOUSE_RELEASE;
 
@@ -679,12 +679,12 @@ gui_ph_handle_mouse(PtWidget_t *widget, 
 	button = MOUSE_DRAG;
 
 #if 0
-    /* Vim doesn't use button repeats */
+    // Vim doesn't use button repeats
     if (info->event->type & Ph_EV_BUT_REPEAT)
 	button = MOUSE_DRAG;
 #endif
 
-    /* Don't do anything if it is one of the phantom mouse release events */
+    // Don't do anything if it is one of the phantom mouse release events
     if ((button != MOUSE_RELEASE) ||
 	    (info->event->subtype == Ph_EV_RELEASE_REAL))
     {
@@ -696,7 +696,9 @@ gui_ph_handle_mouse(PtWidget_t *widget, 
     return Pt_CONTINUE;
 }
 
-/* Handle a focus change of the PtRaw widget */
+/*
+ * Handle a focus change of the PtRaw widget
+ */
     static int
 gui_ph_handle_focus(PtWidget_t *widget, void *data, PtCallbackInfo_t *info)
 {
@@ -745,7 +747,7 @@ gui_ph_handle_raw_draw(PtWidget_t *widge
     PhTranslatePoint(&offset, PtWidgetPos(gui.vimTextArea, NULL));
 
 #if 1
-    /* Redraw individual damage regions */
+    // Redraw individual damage regions
     if (damage->next != NULL)
 	damage = damage->next;
 
@@ -759,7 +761,7 @@ gui_ph_handle_raw_draw(PtWidget_t *widge
 	damage = damage->next;
     }
 #else
-    /* Redraw the rectangle that covers all the damaged regions */
+    // Redraw the rectangle that covers all the damaged regions
     r = &damage->rect;
     gui_redraw(
 	    r->ul.x - offset.x, r->ul.y - offset.y,
@@ -787,7 +789,9 @@ gui_ph_handle_pulldown_menu(
     return Pt_CONTINUE;
 }
 
-/* This is used for pulldown/popup menus and also toolbar buttons */
+/*
+ * This is used for pulldown/popup menus and also toolbar buttons
+ */
     static int
 gui_ph_handle_menu(PtWidget_t *widget, void *data, PtCallbackInfo_t *info)
 {
@@ -799,7 +803,9 @@ gui_ph_handle_menu(PtWidget_t *widget, v
     return Pt_CONTINUE;
 }
 
-/* Stop focus from disappearing into the menubar... */
+/*
+ * Stop focus from disappearing into the menubar...
+ */
     static int
 gui_ph_handle_menu_unrealized(
 	PtWidget_t *widget,
@@ -820,12 +826,14 @@ gui_ph_handle_window_open(
     return Pt_CONTINUE;
 }
 
-/****************************************************************************/
+////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
 
 #define DRAW_START  gui_ph_draw_start()
 #define DRAW_END    gui_ph_draw_end()
 
-/* TODO: Set a clipping rect? */
+/*
+ * TODO: Set a clipping rect?
+ */
     static void
 gui_ph_draw_start(void)
 {
@@ -888,8 +896,8 @@ gui_ph_pg_set_buffer_num(int_u buf_num)
 
     for (i = 0; i < num_panels; i++)
     {
-	/* find the last "(" in the panel title and see if the buffer
-	 * number in the title matches the one we're looking for */
+	// find the last "(" in the panel title and see if the buffer
+	// number in the title matches the one we're looking for
 	mark = STRRCHR(panel_titles[ i ], '(');
 	if (mark != NULL && STRCMP(mark, search) == 0)
 	{
@@ -948,7 +956,9 @@ gui_ph_get_panelgroup_margins(
     *right = *margin_right;
 }
 
-/* Used for the tabs for PtPanelGroup */
+/*
+ * Used for the tabs for PtPanelGroup
+ */
     static int
 gui_ph_is_buffer_item(vimmenu_T *menu, vimmenu_T *parent)
 {
@@ -956,7 +966,7 @@ gui_ph_is_buffer_item(vimmenu_T *menu, v
 
     if (STRCMP(parent->dname, "Buffers") == 0)
     {
-	/* Look for '(' digits ')' */
+	// Look for '(' digits ')'
 	mark = vim_strchr(menu->dname, '(');
 	if (mark != NULL)
 	{
@@ -998,14 +1008,14 @@ gui_ph_pg_remove_buffer(char *name)
     int i;
     char **new_titles = NULL;
 
-    /* If there is only 1 panel, we just use the temporary place holder */
+    // If there is only 1 panel, we just use the temporary place holder
     if (num_panels > 1)
     {
 	new_titles = ALLOC_MULT(char *, num_panels - 1);
 	if (new_titles != NULL)
 	{
 	    char **s = new_titles;
-	    /* Copy all the titles except the one we're removing */
+	    // Copy all the titles except the one we're removing
 	    for (i = 0; i < num_panels; i++)
 	    {
 		if (STRCMP(panel_titles[ i ], name) != 0)
@@ -1030,7 +1040,9 @@ gui_ph_pg_remove_buffer(char *name)
     }
 }
 
-/* When a buffer item is deleted from the buffer menu */
+/*
+ * When a buffer item is deleted from the buffer menu
+ */
     static int
 gui_ph_handle_buffer_remove(
 	PtWidget_t *widget,
@@ -1062,12 +1074,12 @@ gui_ph_pane_resize(PtWidget_t *widget, v
     return Pt_CONTINUE;
 }
 
-/****************************************************************************/
+////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
 
     void
 gui_ph_encoding_changed(int new_encoding)
 {
-    /* Default encoding is latin1 */
+    // Default encoding is latin1
     char *charset = "latin1";
     int i;
 
@@ -1090,8 +1102,7 @@ gui_ph_encoding_changed(int new_encoding
     charset_translate = PxTranslateSet(charset_translate, charset);
 }
 
-/****************************************************************************/
-/****************************************************************************/
+////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
 
     void
 gui_mch_prepare(int *argc, char **argv)
@@ -1105,20 +1116,20 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
     PtArg_t args[10];
     int	    flags = 0, n = 0;
 
-    PhDim_t	window_size = {100, 100}; /* Arbitrary values */
+    PhDim_t	window_size = {100, 100}; // Arbitrary values
     PhPoint_t	pos = {0, 0};
 
     gui.event_buffer = alloc(EVENT_BUFFER_SIZE);
     if (gui.event_buffer == NULL)
 	return FAIL;
 
-    /* Get a translation so we can convert from ISO Latin-1 to UTF */
+    // Get a translation so we can convert from ISO Latin-1 to UTF
     charset_translate = PxTranslateSet(NULL, "latin1");
 
-    /* The +2 is for the 1 pixel dark line on each side */
+    // The +2 is for the 1 pixel dark line on each side
     gui.border_offset = gui.border_width = GUI_PH_MARGIN + 2;
 
-    /* Handle close events ourselves */
+    // Handle close events ourselves
     PtSetArg(&args[ n++ ], Pt_ARG_WINDOW_MANAGED_FLAGS, Pt_FALSE, Ph_WM_CLOSE);
     PtSetArg(&args[ n++ ], Pt_ARG_WINDOW_NOTIFY_FLAGS, Pt_TRUE,
 	    Ph_WM_CLOSE | Ph_WM_RESIZE | Ph_WM_FOCUS);
@@ -1137,7 +1148,7 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
     PtSetArg(&args[ n++ ], Pt_ARG_POS, &pos, 0);
 
 #ifdef USE_PANEL_GROUP
-    /* Put in a temporary place holder title */
+    // Put in a temporary place holder title
     PtSetArg(&args[ n++ ], Pt_ARG_PG_PANEL_TITLES, &empty_title, 1);
 
     gui.vimPanelGroup = PtCreateWidget(PtPanelGroup, gui.vimWindow, n, args);
@@ -1147,7 +1158,7 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
     PtAddCallback(gui.vimPanelGroup, Pt_CB_PG_PANEL_SWITCHING,
 	    gui_ph_handle_pg_change, NULL);
 #else
-    /* Turn off all edge decorations */
+    // Turn off all edge decorations
     PtSetArg(&args[ n++ ], Pt_ARG_BASIC_FLAGS, Pt_FALSE, Pt_ALL);
     PtSetArg(&args[ n++ ], Pt_ARG_BEVEL_WIDTH, 0, 0);
     PtSetArg(&args[ n++ ], Pt_ARG_MARGIN_WIDTH, 0, 0);
@@ -1161,7 +1172,7 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
     PtAddCallback(gui.vimContainer, Pt_CB_RESIZE, gui_ph_pane_resize, NULL);
 #endif
 
-    /* Size for the text area is set in gui_mch_set_text_area_pos */
+    // Size for the text area is set in gui_mch_set_text_area_pos
     n = 0;
 
     PtSetArg(&args[ n++ ], Pt_ARG_RAW_DRAW_F, gui_ph_handle_raw_draw, 1);
@@ -1181,8 +1192,8 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
     if (gui.vimTextArea == NULL)
 	return FAIL;
 
-    /* TODO: use PtAddEventHandlers instead? */
-    /* Not using Ph_EV_BUT_REPEAT because vim wouldn't use it anyway */
+    // TODO: use PtAddEventHandlers instead?
+    // Not using Ph_EV_BUT_REPEAT because vim wouldn't use it anyway
     PtAddEventHandler(gui.vimTextArea,
 	    Ph_EV_BUT_PRESS | Ph_EV_BUT_RELEASE | Ph_EV_PTR_MOTION_BUTTON,
 	    gui_ph_handle_mouse, NULL);
@@ -1311,11 +1322,13 @@ gui_mch_exit(int rc)
 #endif
 }
 
-/****************************************************************************/
-/* events */
-
-/* When no events are available, photon will call this function, working is
- * set to FALSE, and the gui_mch_update loop will exit. */
+////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+// events
+
+/*
+ * When no events are available, photon will call this function, working is
+ * set to FALSE, and the gui_mch_update loop will exit.
+ */
     static int
 exit_gui_mch_update(void *data)
 {
@@ -1388,12 +1401,12 @@ gui_mch_browse(
     {
 	if (saving == TRUE)
 	{
-	    /* Don't need Pt_FSR_CONFIRM_EXISTING, vim will ask anyway */
+	    // Don't need Pt_FSR_CONFIRM_EXISTING, vim will ask anyway
 	    flags |= Pt_FSR_NO_FCHECK;
 	    open_text = "&Save";
 	}
 
-	/* combine the directory and filename into a single path */
+	// combine the directory and filename into a single path
 	if (initdir == NULL || *initdir == NUL)
 	{
 	    mch_dirname(default_path, MAXPATHL);
@@ -1413,7 +1426,7 @@ gui_mch_browse(
 	    STRCAT(default_path, default_name);
 	}
 
-	/* TODO: add a filter? */
+	// TODO: add a filter?
 	PtFileSelection(
 		gui.vimWindow,
 		NULL,
@@ -1496,18 +1509,18 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     int		i, len;
     int		dialog_result = -1;
 
-    /* FIXME: the vertical option in guioptions is blatantly ignored */
-    /* FIXME: so is the type */
+    // FIXME: the vertical option in guioptions is blatantly ignored
+    // FIXME: so is the type
 
     button_count = len = i = 0;
 
     if (buttons == NULL || *buttons == NUL)
 	return -1;
 
-    /* There is one less separator than buttons, so bump up the button count */
+    // There is one less separator than buttons, so bump up the button count
     button_count = 1;
 
-    /* Count string length and number of separators */
+    // Count string length and number of separators
     for (str = buttons; *str; str++)
     {
 	len++;
@@ -1550,8 +1563,8 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 		button_count, (const char **) button_array, NULL,
 		default_button, 0, Pt_MODAL);
 #else
-	/* Writing the dialog ourselves lets us add extra features, like
-	 * trapping the escape key and returning 0 to vim */
+	// Writing the dialog ourselves lets us add extra features, like
+	// trapping the escape key and returning 0 to vim
 	{
 	    int n;
 	    PtArg_t args[5];
@@ -1593,8 +1606,8 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 	    di.buttons = (const char **) button_array;
 	    di.nbtns = button_count;
 	    di.def_btn = default_button;
-	    /* This is just to give the dialog the close button.
-	     * We check for the Escape key ourselves and return 0 */
+	    // This is just to give the dialog the close button.
+	    // We check for the Escape key ourselves and return 0
 	    di.esc_btn = button_count;
 	    di.callback = gui_ph_dialog_close;
 	    di.data = &modal_ctrl;
@@ -1606,7 +1619,7 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 	    if (gui_ph_dialog_text != NULL)
 		PtGiveFocus(gui_ph_dialog_text, NULL);
 
-	    /* Open dialog, block the vim window and wait for the dialog to close */
+	    // Open dialog, block the vim window and wait for the dialog to close
 	    PtRealizeWidget(dialog);
 	    PtMakeModal(dialog, Ph_CURSOR_NOINPUT, Ph_CURSOR_DEFAULT_COLOR);
 	    dialog_result = (int) PtModalBlock(&modal_ctrl, 0);
@@ -1623,8 +1636,8 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     return dialog_result;
 }
 #endif
-/****************************************************************************/
-/* window size/position/state */
+////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+// window size/position/state
 
     int
 gui_mch_get_winpos(int *x, int *y)
@@ -1719,11 +1732,11 @@ gui_mch_settitle(char_u *title,	char_u *
     gui_ph_pg_set_buffer_num(curwin->w_buffer->b_fnum);
 #endif
     PtSetResource(gui.vimWindow, Pt_ARG_WINDOW_TITLE, title, 0);
-    /* Not sure what to do with the icon text, set balloon text somehow? */
+    // Not sure what to do with the icon text, set balloon text somehow?
 }
 
-/****************************************************************************/
-/* Scrollbar */
+////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+// Scrollbar
 
     void
 gui_mch_set_scrollbar_thumb(scrollbar_T *sb, int val, int size, int max)
@@ -1749,7 +1762,7 @@ gui_mch_set_scrollbar_pos(scrollbar_T *s
 gui_mch_create_scrollbar(scrollbar_T *sb, int orient)
 {
     int	    n = 0;
-/*    int	    anchor_flags = 0;*/
+//    int	    anchor_flags = 0;
     PtArg_t args[4];
 
     /*
@@ -1762,7 +1775,7 @@ gui_mch_create_scrollbar(scrollbar_T *sb
 	    Pt_DELAY_REALIZE | Pt_GETS_FOCUS);
     PtSetArg(&args[ n++ ], Pt_ARG_SCROLLBAR_FLAGS, Pt_SCROLLBAR_SHOW_ARROWS, 0);
 #if 0
-    /* Don't need this anchoring for the scrollbars */
+    // Don't need this anchoring for the scrollbars
     if (orient == SBAR_HORIZ)
     {
 	anchor_flags = Pt_BOTTOM_ANCHORED_BOTTOM |
@@ -1808,35 +1821,35 @@ gui_mch_destroy_scrollbar(scrollbar_T *s
     sb->id = NULL;
 }
 
-/****************************************************************************/
-/* Mouse functions */
+////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+// Mouse functions
 
 #if defined(FEAT_MOUSESHAPE) || defined(PROTO)
-/* The last set mouse pointer shape is remembered, to be used when it goes
- * from hidden to not hidden. */
+// The last set mouse pointer shape is remembered, to be used when it goes
+// from hidden to not hidden.
 static int last_shape = 0;
 
-/* Table for shape IDs.  Keep in sync with the mshape_names[] table in
- * misc2.c! */
+// Table for shape IDs.  Keep in sync with the mshape_names[] table in
+// misc2.c!
 static int mshape_ids[] =
 {
-    Ph_CURSOR_POINTER,		/* arrow */
-    Ph_CURSOR_NONE,		/* blank */
-    Ph_CURSOR_INSERT,		/* beam */
-    Ph_CURSOR_DRAG_VERTICAL,	/* updown */
-    Ph_CURSOR_DRAG_VERTICAL,	/* udsizing */
-    Ph_CURSOR_DRAG_HORIZONTAL,	/* leftright */
-    Ph_CURSOR_DRAG_HORIZONTAL,	/* lrsizing */
-    Ph_CURSOR_WAIT,		/* busy */
-    Ph_CURSOR_DONT,		/* no */
-    Ph_CURSOR_CROSSHAIR,	/* crosshair */
-    Ph_CURSOR_FINGER,		/* hand1 */
-    Ph_CURSOR_FINGER,		/* hand2 */
-    Ph_CURSOR_FINGER,		/* pencil */
-    Ph_CURSOR_QUESTION_POINT,	/* question */
-    Ph_CURSOR_POINTER,		/* right-arrow */
-    Ph_CURSOR_POINTER,		/* up-arrow */
-    Ph_CURSOR_POINTER		/* last one */
+    Ph_CURSOR_POINTER,		// arrow
+    Ph_CURSOR_NONE,		// blank
+    Ph_CURSOR_INSERT,		// beam
+    Ph_CURSOR_DRAG_VERTICAL,	// updown
+    Ph_CURSOR_DRAG_VERTICAL,	// udsizing
+    Ph_CURSOR_DRAG_HORIZONTAL,	// leftright
+    Ph_CURSOR_DRAG_HORIZONTAL,	// lrsizing
+    Ph_CURSOR_WAIT,		// busy
+    Ph_CURSOR_DONT,		// no
+    Ph_CURSOR_CROSSHAIR,	// crosshair
+    Ph_CURSOR_FINGER,		// hand1
+    Ph_CURSOR_FINGER,		// hand2
+    Ph_CURSOR_FINGER,		// pencil
+    Ph_CURSOR_QUESTION_POINT,	// question
+    Ph_CURSOR_POINTER,		// right-arrow
+    Ph_CURSOR_POINTER,		// up-arrow
+    Ph_CURSOR_POINTER		// last one
 };
 
     void
@@ -1890,8 +1903,8 @@ gui_mch_getmouse(int *x, int *y)
     PhCursorInfo_t info;
     short ix, iy;
 
-    /* FIXME: does this return the correct position,
-     * with respect to the border? */
+    // FIXME: does this return the correct position,
+    // with respect to the border?
     PhQueryCursor(PhInputGroup(NULL), &info);
     PtGetAbsPosition(gui.vimTextArea , &ix, &iy);
 
@@ -1905,12 +1918,12 @@ gui_mch_setmouse(int x, int y)
     short abs_x, abs_y;
 
     PtGetAbsPosition(gui.vimTextArea, &abs_x, &abs_y);
-    /* Add the border offset? */
+    // Add the border offset?
     PhMoveCursorAbs(PhInputGroup(NULL), abs_x + x, abs_y + y);
 }
 
-/****************************************************************************/
-/* Colours */
+////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+// Colours
 
 /*
  * Return the RGB value of a pixel as a long.
@@ -1925,7 +1938,7 @@ gui_mch_get_rgb(guicolor_T pixel)
     void
 gui_mch_new_colors(void)
 {
-#if 0 /* Don't bother changing the cursor colour */
+#if 0 // Don't bother changing the cursor colour
     short color_diff;
 
     /*
@@ -1938,7 +1951,7 @@ gui_mch_new_colors(void)
     if (abs(color_diff) < 64)
     {
 	short r, g, b;
-	/* not a great algorithm... */
+	// not a great algorithm...
 	r = PgRedValue(gui_ph_mouse_color) ^ 255;
 	g = PgGreenValue(gui_ph_mouse_color) ^ 255;
 	b = PgBlueValue(gui_ph_mouse_color) ^ 255;
@@ -1999,7 +2012,7 @@ gui_mch_invert_rectangle(int row, int co
     rect.ul.x = FILL_X(col);
     rect.ul.y = FILL_Y(row);
 
-    /* FIXME: This has an off by one pixel problem */
+    // FIXME: This has an off by one pixel problem
     rect.lr.x = rect.ul.x + nc * gui.char_width;
     rect.lr.y = rect.ul.y + nr * gui.char_height;
     if (nc > 0)
@@ -2132,7 +2145,7 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(int row, int col, ch
     {
 	int src_taken, dst_made;
 
-	/* Use a static buffer to avoid large amounts of de/allocations */
+	// Use a static buffer to avoid large amounts of de/allocations
 	if (utf8_len < len)
 	{
 	    utf8_buffer = realloc(utf8_buffer, len * MB_LEN_MAX);
@@ -2155,12 +2168,12 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(int row, int col, ch
 
     if (flags & DRAW_BOLD)
     {
-	/* FIXME: try and only calculate these values once... */
+	// FIXME: try and only calculate these values once...
 	rect.ul.x = FILL_X(col) + 1;
 	rect.ul.y = FILL_Y(row);
 	rect.lr.x = FILL_X(col + len) - 1;
 	rect.lr.y = FILL_Y(row + 1) - 1;
-	/* PgSetUserClip(NULL) causes the scrollbar to not redraw... */
+	// PgSetUserClip(NULL) causes the scrollbar to not redraw...
 #if 0
 	pos.x++;
 
@@ -2169,7 +2182,7 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(int row, int col, ch
 	PgSetUserClip(NULL);
 #else
 	rect.lr.y -= (p_linespace + 1) / 2;
-	/* XXX: DrawTextArea doesn't work with phditto */
+	// XXX: DrawTextArea doesn't work with phditto
 	PgDrawTextArea(s, len, &rect, Pg_TEXT_BOTTOM);
 #endif
     }
@@ -2180,15 +2193,15 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(int row, int col, ch
     DRAW_END;
 }
 
-/****************************************************************************/
-/* Cursor */
+////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+// Cursor
 
     void
 gui_mch_draw_hollow_cursor(guicolor_T color)
 {
     PhRect_t r;
 
-    /* FIXME: Double width characters */
+    // FIXME: Double width characters
 
     r.ul.x = FILL_X(gui.col);
     r.ul.y = FILL_Y(gui.row);
@@ -2240,7 +2253,7 @@ gui_mch_set_blinking(long wait, long on,
     void
 gui_mch_start_blink(void)
 {
-    /* Only turn on the timer on if none of the times are zero */
+    // Only turn on the timer on if none of the times are zero
     if (blink_waittime && blink_ontime && blink_offtime && gui.in_focus)
     {
 	PtSetResource(gui_ph_timer_cursor, Pt_ARG_TIMER_INITIAL,
@@ -2261,8 +2274,8 @@ gui_mch_stop_blink(int may_call_gui_upda
     blink_state = BLINK_NONE;
 }
 
-/****************************************************************************/
-/* miscellaneous functions */
+////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+// miscellaneous functions
 
     void
 gui_mch_beep(void)
@@ -2311,8 +2324,8 @@ gui_mch_haskey(char_u *name)
     return FAIL;
 }
 
-/****************************************************************************/
-/* Menu */
+////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+// Menu
 
 #ifdef FEAT_TOOLBAR
 #include "toolbar.phi"
@@ -2360,8 +2373,8 @@ gui_ph_toolbar_load_icon(char_u *iconfil
     temp_phi = PxLoadImage(iconfile, NULL);
     if (temp_phi != NULL)
     {
-	/* The label widget will free the image/palette/etc. for us when
-	 * it's destroyed */
+	// The label widget will free the image/palette/etc. for us when
+	// it's destroyed
 	temp_phi->flags |= Ph_RELEASE_IMAGE_ALL;
 	memcpy(&external_icon, temp_phi, sizeof(external_icon));
 	free(temp_phi);
@@ -2387,10 +2400,10 @@ gui_ph_toolbar_find_icon(vimmenu_T *menu
     if (menu->icon_builtin == FALSE)
     {
 	if (menu->iconfile != NULL)
-	    /* TODO: use gui_find_iconfile() */
+	    // TODO: use gui_find_iconfile()
 	    icon = gui_ph_toolbar_load_icon(menu->iconfile);
 
-	/* TODO: Restrict loading to just .png? Search for any format? */
+	// TODO: Restrict loading to just .png? Search for any format?
 	if ((icon == NULL) &&
 	    ((gui_find_bitmap(menu->name, full_pathname, "gif") == OK) ||
 	      (gui_find_bitmap(menu->name, full_pathname, "png") == OK)))
@@ -2421,10 +2434,12 @@ gui_mch_enable_menu(int flag)
     void
 gui_mch_set_menu_pos(int x, int y, int w, int h)
 {
-    /* Nothing */
+    // Nothing
 }
 
-/* Change the position of a menu button in the parent */
+/*
+ * Change the position of a menu button in the parent
+ */
     static void
 gui_ph_position_menu(PtWidget_t *widget, int priority)
 {
@@ -2433,9 +2448,9 @@ gui_ph_position_menu(PtWidget_t *widget,
 
     traverse = PtWidgetChildBack(PtWidgetParent(widget));
 
-    /* Iterate through the list of widgets in traverse, until
-     * we find the position we want to insert our widget into */
-    /* TODO: traverse from front to back, possible speedup? */
+    // Iterate through the list of widgets in traverse, until
+    // we find the position we want to insert our widget into
+    // TODO: traverse from front to back, possible speedup?
     while (traverse != NULL)
     {
 	PtGetResource(traverse, Pt_ARG_POINTER, &menu, 0);
@@ -2444,7 +2459,7 @@ gui_ph_position_menu(PtWidget_t *widget,
 		priority < menu->priority &&
 		widget != traverse)
 	{
-	    /* Insert the widget before the current traverse widget */
+	    // Insert the widget before the current traverse widget
 	    PtWidgetInsert(widget, traverse, 1);
 	    return;
 	}
@@ -2453,7 +2468,9 @@ gui_ph_position_menu(PtWidget_t *widget,
     }
 }
 
-/* the index is ignored because it's not useful for our purposes */
+/*
+ * the index is ignored because it's not useful for our purposes
+ */
     void
 gui_mch_add_menu(vimmenu_T *menu, int index)
 {
@@ -2475,7 +2492,7 @@ gui_mch_add_menu(vimmenu_T *menu, int in
 	    mnemonic_str[1] = NUL;
 	}
 
-	/* Create the menu button */
+	// Create the menu button
 	n = 0;
 	PtSetArg(&args[ n++ ], Pt_ARG_TEXT_STRING, menu->dname, 0);
 	PtSetArg(&args[ n++ ], Pt_ARG_ACCEL_TEXT, menu->actext, 0);
@@ -2492,7 +2509,7 @@ gui_mch_add_menu(vimmenu_T *menu, int in
 
 	PtAddCallback(menu->id, Pt_CB_ARM, gui_ph_handle_pulldown_menu, menu);
 
-	/* Create the actual menu */
+	// Create the actual menu
 	n = 0;
 	if (parent != NULL)
 	    PtSetArg(&args[ n++ ], Pt_ARG_MENU_FLAGS, Pt_TRUE, Pt_MENU_CHILD);
@@ -2513,7 +2530,7 @@ gui_mch_add_menu(vimmenu_T *menu, int in
 
 	gui_ph_position_menu(menu->id, menu->priority);
 
-	/* Redraw menubar here instead of gui_mch_draw_menubar */
+	// Redraw menubar here instead of gui_mch_draw_menubar
 	if (gui.menu_is_active)
 	    PtRealizeWidget(menu->id);
     }
@@ -2583,7 +2600,7 @@ gui_mch_add_menu_item(vimmenu_T *menu, i
 
 	    PtAddCallback(menu->id, Pt_CB_ACTIVATE, gui_ph_handle_menu, menu);
 	}
-	/* Update toolbar if it's open */
+	// Update toolbar if it's open
 	if (PtWidgetIsRealized(gui.vimToolBar))
 	    PtRealizeWidget(menu->id);
     }
@@ -2669,16 +2686,15 @@ gui_mch_menu_grey(vimmenu_T *menu, int g
     void
 gui_mch_menu_hidden(vimmenu_T *menu, int hidden)
 {
-    /* TODO: [un]realize the widget? */
+    // TODO: [un]realize the widget?
 }
 
     void
 gui_mch_draw_menubar(void)
 {
-    /* The only time a redraw is needed is when a menu button
-     * is added to the menubar, and that is detected and the bar
-     * redrawn in gui_mch_add_menu_item
-     */
+    // The only time a redraw is needed is when a menu button
+    // is added to the menubar, and that is detected and the bar
+    // redrawn in gui_mch_add_menu_item
 }
 
     void
@@ -2691,7 +2707,7 @@ gui_mch_show_popupmenu(vimmenu_T *menu)
     void
 gui_mch_toggle_tearoffs(int enable)
 {
-    /* No tearoffs yet */
+    // No tearoffs yet
 }
 
 #endif
@@ -2707,16 +2723,16 @@ gui_mch_show_toolbar(int showit)
 }
 #endif
 
-/****************************************************************************/
-/* Fonts */
+////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+// Fonts
 
     static GuiFont
 gui_ph_get_font(
 	char_u	*font_name,
 	int_u	font_flags,
 	int_u	font_size,
-	/* Check whether the resulting font has the font flags and size that
-	 * was asked for */
+	// Check whether the resulting font has the font flags and size that
+	// was asked for
 	int_u	enforce
 	)
 {
@@ -2730,7 +2746,7 @@ gui_ph_get_font(
 	if (PfGenerateFontName(font_name, font_flags, font_size,
 		    font_tag) != NULL)
 	{
-	    /* Enforce some limits on the font used */
+	    // Enforce some limits on the font used
 	    style = PHFONT_INFO_FIXED;
 
 	    if (enforce & PF_STYLE_BOLD)
@@ -2745,8 +2761,8 @@ gui_ph_get_font(
 	    if (info.size == 0)
 		font_size = 0;
 
-	    /* Make sure font size matches, and that the font style
-	     * at least has the bits we're checking for */
+	    // Make sure font size matches, and that the font style
+	    // at least has the bits we're checking for
 	    if (font_size == info.size &&
 		    style == (info.style & style))
 		return (GuiFont)font_tag;
@@ -2799,7 +2815,7 @@ gui_ph_parse_font_name(
 
 		    case 's':
 			size = getdigits(&mark);
-			/* Restrict the size to some vague limits */
+			// Restrict the size to some vague limits
 			if (size < 1 || size > 100)
 			    size = 8;
 
@@ -2829,7 +2845,7 @@ gui_mch_init_font(char_u *vim_font_name,
 
     if (vim_font_name == NULL)
     {
-	/* Default font */
+	// Default font
 	vim_font_name = "PC Terminal";
     }
 
@@ -2872,7 +2888,7 @@ gui_mch_init_font(char_u *vim_font_name,
     gui.ital_font = gui_ph_get_font(font_name, font_flags | PF_STYLE_ITALIC,
 	    font_size, PF_STYLE_ITALIC);
 
-    /* This extent was brought to you by the letter 'g' */
+    // This extent was brought to you by the letter 'g'
     PfExtentText(&extent, NULL, font_tag, "g", 1);
 
     gui.char_width = extent.lr.x - extent.ul.x + 1;
--- a/src/gui_w32.c
+++ b/src/gui_w32.c
@@ -58,7 +58,7 @@ gui_mch_set_rendering_options(char_u *s)
     int	    dx_renmode = 0;
     int	    dx_taamode = 0;
 
-    /* parse string as rendering options. */
+    // parse string as rendering options.
     for (p = s; p != NULL && *p != NUL; )
     {
 	char_u  item[256];
@@ -119,16 +119,16 @@ gui_mch_set_rendering_options(char_u *s)
 	}
 	else if (STRCMP(name, "scrlines") == 0)
 	{
-	    /* Deprecated.  Simply ignore it. */
+	    // Deprecated.  Simply ignore it.
 	}
 	else
 	    return FAIL;
     }
 
     if (!gui.in_use)
-	return OK;  /* only checking the syntax of the value */
-
-    /* Enable DirectX/DirectWrite */
+	return OK;  // only checking the syntax of the value
+
+    // Enable DirectX/DirectWrite
     if (dx_enable)
     {
 	if (!directx_enabled())
@@ -179,12 +179,12 @@ gui_mch_set_rendering_options(char_u *s)
 #endif
 
 
-#include "version.h"	/* used by dialog box routine for default title */
+#include "version.h"	// used by dialog box routine for default title
 #ifdef DEBUG
 # include <tchar.h>
 #endif
 
-/* cproto fails on missing include files */
+// cproto fails on missing include files
 #ifndef PROTO
 
 # ifndef __MINGW32__
@@ -199,18 +199,18 @@ gui_mch_set_rendering_options(char_u *s)
 #  include "glbl_ime.h"
 # endif
 
-#endif /* PROTO */
+#endif // PROTO
 
 #ifdef FEAT_MENU
-# define MENUHINTS		/* show menu hints in command line */
-#endif
-
-/* Some parameters for dialog boxes.  All in pixels. */
+# define MENUHINTS		// show menu hints in command line
+#endif
+
+// Some parameters for dialog boxes.  All in pixels.
 #define DLG_PADDING_X		10
 #define DLG_PADDING_Y		10
 #define DLG_OLD_STYLE_PADDING_X	5
 #define DLG_OLD_STYLE_PADDING_Y	5
-#define DLG_VERT_PADDING_X	4	/* For vertical buttons */
+#define DLG_VERT_PADDING_X	4	// For vertical buttons
 #define DLG_VERT_PADDING_Y	4
 #define DLG_ICON_WIDTH		34
 #define DLG_ICON_HEIGHT		34
@@ -220,9 +220,9 @@ gui_mch_set_rendering_options(char_u *s)
 #define DLG_MIN_MAX_WIDTH	400
 #define DLG_MIN_MAX_HEIGHT	400
 
-#define DLG_NONBUTTON_CONTROL	5000	/* First ID of non-button controls */
-
-#ifndef WM_XBUTTONDOWN /* For Win2K / winME ONLY */
+#define DLG_NONBUTTON_CONTROL	5000	// First ID of non-button controls
+
+#ifndef WM_XBUTTONDOWN // For Win2K / winME ONLY
 # define WM_XBUTTONDOWN		0x020B
 # define WM_XBUTTONUP		0x020C
 # define WM_XBUTTONDBLCLK	0x020D
@@ -295,22 +295,22 @@ static void _OnPaint( HWND hwnd);
 static void fill_rect(const RECT *rcp, HBRUSH hbr, COLORREF color);
 static void clear_rect(RECT *rcp);
 
-static WORD		s_dlgfntheight;		/* height of the dialog font */
-static WORD		s_dlgfntwidth;		/* width of the dialog font */
+static WORD		s_dlgfntheight;		// height of the dialog font
+static WORD		s_dlgfntwidth;		// width of the dialog font
 
 #ifdef FEAT_MENU
 static HMENU		s_menuBar = NULL;
 #endif
 #ifdef FEAT_TEAROFF
 static void rebuild_tearoff(vimmenu_T *menu);
-static HBITMAP	s_htearbitmap;	    /* bitmap used to indicate tearoff */
-#endif
-
-/* Flag that is set while processing a message that must not be interrupted by
- * processing another message. */
+static HBITMAP	s_htearbitmap;	    // bitmap used to indicate tearoff
+#endif
+
+// Flag that is set while processing a message that must not be interrupted by
+// processing another message.
 static int		s_busy_processing = FALSE;
 
-static int		destroying = FALSE;	/* call DestroyWindow() ourselves */
+static int		destroying = FALSE;	// call DestroyWindow() ourselves
 
 #ifdef MSWIN_FIND_REPLACE
 static UINT		s_findrep_msg = 0;	// set in gui_w[16/32].c
@@ -344,15 +344,14 @@ static LPARAM		s_lParam = 0;
 static HWND		s_textArea = NULL;
 static UINT		s_uMsg = 0;
 
-static char_u		*s_textfield; /* Used by dialogs to pass back strings */
+static char_u		*s_textfield; // Used by dialogs to pass back strings
 
 static int		s_need_activate = FALSE;
 
-/* This variable is set when waiting for an event, which is the only moment
- * scrollbar dragging can be done directly.  It's not allowed while commands
- * are executed, because it may move the cursor and that may cause unexpected
- * problems (e.g., while ":s" is working).
- */
+// This variable is set when waiting for an event, which is the only moment
+// scrollbar dragging can be done directly.  It's not allowed while commands
+// are executed, because it may move the cursor and that may cause unexpected
+// problems (e.g., while ":s" is working).
 static int allow_scrollbar = FALSE;
 
 #ifdef GLOBAL_IME
@@ -369,7 +368,7 @@ directx_enabled(void)
 	return 1;
     else if (s_directx_load_attempted)
 	return 0;
-    /* load DirectX */
+    // load DirectX
     DWrite_Init();
     s_directx_load_attempted = 1;
     s_dwc = DWriteContext_Open();
@@ -389,10 +388,10 @@ directx_binddc(void)
 }
 #endif
 
-/* use of WindowProc depends on Global IME */
+// use of WindowProc depends on Global IME
 #define MyWindowProc vim_WindowProc
 
-extern int current_font_height;	    /* this is in os_mswin.c */
+extern int current_font_height;	    // this is in os_mswin.c
 
 static struct
 {
@@ -430,11 +429,11 @@ static struct
 
     {VK_F21,		'F', 'B'},
 #ifdef FEAT_NETBEANS_INTG
-    {VK_PAUSE,		'F', 'B'},	/* Pause == F21 (see gui_gtk_x11.c) */
+    {VK_PAUSE,		'F', 'B'},	// Pause == F21 (see gui_gtk_x11.c)
 #endif
     {VK_F22,		'F', 'C'},
     {VK_F23,		'F', 'D'},
-    {VK_F24,		'F', 'E'},	/* winuser.h defines up to F24 */
+    {VK_F24,		'F', 'E'},	// winuser.h defines up to F24
 
     {VK_HELP,		'%', '1'},
     {VK_BACK,		'k', 'b'},
@@ -449,7 +448,7 @@ static struct
     {VK_SUBTRACT,	'K', '7'},
     {VK_DIVIDE,		'K', '8'},
     {VK_MULTIPLY,	'K', '9'},
-    {VK_SEPARATOR,	'K', 'A'},	/* Keypad Enter */
+    {VK_SEPARATOR,	'K', 'A'},	// Keypad Enter
     {VK_DECIMAL,	'K', 'B'},
 
     {VK_NUMPAD0,	'K', 'C'},
@@ -463,22 +462,22 @@ static struct
     {VK_NUMPAD8,	'K', 'K'},
     {VK_NUMPAD9,	'K', 'L'},
 
-    /* Keys that we want to be able to use any modifier with: */
+    // Keys that we want to be able to use any modifier with:
     {VK_SPACE,		' ', NUL},
     {VK_TAB,		TAB, NUL},
     {VK_ESCAPE,		ESC, NUL},
     {NL,		NL, NUL},
     {CAR,		CAR, NUL},
 
-    /* End of list marker: */
+    // End of list marker:
     {0,			0, 0}
 };
 
-/* Local variables */
+// Local variables
 static int	s_button_pending = -1;
 
-/* s_getting_focus is set when we got focus but didn't see mouse-up event yet,
- * so don't reset s_button_pending. */
+// s_getting_focus is set when we got focus but didn't see mouse-up event yet,
+// so don't reset s_button_pending.
 static int	s_getting_focus = FALSE;
 
 static int	s_x_pending;
@@ -491,7 +490,7 @@ static UINT	surrogate_pending_ch = 0; //
 					  // else a high surrogate
 
 #ifdef FEAT_BEVAL_GUI
-/* balloon-eval WM_NOTIFY_HANDLER */
+// balloon-eval WM_NOTIFY_HANDLER
 static void Handle_WM_Notify(HWND hwnd, LPNMHDR pnmh);
 static void TrackUserActivity(UINT uMsg);
 #endif
@@ -502,11 +501,11 @@ static void TrackUserActivity(UINT uMsg)
  * These LOGFONTW used for IME.
  */
 #if defined(FEAT_MBYTE_IME) || defined(GLOBAL_IME)
-/* holds LOGFONTW for 'guifontwide' if available, otherwise 'guifont' */
+// holds LOGFONTW for 'guifontwide' if available, otherwise 'guifont'
 static LOGFONTW norm_logfont;
 #endif
 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE_IME
-/* holds LOGFONTW for 'guifont' always. */
+// holds LOGFONTW for 'guifont' always.
 static LOGFONTW sub_logfont;
 #endif
 
@@ -590,7 +589,7 @@ gui_mch_set_blinking(long wait, long on,
 
     KillTimer(NULL, idEvent);
 
-    /* Eat spurious WM_TIMER messages */
+    // Eat spurious WM_TIMER messages
     while (pPeekMessage(&msg, hwnd, WM_TIMER, WM_TIMER, PM_REMOVE))
 	;
 
@@ -619,7 +618,7 @@ gui_mswin_rm_blink_timer(void)
     if (blink_timer != 0)
     {
 	KillTimer(NULL, blink_timer);
-	/* Eat spurious WM_TIMER messages */
+	// Eat spurious WM_TIMER messages
 	while (pPeekMessage(&msg, s_hwnd, WM_TIMER, WM_TIMER, PM_REMOVE))
 	    ;
 	blink_timer = 0;
@@ -650,7 +649,7 @@ gui_mch_start_blink(void)
 {
     gui_mswin_rm_blink_timer();
 
-    /* Only switch blinking on if none of the times is zero */
+    // Only switch blinking on if none of the times is zero
     if (blink_waittime && blink_ontime && blink_offtime && gui.in_focus)
     {
 	blink_timer = (UINT)SetTimer(NULL, 0, (UINT)blink_waittime,
@@ -680,7 +679,7 @@ gui_mch_start_blink(void)
     KillTimer(NULL, idEvent);
     s_timed_out = TRUE;
 
-    /* Eat spurious WM_TIMER messages */
+    // Eat spurious WM_TIMER messages
     while (pPeekMessage(&msg, hwnd, WM_TIMER, WM_TIMER, PM_REMOVE))
 	;
     if (idEvent == s_wait_timer)
@@ -717,17 +716,17 @@ char_to_string(int ch, char_u *string, i
 
     if (surrogate_pending_ch != 0)
     {
-	/* We don't guarantee ch is a low surrogate to match the high surrogate
-	 * we already have; it should be, but if it isn't, tough luck. */
+	// We don't guarantee ch is a low surrogate to match the high surrogate
+	// we already have; it should be, but if it isn't, tough luck.
 	wstring[0] = surrogate_pending_ch;
 	wstring[1] = ch;
 	surrogate_pending_ch = 0;
 	len = 2;
     }
-    else if (ch >= 0xD800 && ch <= 0xDBFF)	/* high surrogate */
-    {
-	/* We don't have the entire code point yet, only the first UTF-16 code
-	 * unit; so just remember it and use it in the next call. */
+    else if (ch >= 0xD800 && ch <= 0xDBFF)	// high surrogate
+    {
+	// We don't have the entire code point yet, only the first UTF-16 code
+	// unit; so just remember it and use it in the next call.
 	surrogate_pending_ch = ch;
 	return 0;
     }
@@ -737,23 +736,23 @@ char_to_string(int ch, char_u *string, i
 	len = 1;
     }
 
-    /* "ch" is a UTF-16 character.  Convert it to a string of bytes.  When
-     * "enc_codepage" is non-zero use the standard Win32 function,
-     * otherwise use our own conversion function (e.g., for UTF-8). */
+    // "ch" is a UTF-16 character.  Convert it to a string of bytes.  When
+    // "enc_codepage" is non-zero use the standard Win32 function,
+    // otherwise use our own conversion function (e.g., for UTF-8).
     if (enc_codepage > 0)
     {
 	len = WideCharToMultiByte(enc_codepage, 0, wstring, len,
 		(LPSTR)string, slen, 0, NULL);
-	/* If we had included the ALT key into the character but now the
-	 * upper bit is no longer set, that probably means the conversion
-	 * failed.  Convert the original character and set the upper bit
-	 * afterwards. */
+	// If we had included the ALT key into the character but now the
+	// upper bit is no longer set, that probably means the conversion
+	// failed.  Convert the original character and set the upper bit
+	// afterwards.
 	if (had_alt && len == 1 && ch >= 0x80 && string[0] < 0x80)
 	{
 	    wstring[0] = ch & 0x7f;
 	    len = WideCharToMultiByte(enc_codepage, 0, wstring, len,
 		    (LPSTR)string, slen, 0, NULL);
-	    if (len == 1) /* safety check */
+	    if (len == 1) // safety check
 		string[0] |= 0x80;
 	}
     }
@@ -764,7 +763,7 @@ char_to_string(int ch, char_u *string, i
 	    len = 0;
 	else
 	{
-	    if (len > slen)	/* just in case */
+	    if (len > slen)	// just in case
 		len = slen;
 	    mch_memmove(string, ws, len);
 	    vim_free(ws);
@@ -780,7 +779,7 @@ char_to_string(int ch, char_u *string, i
     for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
 	if (string[i] == CSI && len <= slen - 2)
 	{
-	    /* Insert CSI as K_CSI. */
+	    // Insert CSI as K_CSI.
 	    mch_memmove(string + i + 3, string + i + 1, len - i - 1);
 	    string[++i] = KS_EXTRA;
 	    string[++i] = (int)KE_CSI;
@@ -823,20 +822,19 @@ char_to_string(int ch, char_u *string, i
     UINT cch,
     int cRepeat UNUSED)
 {
-    char_u	string[40]; /* Enough for multibyte character */
+    char_u	string[40]; // Enough for multibyte character
     int		len;
     int		modifiers;
-    int		ch = cch;   /* special keys are negative */
+    int		ch = cch;   // special keys are negative
 
     dead_key = 0;
 
-    /* TRACE("OnSysChar(%d, %c)\n", ch, ch); */
-
-    /* OK, we have a character key (given by ch) which was entered with the
-     * ALT key pressed. Eg, if the user presses Alt-A, then ch == 'A'. Note
-     * that the system distinguishes Alt-a and Alt-A (Alt-Shift-a unless
-     * CAPSLOCK is pressed) at this point.
-     */
+    // TRACE("OnSysChar(%d, %c)\n", ch, ch);
+
+    // OK, we have a character key (given by ch) which was entered with the
+    // ALT key pressed. Eg, if the user presses Alt-A, then ch == 'A'. Note
+    // that the system distinguishes Alt-a and Alt-A (Alt-Shift-a unless
+    // CAPSLOCK is pressed) at this point.
     modifiers = MOD_MASK_ALT;
     if (GetKeyState(VK_SHIFT) & 0x8000)
 	modifiers |= MOD_MASK_SHIFT;
@@ -844,12 +842,12 @@ char_to_string(int ch, char_u *string, i
 	modifiers |= MOD_MASK_CTRL;
 
     ch = simplify_key(ch, &modifiers);
-    /* remove the SHIFT modifier for keys where it's already included, e.g.,
-     * '(' and '*' */
+    // remove the SHIFT modifier for keys where it's already included, e.g.,
+    // '(' and '*'
     if (ch < 0x100 && !isalpha(ch) && isprint(ch))
 	modifiers &= ~MOD_MASK_SHIFT;
 
-    /* Interpret the ALT key as making the key META, include SHIFT, etc. */
+    // Interpret the ALT key as making the key META, include SHIFT, etc.
     ch = extract_modifiers(ch, &modifiers, TRUE, NULL);
     if (ch == CSI)
 	ch = K_CSI;
@@ -870,8 +868,8 @@ char_to_string(int ch, char_u *string, i
     }
     else
     {
-	/* Although the documentation isn't clear about it, we assume "ch" is
-	 * a Unicode character. */
+	// Although the documentation isn't clear about it, we assume "ch" is
+	// a Unicode character.
 	len += char_to_string(ch, string + len, 40 - len, TRUE);
     }
 
@@ -914,7 +912,7 @@ char_to_string(int ch, char_u *string, i
     int	    button = -1;
     int	    repeated_click;
 
-    /* Give main window the focus: this is so the cursor isn't hollow. */
+    // Give main window the focus: this is so the cursor isn't hollow.
     (void)SetFocus(s_hwnd);
 
     if (s_uMsg == WM_LBUTTONDOWN || s_uMsg == WM_LBUTTONDBLCLK)
@@ -932,8 +930,8 @@ char_to_string(int ch, char_u *string, i
     }
     else if (s_uMsg == WM_CAPTURECHANGED)
     {
-	/* on W95/NT4, somehow you get in here with an odd Msg
-	 * if you press one button while holding down the other..*/
+	// on W95/NT4, somehow you get in here with an odd Msg
+	// if you press one button while holding down the other..
 	if (s_button_pending == MOUSE_LEFT)
 	    button = MOUSE_RIGHT;
 	else
@@ -970,7 +968,7 @@ char_to_string(int ch, char_u *string, i
 		    _OnMouseEvent(s_button_pending, x, y, FALSE, keyFlags);
 		    s_button_pending = -1;
 	    }
-	    /* TRACE("Button down at x %d, y %d\n", x, y); */
+	    // TRACE("Button down at x %d, y %d\n", x, y);
 	    _OnMouseEvent(button, x, y, repeated_click, keyFlags);
 	}
 	else
@@ -1010,7 +1008,7 @@ char_to_string(int ch, char_u *string, i
     s_getting_focus = FALSE;
     if (s_button_pending > -1)
     {
-	/* Delayed action for mouse down event */
+	// Delayed action for mouse down event
 	_OnMouseEvent(s_button_pending, s_x_pending,
 					s_y_pending, FALSE, s_kFlags_pending);
 	s_button_pending = -1;
@@ -1034,13 +1032,13 @@ char_to_string(int ch, char_u *string, i
 	 */
 	SetCapture(s_textArea);
 	button = MOUSE_DRAG;
-	/* TRACE("  move at x %d, y %d\n", x, y); */
+	// TRACE("  move at x %d, y %d\n", x, y);
     }
     else
     {
 	ReleaseCapture();
 	button = MOUSE_RELEASE;
-	/* TRACE("  up at x %d, y %d\n", x, y); */
+	// TRACE("  up at x %d, y %d\n", x, y);
     }
 
     _OnMouseEvent(button, x, y, FALSE, keyFlags);
@@ -1114,23 +1112,23 @@ gui_mswin_find_menu(
     int	    down;
 
     if (s_findrep_struct.Flags & FR_DIALOGTERM)
-	/* Give main window the focus back. */
+	// Give main window the focus back.
 	(void)SetFocus(s_hwnd);
 
     if (s_findrep_struct.Flags & FR_FINDNEXT)
     {
 	flags = FRD_FINDNEXT;
 
-	/* Give main window the focus back: this is so the cursor isn't
-	 * hollow. */
+	// Give main window the focus back: this is so the cursor isn't
+	// hollow.
 	(void)SetFocus(s_hwnd);
     }
     else if (s_findrep_struct.Flags & FR_REPLACE)
     {
 	flags = FRD_REPLACE;
 
-	/* Give main window the focus back: this is so the cursor isn't
-	 * hollow. */
+	// Give main window the focus back: this is so the cursor isn't
+	// hollow.
 	(void)SetFocus(s_hwnd);
     }
     else if (s_findrep_struct.Flags & FR_REPLACEALL)
@@ -1142,7 +1140,7 @@ gui_mswin_find_menu(
     {
 	char_u	*p, *q;
 
-	/* Call the generic GUI function to do the actual work. */
+	// Call the generic GUI function to do the actual work.
 	if (s_findrep_struct.Flags & FR_WHOLEWORD)
 	    flags |= FRD_WHOLE_WORD;
 	if (s_findrep_struct.Flags & FR_MATCHCASE)
@@ -1163,7 +1161,7 @@ HandleMouseHide(UINT uMsg, LPARAM lParam
 {
     static LPARAM last_lParam = 0L;
 
-    /* We sometimes get a mousemove when the mouse didn't move... */
+    // We sometimes get a mousemove when the mouse didn't move...
     if (uMsg == WM_MOUSEMOVE || uMsg == WM_NCMOUSEMOVE)
     {
 	if (lParam == last_lParam)
@@ -1171,10 +1169,9 @@ HandleMouseHide(UINT uMsg, LPARAM lParam
 	last_lParam = lParam;
     }
 
-    /* Handle specially, to centralise coding. We need to be sure we catch all
-     * possible events which should cause us to restore the cursor (as it is a
-     * shared resource, we take full responsibility for it).
-     */
+    // Handle specially, to centralise coding. We need to be sure we catch all
+    // possible events which should cause us to restore the cursor (as it is a
+    // shared resource, we take full responsibility for it).
     switch (uMsg)
     {
     case WM_KEYUP:
@@ -1186,9 +1183,9 @@ HandleMouseHide(UINT uMsg, LPARAM lParam
 	    gui_mch_mousehide(TRUE);
 	break;
 
-    case WM_SYSKEYUP:	 /* show the pointer when a system-key is pressed */
+    case WM_SYSKEYUP:	 // show the pointer when a system-key is pressed
     case WM_SYSCHAR:
-    case WM_MOUSEMOVE:	 /* show the pointer on any mouse action */
+    case WM_MOUSEMOVE:	 // show the pointer on any mouse action
     case WM_LBUTTONDOWN:
     case WM_LBUTTONUP:
     case WM_MBUTTONDOWN:
@@ -1309,14 +1306,14 @@ gui_mch_def_colors(void)
     int
 gui_mch_open(void)
 {
-    /* Actually open the window, if not already visible
-     * (may be done already in gui_mch_set_shellsize) */
+    // Actually open the window, if not already visible
+    // (may be done already in gui_mch_set_shellsize)
     if (!IsWindowVisible(s_hwnd))
 	ShowWindow(s_hwnd, SW_SHOWDEFAULT);
 
 #ifdef MSWIN_FIND_REPLACE
-    /* Init replace string here, so that we keep it when re-opening the
-     * dialog. */
+    // Init replace string here, so that we keep it when re-opening the
+    // dialog.
     s_findrep_struct.lpstrReplaceWith[0] = NUL;
 #endif
 
@@ -1375,9 +1372,9 @@ gui_mch_set_text_area_pos(int x, int y, 
     }
 #endif
 
-    /* When side scroll bar is unshown, the size of window will change.
-     * then, the text area move left or right. thus client rect should be
-     * forcedly redrawn. (Yasuhiro Matsumoto) */
+    // When side scroll bar is unshown, the size of window will change.
+    // then, the text area move left or right. thus client rect should be
+    // forcedly redrawn. (Yasuhiro Matsumoto)
     if (oldx != x || oldy != y)
     {
 	InvalidateRect(s_hwnd, NULL, FALSE);
@@ -1398,9 +1395,9 @@ gui_mch_enable_scrollbar(
 {
     ShowScrollBar(sb->id, SB_CTL, flag);
 
-    /* TODO: When the window is maximized, the size of the window stays the
-     * same, thus the size of the text area changes.  On Win98 it's OK, on Win
-     * NT 4.0 it's not... */
+    // TODO: When the window is maximized, the size of the window stays the
+    // same, thus the size of the text area changes.  On Win98 it's OK, on Win
+    // NT 4.0 it's not...
 }
 
     void
@@ -1418,13 +1415,13 @@ gui_mch_set_scrollbar_pos(
     void
 gui_mch_create_scrollbar(
     scrollbar_T *sb,
-    int		orient)	/* SBAR_VERT or SBAR_HORIZ */
+    int		orient)	// SBAR_VERT or SBAR_HORIZ
 {
     sb->id = CreateWindow(
 	"SCROLLBAR", "Scrollbar",
 	WS_CHILD | ((orient == SBAR_VERT) ? SBS_VERT : SBS_HORZ), 0, 0,
-	10,				/* Any value will do for now */
-	10,				/* Any value will do for now */
+	10,				// Any value will do for now
+	10,				// Any value will do for now
 	s_hwnd, NULL,
 	g_hinst, NULL);
 }
@@ -1491,7 +1488,7 @@ get_font_handle(LOGFONTW *lf)
 {
     HFONT   font = NULL;
 
-    /* Load the font */
+    // Load the font
     font = CreateFontIndirectW(lf);
 
     if (font == NULL)
@@ -1722,7 +1719,7 @@ gui_mch_draw_part_cursor(
      */
     rc.left =
 #ifdef FEAT_RIGHTLEFT
-		/* vertical line should be on the right of current point */
+		// vertical line should be on the right of current point
 		CURSOR_BAR_RIGHT ? FILL_X(gui.col + 1) - w :
 #endif
 		    FILL_X(gui.col);
@@ -1748,14 +1745,14 @@ outputDeadKey_rePost(MSG originalMsg)
 
     dead_key = 0;
 
-    /* Make Windows generate the dead key's character */
+    // Make Windows generate the dead key's character
     deadCharExpel.message = originalMsg.message;
     deadCharExpel.hwnd    = originalMsg.hwnd;
     deadCharExpel.wParam  = VK_SPACE;
 
     MyTranslateMessage(&deadCharExpel);
 
-    /* re-generate the current character free of the dead char influence */
+    // re-generate the current character free of the dead char influence
     PostMessage(originalMsg.hwnd, originalMsg.message, originalMsg.wParam,
 							  originalMsg.lParam);
 }
@@ -1769,7 +1766,7 @@ outputDeadKey_rePost(MSG originalMsg)
 process_message(void)
 {
     MSG		msg;
-    UINT	vk = 0;		/* Virtual key */
+    UINT	vk = 0;		// Virtual key
     char_u	string[40];
     int		i;
     int		modifiers = 0;
@@ -1781,27 +1778,27 @@ process_message(void)
     pGetMessage(&msg, NULL, 0, 0);
 
 #ifdef FEAT_OLE
-    /* Look after OLE Automation commands */
+    // Look after OLE Automation commands
     if (msg.message == WM_OLE)
     {
 	char_u *str = (char_u *)msg.lParam;
 	if (str == NULL || *str == NUL)
 	{
-	    /* Message can't be ours, forward it.  Fixes problem with Ultramon
-	     * 3.0.4 */
+	    // Message can't be ours, forward it.  Fixes problem with Ultramon
+	    // 3.0.4
 	    pDispatchMessage(&msg);
 	}
 	else
 	{
 	    add_to_input_buf(str, (int)STRLEN(str));
-	    vim_free(str);  /* was allocated in CVim::SendKeys() */
+	    vim_free(str);  // was allocated in CVim::SendKeys()
 	}
 	return;
     }
 #endif
 
 #ifdef MSWIN_FIND_REPLACE
-    /* Don't process messages used by the dialog */
+    // Don't process messages used by the dialog
     if (s_findrep_hwnd != NULL && pIsDialogMessage(s_findrep_hwnd, &msg))
     {
 	HandleMouseHide(msg.message, msg.lParam);
@@ -1851,8 +1848,8 @@ process_message(void)
 		MyTranslateMessage(&msg);
 		return;
 	    }
-	    /* In modes where we are not typing, dead keys should behave
-	     * normally */
+	    // In modes where we are not typing, dead keys should behave
+	    // normally
 	    else if (!(get_real_state() & (INSERT | CMDLINE | SELECTMODE)))
 	    {
 		outputDeadKey_rePost(msg);
@@ -1860,7 +1857,7 @@ process_message(void)
 	    }
 	}
 
-	/* Check for CTRL-BREAK */
+	// Check for CTRL-BREAK
 	if (vk == VK_CANCEL)
 	{
 	    trash_input_buf();
@@ -1872,7 +1869,7 @@ process_message(void)
 
 	for (i = 0; special_keys[i].key_sym != 0; i++)
 	{
-	    /* ignore VK_SPACE when ALT key pressed: system menu */
+	    // ignore VK_SPACE when ALT key pressed: system menu
 	    if (special_keys[i].key_sym == vk
 		    && (vk != VK_SPACE || !(GetKeyState(VK_MENU) & 0x8000)))
 	    {
@@ -1890,8 +1887,8 @@ process_message(void)
 		}
 
 #ifdef FEAT_MENU
-		/* Check for <F10>: Windows selects the menu.  When <F10> is
-		 * mapped we want to use the mapping instead. */
+		// Check for <F10>: Windows selects the menu.  When <F10> is
+		// mapped we want to use the mapping instead.
 		if (vk == VK_F10
 			&& gui.menu_is_active
 			&& check_map(k10, State, FALSE, TRUE, FALSE,
@@ -1942,7 +1939,7 @@ process_message(void)
 		{
 		    int	len;
 
-		    /* Handle "key" as a Unicode character. */
+		    // Handle "key" as a Unicode character.
 		    len = char_to_string(key, string, 40, FALSE);
 		    add_to_input_buf(string, len);
 		}
@@ -1951,27 +1948,27 @@ process_message(void)
 	}
 	if (special_keys[i].key_sym == 0)
 	{
-	    /* Some keys need C-S- where they should only need C-.
-	     * Ignore 0xff, Windows XP sends it when NUMLOCK has changed since
-	     * system startup (Helmut Stiegler, 2003 Oct 3). */
+	    // Some keys need C-S- where they should only need C-.
+	    // Ignore 0xff, Windows XP sends it when NUMLOCK has changed since
+	    // system startup (Helmut Stiegler, 2003 Oct 3).
 	    if (vk != 0xff
 		    && (GetKeyState(VK_CONTROL) & 0x8000)
 		    && !(GetKeyState(VK_SHIFT) & 0x8000)
 		    && !(GetKeyState(VK_MENU) & 0x8000))
 	    {
-		/* CTRL-6 is '^'; Japanese keyboard maps '^' to vk == 0xDE */
+		// CTRL-6 is '^'; Japanese keyboard maps '^' to vk == 0xDE
 		if (vk == '6' || MapVirtualKey(vk, 2) == (UINT)'^')
 		{
 		    string[0] = Ctrl_HAT;
 		    add_to_input_buf(string, 1);
 		}
-		/* vk == 0xBD AZERTY for CTRL-'-', but CTRL-[ for * QWERTY! */
-		else if (vk == 0xBD)	/* QWERTY for CTRL-'-' */
+		// vk == 0xBD AZERTY for CTRL-'-', but CTRL-[ for * QWERTY!
+		else if (vk == 0xBD)	// QWERTY for CTRL-'-'
 		{
 		    string[0] = Ctrl__;
 		    add_to_input_buf(string, 1);
 		}
-		/* CTRL-2 is '@'; Japanese keyboard maps '@' to vk == 0xC0 */
+		// CTRL-2 is '@'; Japanese keyboard maps '@' to vk == 0xC0
 		else if (vk == '2' || MapVirtualKey(vk, 2) == (UINT)'@')
 		{
 		    string[0] = Ctrl_AT;
@@ -1988,11 +1985,11 @@ process_message(void)
     else if (msg.message == WM_IME_NOTIFY)
 	_OnImeNotify(msg.hwnd, (DWORD)msg.wParam, (DWORD)msg.lParam);
     else if (msg.message == WM_KEYUP && im_get_status())
-	/* added for non-MS IME (Yasuhiro Matsumoto) */
+	// added for non-MS IME (Yasuhiro Matsumoto)
 	MyTranslateMessage(&msg);
 #endif
 #if !defined(FEAT_MBYTE_IME) && defined(GLOBAL_IME)
-/* GIME_TEST */
+// GIME_TEST
     else if (msg.message == WM_IME_STARTCOMPOSITION)
     {
 	POINT point;
@@ -2006,9 +2003,9 @@ process_message(void)
 #endif
 
 #ifdef FEAT_MENU
-    /* Check for <F10>: Default effect is to select the menu.  When <F10> is
-     * mapped we need to stop it here to avoid strange effects (e.g., for the
-     * key-up event) */
+    // Check for <F10>: Default effect is to select the menu.  When <F10> is
+    // mapped we need to stop it here to avoid strange effects (e.g., for the
+    // key-up event)
     if (vk != VK_F10 || check_map(k10, State, FALSE, TRUE, FALSE,
 							  NULL, NULL) == NULL)
 #endif
@@ -2041,7 +2038,7 @@ remove_any_timer(void)
     {
 	KillTimer(NULL, s_wait_timer);
 
-	/* Eat spurious WM_TIMER messages */
+	// Eat spurious WM_TIMER messages
 	while (pPeekMessage(&msg, s_hwnd, WM_TIMER, WM_TIMER, PM_REMOVE))
 	    ;
 	s_wait_timer = 0;
@@ -2213,7 +2210,7 @@ gui_mch_set_menu_pos(
     int	    w UNUSED,
     int	    h UNUSED)
 {
-    /* It will be in the right place anyway */
+    // It will be in the right place anyway
 }
 
 #if defined(FEAT_MENU) || defined(PROTO)
@@ -2245,7 +2242,7 @@ gui_mch_draw_menubar(void)
 {
     DrawMenuBar(s_hwnd);
 }
-#endif /*FEAT_MENU*/
+#endif // FEAT_MENU
 
 /*
  * Return the RGB value of a pixel as a long.
@@ -2258,21 +2255,27 @@ gui_mch_get_rgb(guicolor_T pixel)
 }
 
 #if defined(FEAT_GUI_DIALOG) || defined(PROTO)
-/* Convert pixels in X to dialog units */
+/*
+ * Convert pixels in X to dialog units
+ */
     static WORD
 PixelToDialogX(int numPixels)
 {
     return (WORD)((numPixels * 4) / s_dlgfntwidth);
 }
 
-/* Convert pixels in Y to dialog units */
+/*
+ * Convert pixels in Y to dialog units
+ */
     static WORD
 PixelToDialogY(int numPixels)
 {
     return (WORD)((numPixels * 8) / s_dlgfntheight);
 }
 
-/* Return the width in pixels of the given text in the given DC. */
+/*
+ * Return the width in pixels of the given text in the given DC.
+ */
     static int
 GetTextWidth(HDC hdc, char_u *str, int len)
 {
@@ -2328,7 +2331,7 @@ CenterWindow(
     wChild = rChild.right - rChild.left;
     hChild = rChild.bottom - rChild.top;
 
-    /* If Vim is minimized put the window in the middle of the screen. */
+    // If Vim is minimized put the window in the middle of the screen.
     if (hwndParent == NULL || IsMinimized(hwndParent))
 	get_work_area(&rParent);
     else
@@ -2367,7 +2370,7 @@ CenterWindow(
     return SetWindowPos(hwndChild, NULL, xNew, yNew, 0, 0,
 						   SWP_NOSIZE | SWP_NOZORDER);
 }
-#endif /* FEAT_GUI_DIALOG */
+#endif // FEAT_GUI_DIALOG
 
 #if defined(FEAT_TOOLBAR) || defined(PROTO)
     void
@@ -2391,7 +2394,7 @@ gui_mch_show_toolbar(int showit)
 	ShowWindow(s_toolbarhwnd, SW_HIDE);
 }
 
-/* The number of bitmaps is fixed.  Exit is missing! */
+// The number of bitmaps is fixed.  Exit is missing!
 # define TOOLBAR_BITMAP_COUNT 31
 
 #endif
@@ -2424,7 +2427,7 @@ show_tabline_popup_menu(void)
     long	    rval;
     POINT	    pt;
 
-    /* When ignoring events don't show the menu. */
+    // When ignoring events don't show the menu.
     if (hold_gui_events
 # ifdef FEAT_CMDWIN
 	    || cmdwin_type != 0
@@ -2450,7 +2453,7 @@ show_tabline_popup_menu(void)
 
     DestroyMenu(tab_pmenu);
 
-    /* Add the string cmd into input buffer */
+    // Add the string cmd into input buffer
     if (rval > 0)
     {
 	TCHITTESTINFO htinfo;
@@ -2516,7 +2519,7 @@ gui_mch_update_tabline(void)
 	return;
 
 # ifndef CCM_SETUNICODEFORMAT
-    /* For older compilers.  We assume this never changes. */
+    // For older compilers.  We assume this never changes.
 #  define CCM_SETUNICODEFORMAT 0x2005
 # endif
     // Enable unicode support
@@ -2525,10 +2528,10 @@ gui_mch_update_tabline(void)
     tie.mask = TCIF_TEXT;
     tie.iImage = -1;
 
-    /* Disable redraw for tab updates to eliminate O(N^2) draws. */
+    // Disable redraw for tab updates to eliminate O(N^2) draws.
     SendMessage(s_tabhwnd, WM_SETREDRAW, (WPARAM)FALSE, 0);
 
-    /* Add a label for each tab page.  They all contain the same text area. */
+    // Add a label for each tab page.  They all contain the same text area.
     for (tp = first_tabpage; tp != NULL; tp = tp->tp_next, ++nr)
     {
 	if (tp == curtab)
@@ -2536,7 +2539,7 @@ gui_mch_update_tabline(void)
 
 	if (nr >= TabCtrl_GetItemCount(s_tabhwnd))
 	{
-	    /* Add the tab */
+	    // Add the tab
 	    tie.pszText = "-Empty-";
 	    TabCtrl_InsertItem(s_tabhwnd, nr, &tie);
 	    tabadded = 1;
@@ -2558,14 +2561,14 @@ gui_mch_update_tabline(void)
 	}
     }
 
-    /* Remove any old labels. */
+    // Remove any old labels.
     while (nr < TabCtrl_GetItemCount(s_tabhwnd))
 	TabCtrl_DeleteItem(s_tabhwnd, nr);
 
     if (!tabadded && TabCtrl_GetCurSel(s_tabhwnd) != curtabidx)
 	TabCtrl_SetCurSel(s_tabhwnd, curtabidx);
 
-    /* Re-enable redraw and redraw. */
+    // Re-enable redraw and redraw.
     SendMessage(s_tabhwnd, WM_SETREDRAW, (WPARAM)TRUE, 0);
     RedrawWindow(s_tabhwnd, NULL, NULL,
 		    RDW_ERASE | RDW_FRAME | RDW_INVALIDATE | RDW_ALLCHILDREN);
@@ -2603,15 +2606,15 @@ ex_simalt(exarg_T *eap)
     while (*keys)
     {
 	if (*keys == '~')
-	    *keys = ' ';	    /* for showing system menu */
+	    *keys = ' ';	    // for showing system menu
 	PostMessage(s_hwnd, WM_CHAR, (WPARAM)*keys, (LPARAM)0);
 	keys++;
 	fill_typebuf = TRUE;
     }
     if (fill_typebuf)
     {
-	/* Put a NOP in the typeahead buffer so that the message will get
-	 * processed. */
+	// Put a NOP in the typeahead buffer so that the message will get
+	// processed.
 	key_name[0] = K_SPECIAL;
 	key_name[1] = KS_EXTRA;
 	key_name[2] = KE_NOP;
@@ -2636,7 +2639,7 @@ initialise_findrep(char_u *initial_strin
     int		mcase = !p_ic;
     char_u	*entry_text;
 
-    /* Get the search string to use. */
+    // Get the search string to use.
     entry_text = get_find_dialog_text(initial_string, &wword, &mcase);
 
     s_findrep_struct.hwndOwner = s_hwnd;
@@ -2668,7 +2671,7 @@ set_window_title(HWND hwnd, char *title)
     {
 	WCHAR	*wbuf;
 
-	/* Convert the title from 'encoding' to UTF-16. */
+	// Convert the title from 'encoding' to UTF-16.
 	wbuf = (WCHAR *)enc_to_utf16((char_u *)title, NULL);
 	if (wbuf != NULL)
 	{
@@ -2745,14 +2748,14 @@ gui_mch_mousehide(int hide)
     static void
 gui_mch_show_popupmenu_at(vimmenu_T *menu, int x, int y)
 {
-    /* Unhide the mouse, we don't get move events here. */
+    // Unhide the mouse, we don't get move events here.
     gui_mch_mousehide(FALSE);
 
     (void)TrackPopupMenu(
 	(HMENU)menu->submenu_id,
 	TPM_LEFTALIGN | TPM_LEFTBUTTON,
 	x, y,
-	(int)0,	    /*reserved param*/
+	(int)0,	    //reserved param
 	s_hwnd,
 	NULL);
     /*
@@ -2799,11 +2802,11 @@ gui_mch_show_popupmenu_at(vimmenu_T *men
     {
 	PAINTSTRUCT ps;
 
-	out_flush();	    /* make sure all output has been processed */
+	out_flush();	    // make sure all output has been processed
 	(void)BeginPaint(hwnd, &ps);
 
-	/* prevent multi-byte characters from misprinting on an invalid
-	 * rectangle */
+	// prevent multi-byte characters from misprinting on an invalid
+	// rectangle
 	if (has_mbyte)
 	{
 	    RECT rect;
@@ -2836,7 +2839,7 @@ gui_mch_show_popupmenu_at(vimmenu_T *men
 	gui_resize_shell(cx, cy);
 
 #ifdef FEAT_MENU
-	/* Menu bar may wrap differently now */
+	// Menu bar may wrap differently now
 	gui_mswin_get_menu_height(TRUE);
 #endif
     }
@@ -2871,8 +2874,8 @@ gui_mch_show_popupmenu_at(vimmenu_T *men
     BOOL fActivate,
     DWORD dwThreadId)
 {
-    /* we call gui_focus_change() in _OnSetFocus() */
-    /* gui_focus_change((int)fActivate); */
+    // we call gui_focus_change() in _OnSetFocus()
+    // gui_focus_change((int)fActivate);
     return MyWindowProc(hwnd, WM_ACTIVATEAPP, fActivate, (DWORD)dwThreadId);
 }
 
@@ -2954,9 +2957,9 @@ gui_mch_flash(int msec)
     rc.right = gui.num_cols * gui.char_width;
     rc.bottom = gui.num_rows * gui.char_height;
     InvertRect(s_hdc, &rc);
-    gui_mch_flush();			/* make sure it's displayed */
-
-    ui_delay((long)msec, TRUE);	/* wait for a few msec */
+    gui_mch_flush();			// make sure it's displayed
+
+    ui_delay((long)msec, TRUE);	// wait for a few msec
 
     InvertRect(s_hdc, &rc);
 }
@@ -2974,13 +2977,13 @@ get_scroll_flags(void)
 
     GetWindowRect(s_hwnd, &rcVim);
 
-    /* Check if the window is partly above or below the screen.  We don't care
-     * about partly left or right of the screen, it is not relevant when
-     * scrolling up or down. */
+    // Check if the window is partly above or below the screen.  We don't care
+    // about partly left or right of the screen, it is not relevant when
+    // scrolling up or down.
     if (rcVim.top < 0 || rcVim.bottom > GetSystemMetrics(SM_CYFULLSCREEN))
 	return SW_INVALIDATE;
 
-    /* Check if there is an window (partly) on top of us. */
+    // Check if there is an window (partly) on top of us.
     for (hwnd = s_hwnd; (hwnd = GetWindow(hwnd, GW_HWNDPREV)) != (HWND)0; )
 	if (IsWindowVisible(hwnd))
 	{
@@ -3036,11 +3039,11 @@ gui_mch_delete_lines(
 	UpdateWindow(s_textArea);
     }
 
-    /* This seems to be required to avoid the cursor disappearing when
-     * scrolling such that the cursor ends up in the top-left character on
-     * the screen...   But why?  (Webb) */
-    /* It's probably fixed by disabling drawing the cursor while scrolling. */
-    /* gui.cursor_is_valid = FALSE; */
+    // This seems to be required to avoid the cursor disappearing when
+    // scrolling such that the cursor ends up in the top-left character on
+    // the screen...   But why?  (Webb)
+    // It's probably fixed by disabling drawing the cursor while scrolling.
+    // gui.cursor_is_valid = FALSE;
 
     gui_clear_block(gui.scroll_region_bot - num_lines + 1,
 						       gui.scroll_region_left,
@@ -3073,8 +3076,8 @@ gui_mch_insert_lines(
 #endif
     {
 	intel_gpu_workaround();
-	/* The SW_INVALIDATE is required when part of the window is covered or
-	 * off-screen.  How do we avoid it when it's not needed? */
+	// The SW_INVALIDATE is required when part of the window is covered or
+	// off-screen.  How do we avoid it when it's not needed?
 	ScrollWindowEx(s_textArea, 0, num_lines * gui.char_height,
 				    &rc, &rc, NULL, NULL, get_scroll_flags());
 	UpdateWindow(s_textArea);
@@ -3098,14 +3101,14 @@ gui_mch_exit(int rc UNUSED)
     DeleteObject(s_brush);
 
 #ifdef FEAT_TEAROFF
-    /* Unload the tearoff bitmap */
+    // Unload the tearoff bitmap
     (void)DeleteObject((HGDIOBJ)s_htearbitmap);
 #endif
 
-    /* Destroy our window (if we have one). */
+    // Destroy our window (if we have one).
     if (s_hwnd != NULL)
     {
-	destroying = TRUE;	/* ignore WM_DESTROY message now */
+	destroying = TRUE;	// ignore WM_DESTROY message now
 	DestroyWindow(s_hwnd);
     }
 
@@ -3246,7 +3249,7 @@ gui_mch_init_font(char_u *font_name, int
     GuiFont	font = NOFONT;
     char_u	*p;
 
-    /* Load the font */
+    // Load the font
     if (get_logfont(&lf, font_name, NULL, TRUE) == OK)
 	font = get_font_handle(&lf);
     if (font == NOFONT)
@@ -3273,8 +3276,8 @@ gui_mch_init_font(char_u *font_name, int
     {
 	hl_set_font_name(p);
 
-	/* When setting 'guifont' to "*" replace it with the actual font name.
-	 * */
+	// When setting 'guifont' to "*" replace it with the actual font name.
+	//
 	if (STRCMP(font_name, "*") == 0 && STRCMP(p_guifont, "*") == 0)
 	{
 	    vim_free(p_guifont);
@@ -3312,7 +3315,7 @@ gui_mch_init_font(char_u *font_name, int
 }
 
 #ifndef WPF_RESTORETOMAXIMIZED
-# define WPF_RESTORETOMAXIMIZED 2   /* just in case someone doesn't have it */
+# define WPF_RESTORETOMAXIMIZED 2   // just in case someone doesn't have it
 #endif
 
 /*
@@ -3359,7 +3362,7 @@ gui_mch_newfont(void)
     }
     else
     {
-	/* Inside another window, don't use the frame and border. */
+	// Inside another window, don't use the frame and border.
 	gui_resize_shell(rect.right - rect.left,
 	    rect.bottom - rect.top
 #ifdef FEAT_MENU
@@ -3381,27 +3384,27 @@ gui_mch_settitle(
 }
 
 #if defined(FEAT_MOUSESHAPE) || defined(PROTO)
-/* Table for shape IDCs.  Keep in sync with the mshape_names[] table in
- * misc2.c! */
+// Table for shape IDCs.  Keep in sync with the mshape_names[] table in
+// misc2.c!
 static LPCSTR mshape_idcs[] =
 {
-    IDC_ARROW,			/* arrow */
-    MAKEINTRESOURCE(0),		/* blank */
-    IDC_IBEAM,			/* beam */
-    IDC_SIZENS,			/* updown */
-    IDC_SIZENS,			/* udsizing */
-    IDC_SIZEWE,			/* leftright */
-    IDC_SIZEWE,			/* lrsizing */
-    IDC_WAIT,			/* busy */
-    IDC_NO,			/* no */
-    IDC_ARROW,			/* crosshair */
-    IDC_ARROW,			/* hand1 */
-    IDC_ARROW,			/* hand2 */
-    IDC_ARROW,			/* pencil */
-    IDC_ARROW,			/* question */
-    IDC_ARROW,			/* right-arrow */
-    IDC_UPARROW,		/* up-arrow */
-    IDC_ARROW			/* last one */
+    IDC_ARROW,			// arrow
+    MAKEINTRESOURCE(0),		// blank
+    IDC_IBEAM,			// beam
+    IDC_SIZENS,			// updown
+    IDC_SIZENS,			// udsizing
+    IDC_SIZEWE,			// leftright
+    IDC_SIZEWE,			// lrsizing
+    IDC_WAIT,			// busy
+    IDC_NO,			// no
+    IDC_ARROW,			// crosshair
+    IDC_ARROW,			// hand1
+    IDC_ARROW,			// hand2
+    IDC_ARROW,			// pencil
+    IDC_ARROW,			// question
+    IDC_ARROW,			// right-arrow
+    IDC_UPARROW,		// up-arrow
+    IDC_ARROW			// last one
 };
 
     void
@@ -3422,7 +3425,7 @@ mch_set_mouse_shape(int shape)
 	{
 	    POINT mp;
 
-	    /* Set the position to make it redrawn with the new shape. */
+	    // Set the position to make it redrawn with the new shape.
 	    (void)GetCursorPos((LPPOINT)&mp);
 	    (void)SetCursorPos(mp.x, mp.y);
 	    ShowCursor(TRUE);
@@ -3470,8 +3473,8 @@ gui_mch_browse(
 	char_u *initdir,
 	char_u *filter)
 {
-    /* We always use the wide function.  This means enc_to_utf16() must work,
-     * otherwise it fails miserably! */
+    // We always use the wide function.  This means enc_to_utf16() must work,
+    // otherwise it fails miserably!
     OPENFILENAMEW	fileStruct;
     WCHAR		fileBuf[MAXPATHL];
     WCHAR		*wp;
@@ -3498,12 +3501,12 @@ gui_mch_browse(
 	}
     }
 
-    /* Convert the filter to Windows format. */
+    // Convert the filter to Windows format.
     filterp = convert_filterW(filter);
 
     vim_memset(&fileStruct, 0, sizeof(OPENFILENAMEW));
 # ifdef OPENFILENAME_SIZE_VERSION_400W
-    /* be compatible with Windows NT 4.0 */
+    // be compatible with Windows NT 4.0
     fileStruct.lStructSize = OPENFILENAME_SIZE_VERSION_400W;
 # else
     fileStruct.lStructSize = sizeof(fileStruct);
@@ -3520,11 +3523,11 @@ gui_mch_browse(
     fileStruct.lpstrFile = fileBuf;
     fileStruct.nMaxFile = MAXPATHL;
     fileStruct.lpstrFilter = filterp;
-    fileStruct.hwndOwner = s_hwnd;		/* main Vim window is owner*/
-    /* has an initial dir been specified? */
+    fileStruct.hwndOwner = s_hwnd;		// main Vim window is owner
+    // has an initial dir been specified?
     if (initdir != NULL && *initdir != NUL)
     {
-	/* Must have backslashes here, no matter what 'shellslash' says */
+	// Must have backslashes here, no matter what 'shellslash' says
 	initdirp = enc_to_utf16(initdir, NULL);
 	if (initdirp != NULL)
 	{
@@ -3564,15 +3567,15 @@ gui_mch_browse(
     vim_free(titlep);
     vim_free(extp);
 
-    /* Convert from UCS2 to 'encoding'. */
+    // Convert from UCS2 to 'encoding'.
     p = utf16_to_enc(fileBuf, NULL);
     if (p == NULL)
 	return NULL;
 
-    /* Give focus back to main window (when using MDI). */
+    // Give focus back to main window (when using MDI).
     SetFocus(s_hwnd);
 
-    /* Shorten the file name if possible */
+    // Shorten the file name if possible
     q = vim_strsave(shorten_fname1(p));
     vim_free(p);
     return q;
@@ -3602,7 +3605,7 @@ convert_filter(char_u *s)
 	    else
 		res[i] = s[i];
 	res[s_len] = NUL;
-	/* Add two extra NULs to make sure it's properly terminated. */
+	// Add two extra NULs to make sure it's properly terminated.
 	res[s_len + 1] = NUL;
 	res[s_len + 2] = NUL;
     }
@@ -3615,12 +3618,12 @@ convert_filter(char_u *s)
     char_u *
 gui_mch_browsedir(char_u *title, char_u *initdir)
 {
-    /* We fake this: Use a filter that doesn't select anything and a default
-     * file name that won't be used. */
+    // We fake this: Use a filter that doesn't select anything and a default
+    // file name that won't be used.
     return gui_mch_browse(0, title, (char_u *)_("Not Used"), NULL,
 			      initdir, (char_u *)_("Directory\t*.nothing\n"));
 }
-#endif /* FEAT_BROWSE */
+#endif // FEAT_BROWSE
 
     static void
 _OnDropFiles(
@@ -3637,9 +3640,9 @@ gui_mch_browsedir(char_u *title, char_u 
     POINT   pt;
     int_u   modifiers = 0;
 
-    /* TRACE("_OnDropFiles: %d files dropped\n", cFiles); */
-
-    /* Obtain dropped position */
+    // TRACE("_OnDropFiles: %d files dropped\n", cFiles);
+
+    // Obtain dropped position
     DragQueryPoint(hDrop, &pt);
     MapWindowPoints(s_hwnd, s_textArea, &pt, 1);
 
@@ -3683,7 +3686,7 @@ gui_mch_browsedir(char_u *title, char_u 
     UINT code,
     int pos)
 {
-    static UINT	prev_code = 0;   /* code of previous call */
+    static UINT	prev_code = 0;   // code of previous call
     scrollbar_T *sb, *sb_info;
     long	val;
     int		dragging = FALSE;
@@ -3697,7 +3700,7 @@ gui_mch_browsedir(char_u *title, char_u 
     if (sb == NULL)
 	return 0;
 
-    if (sb->wp != NULL)		/* Left or right scrollbar */
+    if (sb->wp != NULL)		// Left or right scrollbar
     {
 	/*
 	 * Careful: need to get scrollbar info out of first (left) scrollbar
@@ -3706,7 +3709,7 @@ gui_mch_browsedir(char_u *title, char_u 
 	 */
 	sb_info = &sb->wp->w_scrollbars[0];
     }
-    else	    /* Bottom scrollbar */
+    else	    // Bottom scrollbar
 	sb_info = sb;
     val = sb_info->value;
 
@@ -3751,7 +3754,7 @@ gui_mch_browsedir(char_u *title, char_u 
 	    break;
 
 	default:
-	    /* TRACE("Unknown scrollbar event %d\n", code); */
+	    // TRACE("Unknown scrollbar event %d\n", code);
 	    return 0;
     }
     prev_code = code;
@@ -3770,11 +3773,11 @@ gui_mch_browsedir(char_u *title, char_u 
 	SetScrollInfo(id, SB_CTL, &si, TRUE);
     }
 
-    /* Don't let us be interrupted here by another message. */
+    // Don't let us be interrupted here by another message.
     s_busy_processing = TRUE;
 
-    /* When "allow_scrollbar" is FALSE still need to remember the new
-     * position, but don't actually scroll by setting "dont_scroll". */
+    // When "allow_scrollbar" is FALSE still need to remember the new
+    // position, but don't actually scroll by setting "dont_scroll".
     dont_scroll = !allow_scrollbar;
 
     mch_disable_flush();
@@ -3902,10 +3905,10 @@ gui_mch_browsedir(char_u *title, char_u 
 #  define HANDLE_WM_DEADCHAR(hwnd, wParam, lParam, fn) \
     ((fn)((hwnd), (TCHAR)(wParam), (int)(short)LOWORD(lParam)), 0L)
 # endif
-#endif /* __MINGW32__ */
-
-
-/* Some parameters for tearoff menus.  All in pixels. */
+#endif // __MINGW32__
+
+
+// Some parameters for tearoff menus.  All in pixels.
 #define TEAROFF_PADDING_X	2
 #define TEAROFF_BUTTON_PAD_X	8
 #define TEAROFF_MIN_WIDTH	200
@@ -3913,7 +3916,7 @@ gui_mch_browsedir(char_u *title, char_u 
 #define TEAROFF_COLUMN_PADDING	3	// # spaces to pad column with.
 
 
-/* For the Intellimouse: */
+// For the Intellimouse:
 #ifndef WM_MOUSEWHEEL
 # define WM_MOUSEWHEEL	0x20a
 #endif
@@ -3924,8 +3927,8 @@ gui_mch_browsedir(char_u *title, char_u 
 # define BEVAL_TEXT_LEN	    MAXPATHL
 
 # if (defined(_MSC_VER) && _MSC_VER < 1300) || !defined(MAXULONG_PTR)
-/* Work around old versions of basetsd.h which wrongly declares
- * UINT_PTR as unsigned long. */
+// Work around old versions of basetsd.h which wrongly declares
+// UINT_PTR as unsigned long.
 #  undef  UINT_PTR
 #  define UINT_PTR UINT
 # endif
@@ -3935,7 +3938,7 @@ static UINT_PTR	    BevalTimerId = 0;
 static DWORD	    LastActivity = 0;
 
 
-/* cproto fails on missing include files */
+// cproto fails on missing include files
 # ifndef PROTO
 
 /*
@@ -4018,13 +4021,13 @@ typedef HRESULT (WINAPI* DLLGETVERSIONPR
 #  define TTN_GETDISPINFO	(TTN_FIRST - 0)
 # endif
 
-#endif /* defined(FEAT_BEVAL_GUI) */
+#endif // defined(FEAT_BEVAL_GUI)
 
 #if defined(FEAT_TOOLBAR) || defined(FEAT_GUI_TABLINE)
-/* Older MSVC compilers don't have LPNMTTDISPINFO[AW] thus we need to define
- * it here if LPNMTTDISPINFO isn't defined.
- * MingW doesn't define LPNMTTDISPINFO but typedefs it.  Thus we need to check
- * _MSC_VER. */
+// Older MSVC compilers don't have LPNMTTDISPINFO[AW] thus we need to define
+// it here if LPNMTTDISPINFO isn't defined.
+// MingW doesn't define LPNMTTDISPINFO but typedefs it.  Thus we need to check
+// _MSC_VER.
 # if !defined(LPNMTTDISPINFO) && defined(_MSC_VER)
 typedef struct tagNMTTDISPINFOA {
     NMHDR	hdr;
@@ -4051,7 +4054,7 @@ typedef struct tagNMTTDISPINFOW {
 # define TTN_GETDISPINFOW	(TTN_FIRST - 10)
 #endif
 
-/* Local variables: */
+// Local variables:
 
 #ifdef FEAT_MENU
 static UINT	s_menu_id = 100;
@@ -4066,9 +4069,9 @@ static UINT	s_menu_id = 100;
 #define VIM_NAME	"vim"
 #define VIM_CLASSW	L"Vim"
 
-/* Initial size for the dialog template.  For gui_mch_dialog() it's fixed,
- * thus there should be room for every dialog.  For tearoffs it's made bigger
- * when needed. */
+// Initial size for the dialog template.  For gui_mch_dialog() it's fixed,
+// thus there should be room for every dialog.  For tearoffs it's made bigger
+// when needed.
 #define DLG_ALLOC_SIZE 16 * 1024
 
 /*
@@ -4094,10 +4097,10 @@ static void get_dialog_font_metrics(void
 
 static int dialog_default_button = -1;
 
-/* Intellimouse support */
+// Intellimouse support
 static int mouse_scroll_lines = 0;
 
-static int	s_usenewlook;	    /* emulate W95/NT4 non-bold dialogs */
+static int	s_usenewlook;	    // emulate W95/NT4 non-bold dialogs
 #ifdef FEAT_TOOLBAR
 static void initialise_toolbar(void);
 static LRESULT CALLBACK toolbar_wndproc(HWND hwnd, UINT uMsg, WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam);
@@ -4158,7 +4161,7 @@ static void dyn_imm_load(void);
  */
     static int
 gui_mswin_get_menu_height(
-    int	    fix_window)	    /* If TRUE, resize window if menu height changed */
+    int	    fix_window)	    // If TRUE, resize window if menu height changed
 {
     static int	old_menu_height = -1;
 
@@ -4175,10 +4178,10 @@ gui_mswin_get_menu_height(
 	menu_height = 0;
     else if (IsMinimized(s_hwnd))
     {
-	/* The height of the menu cannot be determined while the window is
-	 * minimized.  Take the previous height if the menu is changed in that
-	 * state, to avoid that Vim's vertical window size accidentally
-	 * increases due to the unaccounted-for menu height. */
+	// The height of the menu cannot be determined while the window is
+	// minimized.  Take the previous height if the menu is changed in that
+	// state, to avoid that Vim's vertical window size accidentally
+	// increases due to the unaccounted-for menu height.
 	menu_height = old_menu_height == -1 ? 0 : old_menu_height;
     }
     else
@@ -4206,7 +4209,7 @@ gui_mswin_get_menu_height(
 
     return menu_height;
 }
-#endif /*FEAT_MENU*/
+#endif // FEAT_MENU
 
 
 /*
@@ -4223,14 +4226,14 @@ init_mouse_wheel(void)
 # define SPI_SETWHEELSCROLLLINES    105
 #endif
 
-#define VMOUSEZ_CLASSNAME  "MouseZ"		/* hidden wheel window class */
-#define VMOUSEZ_TITLE      "Magellan MSWHEEL"	/* hidden wheel window title */
+#define VMOUSEZ_CLASSNAME  "MouseZ"		// hidden wheel window class
+#define VMOUSEZ_TITLE      "Magellan MSWHEEL"	// hidden wheel window title
 #define VMSH_MOUSEWHEEL    "MSWHEEL_ROLLMSG"
 #define VMSH_SCROLL_LINES  "MSH_SCROLL_LINES_MSG"
 
-    mouse_scroll_lines = 3;	/* reasonable default */
-
-    /* if NT 4.0+ (or Win98) get scroll lines directly from system */
+    mouse_scroll_lines = 3;	// reasonable default
+
+    // if NT 4.0+ (or Win98) get scroll lines directly from system
     SystemParametersInfo(SPI_GETWHEELSCROLLLINES, 0,
 	    &mouse_scroll_lines, 0);
 }
@@ -4399,7 +4402,7 @@ set_tabline_font(void)
 	cy = lpwpos->cy;
 	netbeans_frame_moved(x, y);
     }
-    /* Allow to send WM_SIZE and WM_MOVE */
+    // Allow to send WM_SIZE and WM_MOVE
     FORWARD_WM_WINDOWPOSCHANGED(hwnd, lpwpos, MyWindowProc);
 }
 #endif
@@ -4459,9 +4462,9 @@ set_tabline_font(void)
     {
 	HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_DEADCHAR,	_OnDeadChar);
 	HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_SYSDEADCHAR, _OnDeadChar);
-	/* HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_ACTIVATE,    _OnActivate); */
+	// HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_ACTIVATE,    _OnActivate);
 	HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_CLOSE,	_OnClose);
-	/* HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_COMMAND,	_OnCommand); */
+	// HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_COMMAND,	_OnCommand);
 	HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_DESTROY,	_OnDestroy);
 	HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_DROPFILES,	_OnDropFiles);
 	HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_HSCROLL,	_OnScroll);
@@ -4469,12 +4472,12 @@ set_tabline_font(void)
 #ifdef FEAT_MENU
 	HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_COMMAND,	_OnMenu);
 #endif
-	/* HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_MOVE,	    _OnMove); */
-	/* HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_NCACTIVATE,  _OnNCActivate); */
+	// HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_MOVE,	    _OnMove);
+	// HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_NCACTIVATE,  _OnNCActivate);
 	HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_SETFOCUS,	_OnSetFocus);
 	HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_SIZE,	_OnSize);
-	/* HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_SYSCOMMAND,  _OnSysCommand); */
-	/* HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_SYSKEYDOWN,  _OnAltKey); */
+	// HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_SYSCOMMAND,  _OnSysCommand);
+	// HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_SYSKEYDOWN,  _OnAltKey);
 	HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_VSCROLL,	_OnScroll);
 	// HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_WINDOWPOSCHANGING,	_OnWindowPosChanging);
 	HANDLE_MSG(hwnd, WM_ACTIVATEAPP, _OnActivateApp);
@@ -4522,12 +4525,12 @@ set_tabline_font(void)
 	}
 #endif
 
-    case WM_QUERYENDSESSION:	/* System wants to go down. */
-	gui_shell_closed();	/* Will exit when no changed buffers. */
-	return FALSE;		/* Do NOT allow system to go down. */
+    case WM_QUERYENDSESSION:	// System wants to go down.
+	gui_shell_closed();	// Will exit when no changed buffers.
+	return FALSE;		// Do NOT allow system to go down.
 
     case WM_ENDSESSION:
-	if (wParam)	/* system only really goes down when wParam is TRUE */
+	if (wParam)	// system only really goes down when wParam is TRUE
 	{
 	    _OnEndSession();
 	    return 0L;
@@ -4535,8 +4538,8 @@ set_tabline_font(void)
 	break;
 
     case WM_CHAR:
-	/* Don't use HANDLE_MSG() for WM_CHAR, it truncates wParam to a single
-	 * byte while we want the UTF-16 character value. */
+	// Don't use HANDLE_MSG() for WM_CHAR, it truncates wParam to a single
+	// byte while we want the UTF-16 character value.
 	_OnChar(hwnd, (UINT)wParam, (int)(short)LOWORD(lParam));
 	return 0L;
 
@@ -4563,23 +4566,23 @@ set_tabline_font(void)
 
     case WM_SYSKEYUP:
 #ifdef FEAT_MENU
-	/* This used to be done only when menu is active: ALT key is used for
-	 * that.  But that caused problems when menu is disabled and using
-	 * Alt-Tab-Esc: get into a strange state where no mouse-moved events
-	 * are received, mouse pointer remains hidden. */
+	// This used to be done only when menu is active: ALT key is used for
+	// that.  But that caused problems when menu is disabled and using
+	// Alt-Tab-Esc: get into a strange state where no mouse-moved events
+	// are received, mouse pointer remains hidden.
 	return MyWindowProc(hwnd, uMsg, wParam, lParam);
 #else
 	return 0L;
 #endif
 
-    case WM_SIZING:	/* HANDLE_MSG doesn't seem to handle this one */
+    case WM_SIZING:	// HANDLE_MSG doesn't seem to handle this one
 	return _DuringSizing((UINT)wParam, (LPRECT)lParam);
 
     case WM_MOUSEWHEEL:
 	_OnMouseWheel(hwnd, HIWORD(wParam));
 	return 0L;
 
-	/* Notification for change in SystemParametersInfo() */
+	// Notification for change in SystemParametersInfo()
     case WM_SETTINGCHANGE:
 	return _OnSettingChange((UINT)wParam);
 
@@ -4653,21 +4656,21 @@ set_tabline_font(void)
 			{
 			    LPNMTTDISPINFOW	lpdi = (LPNMTTDISPINFOW)lParam;
 
-			    /* Set the maximum width, this also enables using
-			     * \n for line break. */
+			    // Set the maximum width, this also enables using
+			    // \n for line break.
 			    SendMessage(lpdi->hdr.hwndFrom, TTM_SETMAXTIPWIDTH,
 								      0, 500);
 
 			    tt_text = enc_to_utf16(str, NULL);
 			    lpdi->lpszText = tt_text;
-			    /* can't show tooltip if failed */
+			    // can't show tooltip if failed
 			}
 			else
 			{
 			    LPNMTTDISPINFO	lpdi = (LPNMTTDISPINFO)lParam;
 
-			    /* Set the maximum width, this also enables using
-			     * \n for line break. */
+			    // Set the maximum width, this also enables using
+			    // \n for line break.
 			    SendMessage(lpdi->hdr.hwndFrom, TTM_SETMAXTIPWIDTH,
 								      0, 500);
 
@@ -4760,8 +4763,8 @@ set_tabline_font(void)
 		    int  yPos = GET_Y_LPARAM(lParam);
 		    RECT rct;
 
-		    /* If the cursor is on the GUI tabline, don't process this
-		     * event */
+		    // If the cursor is on the GUI tabline, don't process this
+		    // event
 		    GetWindowRect(s_textArea, &rct);
 		    if (yPos < rct.top)
 			return result;
@@ -4770,7 +4773,7 @@ set_tabline_font(void)
 		(void)gui_mch_get_winpos(&x, &y);
 		xPos -= x;
 
-		if (xPos < 48) /* <VN> TODO should use system metric? */
+		if (xPos < 48) // <VN> TODO should use system metric?
 		    return HTBOTTOMLEFT;
 		else
 		    return HTBOTTOMRIGHT;
@@ -4778,7 +4781,7 @@ set_tabline_font(void)
 	    else
 		return result;
 	}
-	/* break; notreached */
+	// break; notreached
 
 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE_IME
     case WM_IME_NOTIFY:
@@ -4807,7 +4810,7 @@ set_tabline_font(void)
  * End of call-back routines
  */
 
-/* parent window, if specified with -P */
+// parent window, if specified with -P
 HWND vim_parent_hwnd = NULL;
 
     static BOOL CALLBACK
@@ -4820,14 +4823,14 @@ FindWindowTitle(HWND hwnd, LPARAM lParam
     {
 	if (strstr(buf, title) != NULL)
 	{
-	    /* Found it.  Store the window ref. and quit searching if MDI
-	     * works. */
+	    // Found it.  Store the window ref. and quit searching if MDI
+	    // works.
 	    vim_parent_hwnd = FindWindowEx(hwnd, NULL, "MDIClient", NULL);
 	    if (vim_parent_hwnd != NULL)
 		return FALSE;
 	}
     }
-    return TRUE;	/* continue searching */
+    return TRUE;	// continue searching
 }
 
 /*
@@ -4855,7 +4858,7 @@ ole_error(char *arg)
     gui.in_use = mch_is_gui_executable();
 # endif
 
-    /* Can't use emsg() here, we have not finished initialisation yet. */
+    // Can't use emsg() here, we have not finished initialisation yet.
     vim_snprintf(buf, IOSIZE,
 	    _("E243: Argument not supported: \"-%s\"; Use the OLE version."),
 	    arg);
@@ -5009,10 +5012,10 @@ gui_mch_prepare(int *argc, char **argv)
     int		silent = FALSE;
     int		idx;
 
-    /* Check for special OLE command line parameters */
+    // Check for special OLE command line parameters
     if ((*argc == 2 || *argc == 3) && (argv[1][0] == '-' || argv[1][0] == '/'))
     {
-	/* Check for a "-silent" argument first. */
+	// Check for a "-silent" argument first.
 	if (*argc == 3 && STRICMP(argv[1] + 1, "silent") == 0
 		&& (argv[2][0] == '-' || argv[2][0] == '/'))
 	{
@@ -5022,7 +5025,7 @@ gui_mch_prepare(int *argc, char **argv)
 	else
 	    idx = 1;
 
-	/* Register Vim as an OLE Automation server */
+	// Register Vim as an OLE Automation server
 	if (STRICMP(argv[idx] + 1, "register") == 0)
 	{
 #ifdef FEAT_OLE
@@ -5035,7 +5038,7 @@ gui_mch_prepare(int *argc, char **argv)
 #endif
 	}
 
-	/* Unregister Vim as an OLE Automation server */
+	// Unregister Vim as an OLE Automation server
 	if (STRICMP(argv[idx] + 1, "unregister") == 0)
 	{
 #ifdef FEAT_OLE
@@ -5048,11 +5051,10 @@ gui_mch_prepare(int *argc, char **argv)
 #endif
 	}
 
-	/* Ignore an -embedding argument. It is only relevant if the
-	 * application wants to treat the case when it is started manually
-	 * differently from the case where it is started via automation (and
-	 * we don't).
-	 */
+	// Ignore an -embedding argument. It is only relevant if the
+	// application wants to treat the case when it is started manually
+	// differently from the case where it is started via automation (and
+	// we don't).
 	if (STRICMP(argv[idx] + 1, "embedding") == 0)
 	{
 #ifdef FEAT_OLE
@@ -5069,7 +5071,7 @@ gui_mch_prepare(int *argc, char **argv)
 	int	bDoRestart = FALSE;
 
 	InitOLE(&bDoRestart);
-	/* automatically exit after registering */
+	// automatically exit after registering
 	if (bDoRestart)
 	    mch_exit(0);
     }
@@ -5077,7 +5079,7 @@ gui_mch_prepare(int *argc, char **argv)
 
 #ifdef FEAT_NETBEANS_INTG
     {
-	/* stolen from gui_x11.c */
+	// stolen from gui_x11.c
 	int arg;
 
 	for (arg = 1; arg < *argc; arg++)
@@ -5087,7 +5089,7 @@ gui_mch_prepare(int *argc, char **argv)
 		mch_memmove(&argv[arg], &argv[arg + 1],
 					    (--*argc - arg) * sizeof(char *));
 		argv[*argc] = NULL;
-		break;	/* enough? */
+		break;	// enough?
 	    }
     }
 #endif
@@ -5107,8 +5109,8 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
     ATOM	atom;
 #endif
 
-    /* Return here if the window was already opened (happens when
-     * gui_mch_dialog() is called early). */
+    // Return here if the window was already opened (happens when
+    // gui_mch_dialog() is called early).
     if (s_hwnd != NULL)
 	goto theend;
 
@@ -5122,14 +5124,14 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
     gui.scrollbar_width = GetSystemMetrics(SM_CXVSCROLL);
     gui.scrollbar_height = GetSystemMetrics(SM_CYHSCROLL);
 #ifdef FEAT_MENU
-    gui.menu_height = 0;	/* Windows takes care of this */
+    gui.menu_height = 0;	// Windows takes care of this
 #endif
     gui.border_width = 0;
 
     s_brush = CreateSolidBrush(GetSysColor(COLOR_BTNFACE));
 
-    /* First try using the wide version, so that we can use any title.
-     * Otherwise only characters in the active codepage will work. */
+    // First try using the wide version, so that we can use any title.
+    // Otherwise only characters in the active codepage will work.
     if (GetClassInfoW(g_hinst, szVimWndClassW, &wndclassw) == 0)
     {
 	wndclassw.style = CS_DBLCLKS;
@@ -5175,7 +5177,7 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
 	}
 	__except(EXCEPTION_EXECUTE_HANDLER)
 	{
-	    /* NOP */
+	    // NOP
 	}
 #endif
 	if (s_hwnd == NULL)
@@ -5186,21 +5188,21 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
     }
     else
     {
-	/* If the provided windowid is not valid reset it to zero, so that it
-	 * is ignored and we open our own window. */
+	// If the provided windowid is not valid reset it to zero, so that it
+	// is ignored and we open our own window.
 	if (IsWindow((HWND)win_socket_id) <= 0)
 	    win_socket_id = 0;
 
-	/* Create a window.  If win_socket_id is not zero without border and
-	 * titlebar, it will be reparented below. */
+	// Create a window.  If win_socket_id is not zero without border and
+	// titlebar, it will be reparented below.
 	s_hwnd = CreateWindowW(
 		szVimWndClassW, L"Vim MSWindows GUI",
 		(win_socket_id == 0 ? WS_OVERLAPPEDWINDOW : WS_POPUP)
 					  | WS_CLIPSIBLINGS | WS_CLIPCHILDREN,
 		gui_win_x == -1 ? CW_USEDEFAULT : gui_win_x,
 		gui_win_y == -1 ? CW_USEDEFAULT : gui_win_y,
-		100,				/* Any value will do */
-		100,				/* Any value will do */
+		100,				// Any value will do
+		100,				// Any value will do
 		NULL, NULL,
 		g_hinst, NULL);
 	if (s_hwnd != NULL && win_socket_id != 0)
@@ -5220,7 +5222,7 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
     dyn_imm_load();
 #endif
 
-    /* Create the text area window */
+    // Create the text area window
     if (GetClassInfoW(g_hinst, szTextAreaClassW, &wndclassw) == 0)
     {
 	wndclassw.style = CS_OWNDC;
@@ -5251,7 +5253,7 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
 	return FAIL;
 
 #ifdef FEAT_LIBCALL
-    /* Try loading an icon from $RUNTIMEPATH/bitmaps/vim.ico. */
+    // Try loading an icon from $RUNTIMEPATH/bitmaps/vim.ico.
     {
 	HANDLE	hIcon = NULL;
 
@@ -5267,14 +5269,14 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
 
     DragAcceptFiles(s_hwnd, TRUE);
 
-    /* Do we need to bother with this? */
-    /* m_fMouseAvail = GetSystemMetrics(SM_MOUSEPRESENT); */
-
-    /* Get background/foreground colors from the system */
+    // Do we need to bother with this?
+    // m_fMouseAvail = GetSystemMetrics(SM_MOUSEPRESENT);
+
+    // Get background/foreground colors from the system
     gui_mch_def_colors();
 
-    /* Get the colors from the "Normal" group (set in syntax.c or in a vimrc
-     * file) */
+    // Get the colors from the "Normal" group (set in syntax.c or in a vimrc
+    // file)
     set_normal_colors();
 
     /*
@@ -5285,8 +5287,8 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
     gui.def_norm_pixel = gui.norm_pixel;
     gui.def_back_pixel = gui.back_pixel;
 
-    /* Get the colors for the highlight groups (gui_check_colors() might have
-     * changed them) */
+    // Get the colors for the highlight groups (gui_check_colors() might have
+    // changed them)
     highlight_gui_started();
 
     /*
@@ -5321,7 +5323,7 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
      */
     s_findrep_msg = RegisterWindowMessage(FINDMSGSTRING);
 
-    /* Initialise the struct */
+    // Initialise the struct
     s_findrep_struct.lStructSize = sizeof(s_findrep_struct);
     s_findrep_struct.lpstrFindWhat = ALLOC_MULT(WCHAR, MSWIN_FR_BUFSIZE);
     s_findrep_struct.lpstrFindWhat[0] = NUL;
@@ -5333,12 +5335,12 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
 
 #ifdef FEAT_EVAL
 # if !defined(_MSC_VER) || (_MSC_VER < 1400)
-/* Define HandleToLong for old MS and non-MS compilers if not defined. */
+// Define HandleToLong for old MS and non-MS compilers if not defined.
 #  ifndef HandleToLong
 #   define HandleToLong(h) ((long)(intptr_t)(h))
 #  endif
 # endif
-    /* set the v:windowid variable */
+    // set the v:windowid variable
     set_vim_var_nr(VV_WINDOWID, HandleToLong(s_hwnd));
 #endif
 
@@ -5348,7 +5350,7 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
 #endif
 
 theend:
-    /* Display any pending error messages */
+    // Display any pending error messages
     display_errors();
 
     return OK;
@@ -5364,7 +5366,7 @@ get_work_area(RECT *spi_rect)
     HMONITOR	    mon;
     MONITORINFO	    moninfo;
 
-    /* work out which monitor the window is on, and get *its* work area */
+    // work out which monitor the window is on, and get *its* work area
     mon = MonitorFromWindow(s_hwnd, MONITOR_DEFAULTTOPRIMARY);
     if (mon != NULL)
     {
@@ -5375,7 +5377,7 @@ get_work_area(RECT *spi_rect)
 	    return;
 	}
     }
-    /* this is the old method... */
+    // this is the old method...
     SystemParametersInfo(SPI_GETWORKAREA, 0, spi_rect, 0);
 }
 
@@ -5396,27 +5398,27 @@ gui_mch_set_shellsize(
     int		win_width, win_height;
     WINDOWPLACEMENT wndpl;
 
-    /* Try to keep window completely on screen. */
-    /* Get position of the screen work area.  This is the part that is not
-     * used by the taskbar or appbars. */
+    // Try to keep window completely on screen.
+    // Get position of the screen work area.  This is the part that is not
+    // used by the taskbar or appbars.
     get_work_area(&workarea_rect);
 
-    /* Get current position of our window.  Note that the .left and .top are
-     * relative to the work area.  */
+    // Get current position of our window.  Note that the .left and .top are
+    // relative to the work area.
     wndpl.length = sizeof(WINDOWPLACEMENT);
     GetWindowPlacement(s_hwnd, &wndpl);
 
-    /* Resizing a maximized window looks very strange, unzoom it first.
-     * But don't do it when still starting up, it may have been requested in
-     * the shortcut. */
+    // Resizing a maximized window looks very strange, unzoom it first.
+    // But don't do it when still starting up, it may have been requested in
+    // the shortcut.
     if (wndpl.showCmd == SW_SHOWMAXIMIZED && starting == 0)
     {
 	ShowWindow(s_hwnd, SW_SHOWNORMAL);
-	/* Need to get the settings of the normal window. */
+	// Need to get the settings of the normal window.
 	GetWindowPlacement(s_hwnd, &wndpl);
     }
 
-    /* compute the size of the outside of the window */
+    // compute the size of the outside of the window
     win_width = width + (GetSystemMetrics(SM_CXFRAME) +
 			 GetSystemMetrics(SM_CXPADDEDBORDER)) * 2;
     win_height = height + (GetSystemMetrics(SM_CYFRAME) +
@@ -5427,13 +5429,13 @@ gui_mch_set_shellsize(
 #endif
 			;
 
-    /* The following should take care of keeping Vim on the same monitor, no
-     * matter if the secondary monitor is left or right of the primary
-     * monitor. */
+    // The following should take care of keeping Vim on the same monitor, no
+    // matter if the secondary monitor is left or right of the primary
+    // monitor.
     wndpl.rcNormalPosition.right = wndpl.rcNormalPosition.left + win_width;
     wndpl.rcNormalPosition.bottom = wndpl.rcNormalPosition.top + win_height;
 
-    /* If the window is going off the screen, move it on to the screen. */
+    // If the window is going off the screen, move it on to the screen.
     if ((direction & RESIZE_HOR)
 	    && wndpl.rcNormalPosition.right > workarea_rect.right)
 	OffsetRect(&wndpl.rcNormalPosition,
@@ -5454,16 +5456,16 @@ gui_mch_set_shellsize(
 	OffsetRect(&wndpl.rcNormalPosition,
 		0, workarea_rect.top - wndpl.rcNormalPosition.top);
 
-    /* set window position - we should use SetWindowPlacement rather than
-     * SetWindowPos as the MSDN docs say the coord systems returned by
-     * these two are not compatible. */
+    // set window position - we should use SetWindowPlacement rather than
+    // SetWindowPos as the MSDN docs say the coord systems returned by
+    // these two are not compatible.
     SetWindowPlacement(s_hwnd, &wndpl);
 
     SetActiveWindow(s_hwnd);
     SetFocus(s_hwnd);
 
 #ifdef FEAT_MENU
-    /* Menu may wrap differently now */
+    // Menu may wrap differently now
     gui_mswin_get_menu_height(!gui.starting);
 #endif
 }
@@ -5543,7 +5545,7 @@ gui_mch_set_sp_color(guicolor_T color)
  * First static functions (no prototypes generated).
  */
 # ifdef _MSC_VER
-#  include <ime.h>   /* Apparently not needed for Cygwin or MinGW. */
+#  include <ime.h>   // Apparently not needed for Cygwin or MinGW.
 # endif
 # include <imm.h>
 
@@ -5566,15 +5568,15 @@ gui_mch_set_sp_color(guicolor_T color)
 		pImmSetCompositionFontW(hImc, &norm_logfont);
 		im_set_position(gui.row, gui.col);
 
-		/* Disable langmap */
+		// Disable langmap
 		State &= ~LANGMAP;
 		if (State & INSERT)
 		{
 # if defined(FEAT_KEYMAP)
-		    /* Unshown 'keymap' in status lines */
+		    // Unshown 'keymap' in status lines
 		    if (curbuf->b_p_iminsert == B_IMODE_LMAP)
 		    {
-			/* Save cursor position */
+			// Save cursor position
 			int old_row = gui.row;
 			int old_col = gui.col;
 
@@ -5584,7 +5586,7 @@ gui_mch_set_sp_color(guicolor_T color)
 			showmode();
 			status_redraw_curbuf();
 			update_screen(0);
-			/* Restore cursor position */
+			// Restore cursor position
 			gui.row = old_row;
 			gui.col = old_col;
 		    }
@@ -5606,7 +5608,7 @@ gui_mch_set_sp_color(guicolor_T color)
     char_u	*ret;
     int		len;
 
-    if ((param & GCS_RESULTSTR) == 0) /* Composition unfinished. */
+    if ((param & GCS_RESULTSTR) == 0) // Composition unfinished.
 	return 0;
 
     ret = GetResultStr(hwnd, GCS_RESULTSTR, &len);
@@ -5631,16 +5633,16 @@ GetCompositionString_inUCS2(HIMC hIMC, D
     char_u	    *buf;
 
     if (!pImmGetContext)
-	return NULL; /* no imm32.dll */
-
-    /* Try Unicode; this'll always work on NT regardless of codepage. */
+	return NULL; // no imm32.dll
+
+    // Try Unicode; this'll always work on NT regardless of codepage.
     ret = pImmGetCompositionStringW(hIMC, GCS, NULL, 0);
     if (ret == 0)
-	return NULL; /* empty */
+	return NULL; // empty
 
     if (ret > 0)
     {
-	/* Allocate the requested buffer plus space for the NUL character. */
+	// Allocate the requested buffer plus space for the NUL character.
 	wbuf = alloc(ret + sizeof(WCHAR));
 	if (wbuf != NULL)
 	{
@@ -5650,19 +5652,19 @@ GetCompositionString_inUCS2(HIMC hIMC, D
 	return (short_u *)wbuf;
     }
 
-    /* ret < 0; we got an error, so try the ANSI version.  This'll work
-     * on 9x/ME, but only if the codepage happens to be set to whatever
-     * we're inputting. */
+    // ret < 0; we got an error, so try the ANSI version.  This'll work
+    // on 9x/ME, but only if the codepage happens to be set to whatever
+    // we're inputting.
     ret = pImmGetCompositionStringA(hIMC, GCS, NULL, 0);
     if (ret <= 0)
-	return NULL; /* empty or error */
+	return NULL; // empty or error
 
     buf = alloc(ret);
     if (buf == NULL)
 	return NULL;
     pImmGetCompositionStringA(hIMC, GCS, buf, ret);
 
-    /* convert from codepage to UCS-2 */
+    // convert from codepage to UCS-2
     MultiByteToWideChar_alloc(GetACP(), 0, (LPCSTR)buf, ret, &wbuf, lenp);
     vim_free(buf);
 
@@ -5678,14 +5680,14 @@ GetCompositionString_inUCS2(HIMC hIMC, D
     static char_u *
 GetResultStr(HWND hwnd, int GCS, int *lenp)
 {
-    HIMC	hIMC;		/* Input context handle. */
+    HIMC	hIMC;		// Input context handle.
     short_u	*buf = NULL;
     char_u	*convbuf = NULL;
 
     if (!pImmGetContext || (hIMC = pImmGetContext(hwnd)) == (HIMC)0)
 	return NULL;
 
-    /* Reads in the composition string. */
+    // Reads in the composition string.
     buf = GetCompositionString_inUCS2(hIMC, GCS, lenp);
     if (buf == NULL)
 	return NULL;
@@ -5697,7 +5699,7 @@ GetResultStr(HWND hwnd, int GCS, int *le
 }
 #endif
 
-/* For global functions we need prototypes. */
+// For global functions we need prototypes.
 #if defined(FEAT_MBYTE_IME) || defined(PROTO)
 
 /*
@@ -5754,7 +5756,7 @@ im_set_active(int active)
     }
 # endif
 
-    if (pImmGetContext)	    /* if NULL imm32.dll wasn't loaded (yet) */
+    if (pImmGetContext)	    // if NULL imm32.dll wasn't loaded (yet)
     {
 	if (p_imdisable)
 	{
@@ -5787,7 +5789,7 @@ im_set_active(int active)
 
 		if (active)
 		{
-		    /* if we have a saved conversion status, restore it */
+		    // if we have a saved conversion status, restore it
 		    if (bSaved)
 			pImmSetConversionStatus(hImc, dwConversionSaved,
 							     dwSentenceSaved);
@@ -5795,7 +5797,7 @@ im_set_active(int active)
 		}
 		else
 		{
-		    /* save conversion status and disable korean */
+		    // save conversion status and disable korean
 		    if (pImmGetConversionStatus(hImc, &dwConversionSaved,
 							    &dwSentenceSaved))
 		    {
@@ -5836,10 +5838,10 @@ im_get_status(void)
     return status;
 }
 
-#endif /* FEAT_MBYTE_IME */
+#endif // FEAT_MBYTE_IME
 
 #if !defined(FEAT_MBYTE_IME) && defined(GLOBAL_IME)
-/* Win32 with GLOBAL IME */
+// Win32 with GLOBAL IME
 
 /*
  * Notify cursor position to IM.
@@ -5847,7 +5849,7 @@ im_get_status(void)
     void
 im_set_position(int row, int col)
 {
-    /* Win32 with GLOBAL IME */
+    // Win32 with GLOBAL IME
     POINT p;
 
     p.x = FILL_X(col);
@@ -5888,14 +5890,14 @@ latin9_to_ucs(char_u *text, int len, WCH
 	c = *text++;
 	switch (c)
 	{
-	    case 0xa4: c = 0x20ac; break;   /* euro */
-	    case 0xa6: c = 0x0160; break;   /* S hat */
-	    case 0xa8: c = 0x0161; break;   /* S -hat */
-	    case 0xb4: c = 0x017d; break;   /* Z hat */
-	    case 0xb8: c = 0x017e; break;   /* Z -hat */
-	    case 0xbc: c = 0x0152; break;   /* OE */
-	    case 0xbd: c = 0x0153; break;   /* oe */
-	    case 0xbe: c = 0x0178; break;   /* Y */
+	    case 0xa4: c = 0x20ac; break;   // euro
+	    case 0xa6: c = 0x0160; break;   // S hat
+	    case 0xa8: c = 0x0161; break;   // S -hat
+	    case 0xb4: c = 0x017d; break;   // Z hat
+	    case 0xb8: c = 0x017e; break;   // Z -hat
+	    case 0xbc: c = 0x0152; break;   // OE
+	    case 0xbd: c = 0x0153; break;   // oe
+	    case 0xbe: c = 0x0178; break;   // Y
 	}
 	*unicodebuf++ = c;
     }
@@ -5949,7 +5951,7 @@ draw_line(
 	HPEN	hpen = CreatePen(PS_SOLID, 1, color);
 	HPEN	old_pen = SelectObject(s_hdc, hpen);
 	MoveToEx(s_hdc, x1, y1, NULL);
-	/* Note: LineTo() excludes the last pixel in the line. */
+	// Note: LineTo() excludes the last pixel in the line.
 	LineTo(s_hdc, x2, y2);
 	DeleteObject(SelectObject(s_hdc, old_pen));
     }
@@ -6041,15 +6043,15 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(
 	rc.top = FILL_Y(row);
 	if (has_mbyte)
 	{
-	    /* Compute the length in display cells. */
+	    // Compute the length in display cells.
 	    rc.right = FILL_X(col + mb_string2cells(text, len));
 	}
 	else
 	    rc.right = FILL_X(col + len);
 	rc.bottom = FILL_Y(row + 1);
 
-	/* Cache the created brush, that saves a lot of time.  We need two:
-	 * one for cursor background and one for the normal background. */
+	// Cache the created brush, that saves a lot of time.  We need two:
+	// one for cursor background and one for the normal background.
 	if (gui.currBgColor == brush_color[0])
 	{
 	    hbr = hbr_cache[0];
@@ -6097,8 +6099,8 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(
 	vim_free(padding);
 	pad_size = Columns;
 
-	/* Don't give an out-of-memory message here, it would call us
-	 * recursively. */
+	// Don't give an out-of-memory message here, it would call us
+	// recursively.
 	padding = LALLOC_MULT(int, pad_size);
 	if (padding != NULL)
 	    for (i = 0; i < pad_size; i++)
@@ -6112,24 +6114,24 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(
      * No check for DRAW_BOLD, Windows will have done it already.
      */
 
-    /* Check if there are any UTF-8 characters.  If not, use normal text
-     * output to speed up output. */
+    // Check if there are any UTF-8 characters.  If not, use normal text
+    // output to speed up output.
     if (enc_utf8)
 	for (n = 0; n < len; ++n)
 	    if (text[n] >= 0x80)
 		break;
 
 #if defined(FEAT_DIRECTX)
-    /* Quick hack to enable DirectWrite.  To use DirectWrite (antialias), it is
-     * required that unicode drawing routine, currently.  So this forces it
-     * enabled. */
+    // Quick hack to enable DirectWrite.  To use DirectWrite (antialias), it is
+    // required that unicode drawing routine, currently.  So this forces it
+    // enabled.
     if (IS_ENABLE_DIRECTX())
-	n = 0; /* Keep n < len, to enter block for unicode. */
-#endif
-
-    /* Check if the Unicode buffer exists and is big enough.  Create it
-     * with the same length as the multi-byte string, the number of wide
-     * characters is always equal or smaller. */
+	n = 0; // Keep n < len, to enter block for unicode.
+#endif
+
+    // Check if the Unicode buffer exists and is big enough.  Create it
+    // with the same length as the multi-byte string, the number of wide
+    // characters is always equal or smaller.
     if ((enc_utf8
 		|| (enc_codepage > 0 && (int)GetACP() != enc_codepage)
 		|| enc_latin9)
@@ -6146,13 +6148,13 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(
 
     if (enc_utf8 && n < len && unicodebuf != NULL)
     {
-	/* Output UTF-8 characters.  Composing characters should be
-	 * handled here. */
+	// Output UTF-8 characters.  Composing characters should be
+	// handled here.
 	int		i;
-	int		wlen;	/* string length in words */
-	int		clen;	/* string length in characters */
-	int		cells;	/* cell width of string up to composing char */
-	int		cw;	/* width of current cell */
+	int		wlen;	// string length in words
+	int		clen;	// string length in characters
+	int		cells;	// cell width of string up to composing char
+	int		cw;	// width of current cell
 	int		c;
 
 	wlen = 0;
@@ -6163,7 +6165,7 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(
 	    c = utf_ptr2char(text + i);
 	    if (c >= 0x10000)
 	    {
-		/* Turn into UTF-16 encoding. */
+		// Turn into UTF-16 encoding.
 		unicodebuf[wlen++] = ((c - 0x10000) >> 10) + 0xD800;
 		unicodebuf[wlen++] = ((c - 0x10000) & 0x3ff) + 0xDC00;
 	    }
@@ -6177,15 +6179,15 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(
 	    else
 	    {
 		cw = utf_char2cells(c);
-		if (cw > 2)		/* don't use 4 for unprintable char */
+		if (cw > 2)		// don't use 4 for unprintable char
 		    cw = 1;
 	    }
 
 	    if (unicodepdy != NULL)
 	    {
-		/* Use unicodepdy to make characters fit as we expect, even
-		 * when the font uses different widths (e.g., bold character
-		 * is wider).  */
+		// Use unicodepdy to make characters fit as we expect, even
+		// when the font uses different widths (e.g., bold character
+		// is wider).
 		if (c >= 0x10000)
 		{
 		    unicodepdy[wlen - 2] = cw * gui.char_width;
@@ -6201,7 +6203,7 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(
 #if defined(FEAT_DIRECTX)
 	if (IS_ENABLE_DIRECTX())
 	{
-	    /* Add one to "cells" for italics. */
+	    // Add one to "cells" for italics.
 	    DWriteContext_DrawText(s_dwc, unicodebuf, wlen,
 		    TEXT_X(col), TEXT_Y(row),
 		    FILL_X(cells + 1), FILL_Y(1) - p_linespace,
@@ -6212,12 +6214,12 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(
 #endif
 	    ExtTextOutW(s_hdc, TEXT_X(col), TEXT_Y(row),
 		    foptions, pcliprect, unicodebuf, wlen, unicodepdy);
-	len = cells;	/* used for underlining */
+	len = cells;	// used for underlining
     }
     else if ((enc_codepage > 0 && (int)GetACP() != enc_codepage) || enc_latin9)
     {
-	/* If we want to display codepage data, and the current CP is not the
-	 * ANSI one, we need to go via Unicode. */
+	// If we want to display codepage data, and the current CP is not the
+	// ANSI one, we need to go via Unicode.
 	if (unicodebuf != NULL)
 	{
 	    if (enc_latin9)
@@ -6229,9 +6231,9 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(
 			(LPWSTR)unicodebuf, unibuflen);
 	    if (len != 0)
 	    {
-		/* Use unicodepdy to make characters fit as we expect, even
-		 * when the font uses different widths (e.g., bold character
-		 * is wider). */
+		// Use unicodepdy to make characters fit as we expect, even
+		// when the font uses different widths (e.g., bold character
+		// is wider).
 		if (unicodepdy != NULL)
 		{
 		    int i;
@@ -6253,8 +6255,8 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(
     else
     {
 #ifdef FEAT_RIGHTLEFT
-	/* Windows will mess up RL text, so we have to draw it character by
-	 * character.  Only do this if RL is on, since it's slow. */
+	// Windows will mess up RL text, so we have to draw it character by
+	// character.  Only do this if RL is on, since it's slow.
 	if (curwin->w_p_rl)
 	    RevOut(s_hdc, TEXT_X(col), TEXT_Y(row),
 			 foptions, pcliprect, (char *)text, len, padding);
@@ -6264,25 +6266,25 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(
 			 foptions, pcliprect, (char *)text, len, padding);
     }
 
-    /* Underline */
+    // Underline
     if (flags & DRAW_UNDERL)
     {
-	/* When p_linespace is 0, overwrite the bottom row of pixels.
-	 * Otherwise put the line just below the character. */
+	// When p_linespace is 0, overwrite the bottom row of pixels.
+	// Otherwise put the line just below the character.
 	y = FILL_Y(row + 1) - 1;
 	if (p_linespace > 1)
 	    y -= p_linespace - 1;
 	draw_line(FILL_X(col), y, FILL_X(col + len), y, gui.currFgColor);
     }
 
-    /* Strikethrough */
+    // Strikethrough
     if (flags & DRAW_STRIKE)
     {
 	y = FILL_Y(row + 1) - gui.char_height/2;
 	draw_line(FILL_X(col), y, FILL_X(col + len), y, gui.currSpColor);
     }
 
-    /* Undercurl */
+    // Undercurl
     if (flags & DRAW_UNDERC)
     {
 	int			x;
@@ -6303,7 +6305,9 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(
  * Output routines.
  */
 
-/* Flush any output to the screen */
+/*
+ * Flush any output to the screen
+ */
     void
 gui_mch_flush(void)
 {
@@ -6333,9 +6337,9 @@ gui_mch_get_screen_dimensions(int *scree
 		- (GetSystemMetrics(SM_CXFRAME) +
 		   GetSystemMetrics(SM_CXPADDEDBORDER)) * 2;
 
-    /* FIXME: dirty trick: Because the gui_get_base_height() doesn't include
-     * the menubar for MSwin, we subtract it from the screen height, so that
-     * the window size can be made to fit on the screen. */
+    // FIXME: dirty trick: Because the gui_get_base_height() doesn't include
+    // the menubar for MSwin, we subtract it from the screen height, so that
+    // the window size can be made to fit on the screen.
     *screen_h = workarea_rect.bottom - workarea_rect.top
 		- (GetSystemMetrics(SM_CYFRAME) +
 		   GetSystemMetrics(SM_CXPADDEDBORDER)) * 2
@@ -6385,7 +6389,7 @@ gui_mch_add_menu(
 	vim_free(wn);
     }
 
-    /* Fix window size if menu may have wrapped */
+    // Fix window size if menu may have wrapped
     if (parent == NULL)
 	gui_mswin_get_menu_height(!gui.starting);
 # ifdef FEAT_TEAROFF
@@ -6412,7 +6416,7 @@ gui_make_popup(char_u *path_name, int mo
     {
 	POINT	p;
 
-	/* Find the position of the current cursor */
+	// Find the position of the current cursor
 	GetDCOrgEx(s_hdc, &p);
 	if (mouse_pos)
 	{
@@ -6442,7 +6446,7 @@ gui_make_tearoff(char_u *path_name)
 {
     vimmenu_T	*menu = gui_find_menu(path_name);
 
-    /* Found the menu, so tear it off. */
+    // Found the menu, so tear it off.
     if (menu != NULL)
 	gui_mch_tearoff(menu->dname, menu, 0xffffL, 0xffffL);
 }
@@ -6549,7 +6553,7 @@ gui_mch_destroy_menu(vimmenu_T *menu)
 		&& menu->parent->children != NULL
 		&& IsWindow(menu->parent->tearoff_handle))
 	{
-	    /* This menu must not show up when rebuilding the tearoff window. */
+	    // This menu must not show up when rebuilding the tearoff window.
 	    menu->modes = 0;
 	    rebuild_tearoff(menu->parent);
 	}
@@ -6561,7 +6565,7 @@ gui_mch_destroy_menu(vimmenu_T *menu)
     static void
 rebuild_tearoff(vimmenu_T *menu)
 {
-    /*hackish*/
+    //hackish
     char_u	tbuf[128];
     RECT	trect;
     RECT	rct;
@@ -6595,7 +6599,7 @@ rebuild_tearoff(vimmenu_T *menu)
 				SWP_NOSIZE | SWP_NOZORDER | SWP_NOACTIVATE);
     }
 }
-# endif /* FEAT_TEAROFF */
+# endif // FEAT_TEAROFF
 
 /*
  * Make a menu either grey or not grey.
@@ -6640,10 +6644,10 @@ gui_mch_menu_grey(
 # endif
 }
 
-#endif /* FEAT_MENU */
-
-
-/* define some macros used to make the dialogue creation more readable */
+#endif // FEAT_MENU
+
+
+// define some macros used to make the dialogue creation more readable
 
 #define add_string(s) strcpy((LPSTR)p, s); (LPSTR)p += (strlen((LPSTR)p) + 1)
 #define add_word(x)		*p++ = (x)
@@ -6671,13 +6675,13 @@ dialog_callback(
     if (message == WM_INITDIALOG)
     {
 	CenterWindow(hwnd, GetWindow(hwnd, GW_OWNER));
-	/* Set focus to the dialog.  Set the default button, if specified. */
+	// Set focus to the dialog.  Set the default button, if specified.
 	(void)SetFocus(hwnd);
 	if (dialog_default_button > IDCANCEL)
 	    (void)SetFocus(GetDlgItem(hwnd, dialog_default_button));
 	else
-	    /* We don't have a default, set focus on another element of the
-	     * dialog window, probably the icon */
+	    // We don't have a default, set focus on another element of the
+	    // dialog window, probably the icon
 	    (void)SetFocus(GetDlgItem(hwnd, DLG_NONBUTTON_CONTROL));
 	return FALSE;
     }
@@ -6686,13 +6690,12 @@ dialog_callback(
     {
 	int	button = LOWORD(wParam);
 
-	/* Don't end the dialog if something was selected that was
-	 * not a button.
-	 */
+	// Don't end the dialog if something was selected that was
+	// not a button.
 	if (button >= DLG_NONBUTTON_CONTROL)
 	    return TRUE;
 
-	/* If the edit box exists, copy the string. */
+	// If the edit box exists, copy the string.
 	if (s_textfield != NULL)
 	{
 	    WCHAR  *wp = ALLOC_MULT(WCHAR, IOSIZE);
@@ -6744,7 +6747,7 @@ dialog_callback(
  * If stubbing out this fn, return 1.
  */
 
-static const char *dlg_icons[] = /* must match names in resource file */
+static const char *dlg_icons[] = // must match names in resource file
 {
     "IDR_VIM",
     "IDR_VIM_ERROR",
@@ -6800,12 +6803,12 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     int		l;
 
 # ifndef NO_CONSOLE
-    /* Don't output anything in silent mode ("ex -s") */
+    // Don't output anything in silent mode ("ex -s")
 #  ifdef VIMDLL
     if (!(gui.in_use || gui.starting))
 #  endif
 	if (silent_mode)
-	    return dfltbutton;   /* return default option */
+	    return dfltbutton;   // return default option
 # endif
 
     if (s_hwnd == NULL)
@@ -6814,8 +6817,8 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     if ((type < 0) || (type > VIM_LAST_TYPE))
 	type = 0;
 
-    /* allocate some memory for dialog template */
-    /* TODO should compute this really */
+    // allocate some memory for dialog template
+    // TODO should compute this really
     pdlgtemplate = p = (PWORD)LocalAlloc(LPTR,
 					DLG_ALLOC_SIZE + STRLEN(message) * 2);
 
@@ -6831,9 +6834,9 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     if (tbuffer == NULL)
 	return -1;
 
-    --dfltbutton;   /* Change from one-based to zero-based */
-
-    /* Count buttons */
+    --dfltbutton;   // Change from one-based to zero-based
+
+    // Count buttons
     numButtons = 1;
     for (i = 0; tbuffer[i] != '\0'; i++)
     {
@@ -6843,12 +6846,12 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     if (dfltbutton >= numButtons)
 	dfltbutton = -1;
 
-    /* Allocate array to hold the width of each button */
+    // Allocate array to hold the width of each button
     buttonWidths = ALLOC_MULT(int, numButtons);
     if (buttonWidths == NULL)
 	return -1;
 
-    /* Allocate array to hold the X position of each button */
+    // Allocate array to hold the X position of each button
     buttonPositions = ALLOC_MULT(int, numButtons);
     if (buttonPositions == NULL)
 	return -1;
@@ -6883,25 +6886,25 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     GetTextMetrics(hdc, &fontInfo);
     fontHeight = fontInfo.tmHeight;
 
-    /* Minimum width for horizontal button */
+    // Minimum width for horizontal button
     minButtonWidth = GetTextWidth(hdc, (char_u *)"Cancel", 6);
 
-    /* Maximum width of a dialog, if possible */
+    // Maximum width of a dialog, if possible
     if (s_hwnd == NULL)
     {
 	RECT	workarea_rect;
 
-	/* We don't have a window, use the desktop area. */
+	// We don't have a window, use the desktop area.
 	get_work_area(&workarea_rect);
 	maxDialogWidth = workarea_rect.right - workarea_rect.left - 100;
 	if (maxDialogWidth > 600)
 	    maxDialogWidth = 600;
-	/* Leave some room for the taskbar. */
+	// Leave some room for the taskbar.
 	maxDialogHeight = workarea_rect.bottom - workarea_rect.top - 150;
     }
     else
     {
-	/* Use our own window for the size, unless it's very small. */
+	// Use our own window for the size, unless it's very small.
 	GetWindowRect(s_hwnd, &rect);
 	maxDialogWidth = rect.right - rect.left
 				   - (GetSystemMetrics(SM_CXFRAME) +
@@ -6917,20 +6920,20 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 	    maxDialogHeight = DLG_MIN_MAX_HEIGHT;
     }
 
-    /* Set dlgwidth to width of message.
-     * Copy the message into "ga", changing NL to CR-NL and inserting line
-     * breaks where needed. */
+    // Set dlgwidth to width of message.
+    // Copy the message into "ga", changing NL to CR-NL and inserting line
+    // breaks where needed.
     pstart = message;
     messageWidth = 0;
     msgheight = 0;
     ga_init2(&ga, sizeof(char), 500);
     do
     {
-	msgheight += fontHeight;    /* at least one line */
-
-	/* Need to figure out where to break the string.  The system does it
-	 * at a word boundary, which would mean we can't compute the number of
-	 * wrapped lines. */
+	msgheight += fontHeight;    // at least one line
+
+	// Need to figure out where to break the string.  The system does it
+	// at a word boundary, which would mean we can't compute the number of
+	// wrapped lines.
 	textWidth = 0;
 	last_white = NULL;
 	for (pend = pstart; *pend != NUL && *pend != '\n'; )
@@ -6942,14 +6945,14 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 	    textWidth += GetTextWidthEnc(hdc, pend, l);
 	    if (textWidth >= maxDialogWidth)
 	    {
-		/* Line will wrap. */
+		// Line will wrap.
 		messageWidth = maxDialogWidth;
 		msgheight += fontHeight;
 		textWidth = 0;
 
 		if (last_white != NULL)
 		{
-		    /* break the line just after a space */
+		    // break the line just after a space
 		    ga.ga_len -= (int)(pend - (last_white + 1));
 		    pend = last_white + 1;
 		    last_white = NULL;
@@ -6973,9 +6976,9 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     if (ga.ga_data != NULL)
 	message = ga.ga_data;
 
-    messageWidth += 10;		/* roundoff space */
-
-    /* Add width of icon to dlgwidth, and some space */
+    messageWidth += 10;		// roundoff space
+
+    // Add width of icon to dlgwidth, and some space
     dlgwidth = messageWidth + DLG_ICON_WIDTH + 3 * dlgPaddingX
 					     + GetSystemMetrics(SM_CXVSCROLL);
 
@@ -7001,10 +7004,10 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 	    textWidth = GetTextWidthEnc(hdc, pstart, (int)(pend - pstart));
 	    if (textWidth < minButtonWidth)
 		textWidth = minButtonWidth;
-	    textWidth += dlgPaddingX;	    /* Padding within button */
+	    textWidth += dlgPaddingX;	    // Padding within button
 	    buttonWidths[i] = textWidth;
 	    buttonPositions[i++] = horizWidth;
-	    horizWidth += textWidth + dlgPaddingX; /* Pad between buttons */
+	    horizWidth += textWidth + dlgPaddingX; // Pad between buttons
 	    pstart = pend + 1;
 	} while (*pend != NUL);
 
@@ -7024,8 +7027,8 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 	    if (pend == NULL)
 		pend = pstart + STRLEN(pstart);	// Last button name.
 	    textWidth = GetTextWidthEnc(hdc, pstart, (int)(pend - pstart));
-	    textWidth += dlgPaddingX;		/* Padding within button */
-	    textWidth += DLG_VERT_PADDING_X * 2; /* Padding around button */
+	    textWidth += dlgPaddingX;		// Padding within button
+	    textWidth += DLG_VERT_PADDING_X * 2; // Padding around button
 	    if (textWidth > dlgwidth)
 		dlgwidth = textWidth;
 	    pstart = pend + 1;
@@ -7033,9 +7036,9 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     }
 
     if (dlgwidth < DLG_MIN_WIDTH)
-	dlgwidth = DLG_MIN_WIDTH;	/* Don't allow a really thin dialog!*/
-
-    /* start to fill in the dlgtemplate information.  addressing by WORDs */
+	dlgwidth = DLG_MIN_WIDTH;	// Don't allow a really thin dialog!
+
+    // start to fill in the dlgtemplate information.  addressing by WORDs
     if (s_usenewlook)
 	lStyle = DS_MODALFRAME | WS_CAPTION |DS_3DLOOK| WS_VISIBLE |DS_SETFONT;
     else
@@ -7043,7 +7046,7 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 
     add_long(lStyle);
     add_long(0);	// (lExtendedStyle)
-    pnumitems = p;	/*save where the number of items must be stored*/
+    pnumitems = p;	//save where the number of items must be stored
     add_word(0);	// NumberOfItems(will change later)
     add_word(10);	// x
     add_word(10);	// y
@@ -7061,13 +7064,13 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     if (textfield != NULL)
 	dlgheight += editboxheight;
 
-    /* Restrict the size to a maximum.  Causes a scrollbar to show up. */
+    // Restrict the size to a maximum.  Causes a scrollbar to show up.
     if (dlgheight > maxDialogHeight)
     {
 	msgheight = msgheight - (dlgheight - maxDialogHeight);
 	dlgheight = maxDialogHeight;
 	scroll_flag = WS_VSCROLL;
-	/* Make sure scrollbar doesn't appear in the middle of the dialog */
+	// Make sure scrollbar doesn't appear in the middle of the dialog
 	messageWidth = dlgwidth - DLG_ICON_WIDTH - 3 * dlgPaddingX;
     }
 
@@ -7076,18 +7079,18 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     add_word(0);	// Menu
     add_word(0);	// Class
 
-    /* copy the title of the dialog */
+    // copy the title of the dialog
     nchar = nCopyAnsiToWideChar(p, (title ? (LPSTR)title
 				   : (LPSTR)("Vim "VIM_VERSION_MEDIUM)), TRUE);
     p += nchar;
 
     if (s_usenewlook)
     {
-	/* do the font, since DS_3DLOOK doesn't work properly */
+	// do the font, since DS_3DLOOK doesn't work properly
 # ifdef USE_SYSMENU_FONT
 	if (use_lfSysmenu)
 	{
-	    /* point size */
+	    // point size
 	    *p++ = -MulDiv(lfSysmenu.lfHeight, 72,
 		    GetDeviceCaps(hdc, LOGPIXELSY));
 	    wcscpy(p, lfSysmenu.lfFaceName);
@@ -7109,10 +7112,10 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 
     pstart = tbuffer;
     if (!vertical)
-	horizWidth = (dlgwidth - horizWidth) / 2;	/* Now it's X offset */
+	horizWidth = (dlgwidth - horizWidth) / 2;	// Now it's X offset
     for (i = 0; i < numButtons; i++)
     {
-	/* get end of this button. */
+	// get end of this button.
 	for (	pend = pstart;
 		*pend && (*pend != DLG_BUTTON_SEP);
 		pend++)
@@ -7140,7 +7143,7 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 		    (i == dfltbutton
 			    ? BS_DEFPUSHBUTTON : BS_PUSHBUTTON) | WS_TABSTOP,
 		    PixelToDialogX(DLG_VERT_PADDING_X),
-		    PixelToDialogY(buttonYpos /* TBK */
+		    PixelToDialogY(buttonYpos // TBK
 				   + 2 * fontHeight * i),
 		    PixelToDialogX(dlgwidth - 2 * DLG_VERT_PADDING_X),
 		    (WORD)(PixelToDialogY(2 * fontHeight) - 1),
@@ -7152,16 +7155,16 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 		    (i == dfltbutton
 			    ? BS_DEFPUSHBUTTON : BS_PUSHBUTTON) | WS_TABSTOP,
 		    PixelToDialogX(horizWidth + buttonPositions[i]),
-		    PixelToDialogY(buttonYpos), /* TBK */
+		    PixelToDialogY(buttonYpos), // TBK
 		    PixelToDialogX(buttonWidths[i]),
 		    (WORD)(PixelToDialogY(2 * fontHeight) - 1),
 		    (WORD)(IDCANCEL + 1 + i), (WORD)0x0080, (char *)pstart);
 	}
-	pstart = pend + 1;	/*next button*/
+	pstart = pend + 1;	//next button
     }
     *pnumitems += numButtons;
 
-    /* Vim icon */
+    // Vim icon
     p = add_dialog_element(p, SS_ICON,
 	    PixelToDialogX(dlgPaddingX),
 	    PixelToDialogY(dlgPaddingY),
@@ -7170,7 +7173,7 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 	    DLG_NONBUTTON_CONTROL + 0, (WORD)0x0082,
 	    dlg_icons[type]);
 
-    /* Dialog message */
+    // Dialog message
     p = add_dialog_element(p, ES_LEFT|scroll_flag|ES_MULTILINE|ES_READONLY,
 	    PixelToDialogX(2 * dlgPaddingX + DLG_ICON_WIDTH),
 	    PixelToDialogY(dlgPaddingY),
@@ -7178,7 +7181,7 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 	    PixelToDialogY(msgheight),
 	    DLG_NONBUTTON_CONTROL + 1, (WORD)0x0081, (char *)message);
 
-    /* Edit box */
+    // Edit box
     if (textfield != NULL)
     {
 	p = add_dialog_element(p, ES_LEFT|ES_AUTOHSCROLL|WS_TABSTOP|WS_BORDER,
@@ -7196,11 +7199,10 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     DeleteObject(font);
     ReleaseDC(hwnd, hdc);
 
-    /* Let the dialog_callback() function know which button to make default
-     * If we have an edit box, make that the default. We also need to tell
-     * dialog_callback() if this dialog contains an edit box or not. We do
-     * this by setting s_textfield if it does.
-     */
+    // Let the dialog_callback() function know which button to make default
+    // If we have an edit box, make that the default. We also need to tell
+    // dialog_callback() if this dialog contains an edit box or not. We do
+    // this by setting s_textfield if it does.
     if (textfield != NULL)
     {
 	dialog_default_button = DLG_NONBUTTON_CONTROL + 2;
@@ -7212,7 +7214,7 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
 	s_textfield = NULL;
     }
 
-    /* show the dialog box modally and get a return value */
+    // show the dialog box modally and get a return value
     nchar = (int)DialogBoxIndirect(
 	    g_hinst,
 	    (LPDLGTEMPLATE)pdlgtemplate,
@@ -7225,13 +7227,13 @@ gui_mch_dialog(
     vim_free(buttonPositions);
     vim_free(ga.ga_data);
 
-    /* Focus back to our window (for when MDI is used). */
+    // Focus back to our window (for when MDI is used).
     (void)SetFocus(s_hwnd);
 
     return nchar;
 }
 
-#endif /* FEAT_GUI_DIALOG */
+#endif // FEAT_GUI_DIALOG
 
 /*
  * Put a simple element (basic class) onto a dialog template in memory.
@@ -7263,7 +7265,7 @@ add_dialog_element(
 {
     int nchar;
 
-    p = lpwAlign(p);	/* Align to dword boundary*/
+    p = lpwAlign(p);	// Align to dword boundary
     lStyle = lStyle | WS_VISIBLE | WS_CHILD;
     *p++ = LOWORD(lStyle);
     *p++ = HIWORD(lStyle);
@@ -7319,13 +7321,13 @@ nCopyAnsiToWideChar(
     BOOL use_enc)
 {
     int		nChar = 0;
-    int		len = lstrlen(lpAnsiIn) + 1;	/* include NUL character */
+    int		len = lstrlen(lpAnsiIn) + 1;	// include NUL character
     int		i;
     WCHAR	*wn;
 
     if (use_enc && enc_codepage >= 0 && (int)GetACP() != enc_codepage)
     {
-	/* Not a codepage, use our own conversion function. */
+	// Not a codepage, use our own conversion function.
 	wn = enc_to_utf16((char_u *)lpAnsiIn, NULL);
 	if (wn != NULL)
 	{
@@ -7335,14 +7337,14 @@ nCopyAnsiToWideChar(
 	}
     }
     if (nChar == 0)
-	/* Use Win32 conversion function. */
+	// Use Win32 conversion function.
 	nChar = MultiByteToWideChar(
 		enc_codepage > 0 ? enc_codepage : CP_ACP,
 		MB_PRECOMPOSED,
 		lpAnsiIn, len,
 		lpWCStr, len);
     for (i = 0; i < nChar; ++i)
-	if (lpWCStr[i] == (WORD)'\t')	/* replace tabs with spaces */
+	if (lpWCStr[i] == (WORD)'\t')	// replace tabs with spaces
 	    lpWCStr[i] = (WORD)' ';
 
     return nChar;
@@ -7360,7 +7362,7 @@ tearoff_lookup_menuhandle(
 {
     for ( ; menu != NULL; menu = menu->next)
     {
-	if (menu->modes == 0)	/* this menu has just been deleted */
+	if (menu->modes == 0)	// this menu has just been deleted
 	    continue;
 	if (menu_is_separator(menu->dname))
 	    continue;
@@ -7388,7 +7390,7 @@ tearoff_callback(
 	return (TRUE);
     }
 
-    /* May show the mouse pointer again. */
+    // May show the mouse pointer again.
     HandleMouseHide(message, lParam);
 
     if (message == WM_COMMAND)
@@ -7408,7 +7410,7 @@ tearoff_callback(
 			 TPM_LEFTALIGN | TPM_LEFTBUTTON,
 			 (int)rect.right - 8,
 			 (int)mp.y,
-			 (int)0,	    /*reserved param*/
+			 (int)0,	    // reserved param
 			 s_hwnd,
 			 NULL);
 		/*
@@ -7418,7 +7420,7 @@ tearoff_callback(
 	    }
 	}
 	else
-	    /* Pass on messages to the main Vim window */
+	    // Pass on messages to the main Vim window
 	    PostMessage(s_hwnd, WM_COMMAND, LOWORD(wParam), 0);
 	/*
 	 * Give main window the focus back: this is so after
@@ -7434,7 +7436,7 @@ tearoff_callback(
 	return TRUE;
     }
 
-    /* When moved around, give main window the focus back. */
+    // When moved around, give main window the focus back.
     if (message == WM_EXITSIZEMOVE)
 	(void)SetActiveWindow(s_hwnd);
 
@@ -7490,7 +7492,7 @@ get_dialog_font_metrics(void)
 
     if (!s_usenewlook)
     {
-	dlgFontSize = GetDialogBaseUnits();	/* fall back to big old system*/
+	dlgFontSize = GetDialogBaseUnits();	// fall back to big old system
 	s_dlgfntwidth = LOWORD(dlgFontSize);
 	s_dlgfntheight = HIWORD(dlgFontSize);
     }
@@ -7555,8 +7557,8 @@ gui_mch_tearoff(
     if (*title == MNU_HIDDEN_CHAR)
 	title++;
 
-    /* Allocate memory to store the dialog template.  It's made bigger when
-     * needed. */
+    // Allocate memory to store the dialog template.  It's made bigger when
+    // needed.
     template_len = DLG_ALLOC_SIZE;
     pdlgtemplate = p = (WORD *)LocalAlloc(LPTR, template_len);
     if (p == NULL)
@@ -7579,19 +7581,19 @@ gui_mch_tearoff(
     else
 	oldFont = SelectFont(hdc, GetStockObject(SYSTEM_FONT));
 
-    /* Calculate width of a single space.  Used for padding columns to the
-     * right width. */
+    // Calculate width of a single space.  Used for padding columns to the
+    // right width.
     spaceWidth = GetTextWidth(hdc, (char_u *)" ", 1);
 
-    /* Figure out max width of the text column, the accelerator column and the
-     * optional submenu column. */
+    // Figure out max width of the text column, the accelerator column and the
+    // optional submenu column.
     submenuWidth = 0;
     for (col = 0; col < 2; col++)
     {
 	columnWidths[col] = 0;
 	for (pmenu = menu->children; pmenu != NULL; pmenu = pmenu->next)
 	{
-	    /* Use "dname" here to compute the width of the visible text. */
+	    // Use "dname" here to compute the width of the visible text.
 	    text = (col == 0) ? pmenu->dname : pmenu->actext;
 	    if (text != NULL && *text != NUL)
 	    {
@@ -7605,7 +7607,7 @@ gui_mch_tearoff(
     }
     if (columnWidths[1] == 0)
     {
-	/* no accelerators */
+	// no accelerators
 	if (submenuWidth != 0)
 	    columnWidths[0] += submenuWidth;
 	else
@@ -7613,7 +7615,7 @@ gui_mch_tearoff(
     }
     else
     {
-	/* there is an accelerator column */
+	// there is an accelerator column
 	columnWidths[0] += TEAROFF_COLUMN_PADDING * spaceWidth;
 	columnWidths[1] += submenuWidth;
     }
@@ -7633,7 +7635,7 @@ gui_mch_tearoff(
 	dlgwidth = textWidth;
     dlgwidth += 2 * TEAROFF_PADDING_X + TEAROFF_BUTTON_PAD_X;
 
-    /* start to fill in the dlgtemplate information.  addressing by WORDs */
+    // start to fill in the dlgtemplate information.  addressing by WORDs
     if (s_usenewlook)
 	lStyle = DS_MODALFRAME | WS_CAPTION| WS_SYSMENU |DS_SETFONT| WS_VISIBLE;
     else
@@ -7644,7 +7646,7 @@ gui_mch_tearoff(
     *p++ = HIWORD(lStyle);
     *p++ = LOWORD(lExtendedStyle);
     *p++ = HIWORD(lExtendedStyle);
-    pnumitems = p;	/* save where the number of items must be stored */
+    pnumitems = p;	// save where the number of items must be stored
     *p++ = 0;		// NumberOfItems(will change later)
     gui_mch_getmouse(&x, &y);
     if (initX == 0xffffL)
@@ -7661,7 +7663,7 @@ gui_mch_tearoff(
     *p++ = 0;		// Menu
     *p++ = 0;		// Class
 
-    /* copy the title of the dialog */
+    // copy the title of the dialog
     nchar = nCopyAnsiToWideChar(p, ((*title)
 			    ? (LPSTR)title
 			    : (LPSTR)("Vim "VIM_VERSION_MEDIUM)), TRUE);
@@ -7669,11 +7671,11 @@ gui_mch_tearoff(
 
     if (s_usenewlook)
     {
-	/* do the font, since DS_3DLOOK doesn't work properly */
+	// do the font, since DS_3DLOOK doesn't work properly
 # ifdef USE_SYSMENU_FONT
 	if (use_lfSysmenu)
 	{
-	    /* point size */
+	    // point size
 	    *p++ = -MulDiv(lfSysmenu.lfHeight, 72,
 		    GetDeviceCaps(hdc, LOGPIXELSY));
 	    wcscpy(p, lfSysmenu.lfFaceName);
@@ -7699,7 +7701,7 @@ gui_mch_tearoff(
     top_menu = menu;
     for ( ; menu != NULL; menu = menu->next)
     {
-	if (menu->modes == 0)	/* this menu has just been deleted */
+	if (menu->modes == 0)	// this menu has just been deleted
 	    continue;
 	if (menu_is_separator(menu->dname))
 	{
@@ -7707,8 +7709,8 @@ gui_mch_tearoff(
 	    continue;
 	}
 
-	/* Check if there still is plenty of room in the template.  Make it
-	 * larger when needed. */
+	// Check if there still is plenty of room in the template.  Make it
+	// larger when needed.
 	if (((char *)p - (char *)pdlgtemplate) + 1000 > template_len)
 	{
 	    WORD    *newp;
@@ -7727,9 +7729,9 @@ gui_mch_tearoff(
 	    }
 	}
 
-	/* Figure out minimal length of this menu label.  Use "name" for the
-	 * actual text, "dname" for estimating the displayed size.  "name"
-	 * has "&a" for mnemonic and includes the accelerator. */
+	// Figure out minimal length of this menu label.  Use "name" for the
+	// actual text, "dname" for estimating the displayed size.  "name"
+	// has "&a" for mnemonic and includes the accelerator.
 	len = nameLen = (int)STRLEN(menu->name);
 	padding0 = (columnWidths[0] - GetTextWidthEnc(hdc, menu->dname,
 				      (int)STRLEN(menu->dname))) / spaceWidth;
@@ -7758,15 +7760,15 @@ gui_mch_tearoff(
 	    menuID = (WORD)((long_u)(menu->submenu_id) | (DWORD)0x8000);
 	}
 
-	/* Allocate menu label and fill it in */
+	// Allocate menu label and fill it in
 	text = label = alloc(len + 1);
 	if (label == NULL)
 	    break;
 
 	vim_strncpy(text, menu->name, nameLen);
-	text = vim_strchr(text, TAB);	    /* stop at TAB before actext */
+	text = vim_strchr(text, TAB);	    // stop at TAB before actext
 	if (text == NULL)
-	    text = label + nameLen;	    /* no actext, use whole name */
+	    text = label + nameLen;	    // no actext, use whole name
 	while (padding0-- > 0)
 	    *text++ = ' ';
 	if (menu->actext != NULL)
@@ -7806,7 +7808,7 @@ gui_mch_tearoff(
     *ptrueheight = (WORD)(sepPadding + 1 + 13 * (*pnumitems));
 
 
-    /* show modelessly */
+    // show modelessly
     the_menu->tearoff_handle = CreateDialogIndirectParam(
 	    g_hinst,
 	    (LPDLGTEMPLATE)pdlgtemplate,
@@ -7826,7 +7828,7 @@ gui_mch_tearoff(
      */
     (void)SetActiveWindow(s_hwnd);
 
-    /* make sure the right buttons are enabled */
+    // make sure the right buttons are enabled
     force_menu_update = TRUE;
 }
 #endif
@@ -7834,7 +7836,7 @@ gui_mch_tearoff(
 #if defined(FEAT_TOOLBAR) || defined(PROTO)
 # include "gui_w32_rc.h"
 
-/* This not defined in older SDKs */
+// This not defined in older SDKs
 # ifndef TBSTYLE_FLAT
 #  define TBSTYLE_FLAT		0x0800
 # endif
@@ -7941,7 +7943,7 @@ get_toolbar_bitmap(vimmenu_T *menu)
 
 	    i = (int)SendMessage(s_toolbarhwnd, TB_ADDBITMAP,
 			    (WPARAM)1, (LPARAM)&tbAddBitmap);
-	    /* i will be set to -1 if it fails */
+	    // i will be set to -1 if it fails
 	}
     }
     if (i == -1 && menu->iconidx >= 0 && menu->iconidx < TOOLBAR_BITMAP_COUNT)
@@ -7984,7 +7986,7 @@ GetTabFromPoint(
     {
 	TCHITTESTINFO htinfo;
 	htinfo.pt = pt;
-	/* ignore if a window under cusor is not tabcontrol. */
+	// ignore if a window under cusor is not tabcontrol.
 	if (s_tabhwnd == hWnd)
 	{
 	    int idx = TabCtrl_HitTest(s_tabhwnd, &htinfo);
@@ -8021,7 +8023,7 @@ tabline_wndproc(
 		s_pt.x = GET_X_LPARAM(lParam);
 		s_pt.y = GET_Y_LPARAM(lParam);
 		SetCapture(hwnd);
-		s_hCursor = GetCursor(); /* backup default cursor */
+		s_hCursor = GetCursor(); // backup default cursor
 		break;
 	    }
 	case WM_MOUSEMOVE:
@@ -8043,8 +8045,8 @@ tabline_wndproc(
 			TabCtrl_GetItemRect(hwnd, idx1, &rect);
 			nCenter = rect.left + (rect.right - rect.left) / 2;
 
-			/* Check if the mouse cursor goes over the center of
-			 * the next tab to prevent "flickering". */
+			// Check if the mouse cursor goes over the center of
+			// the next tab to prevent "flickering".
 			if ((idx0 < idx1) && (nCenter < pt.x))
 			{
 			    tabpage_move(idx1 + 1);
@@ -8157,7 +8159,7 @@ typedef struct _signicon_t
     HANDLE	hImage;
     UINT	uType;
 # ifdef FEAT_XPM_W32
-    HANDLE	hShape;	/* Mask bitmap handle */
+    HANDLE	hShape;	// Mask bitmap handle
 # endif
 } signicon_t;
 
@@ -8205,11 +8207,11 @@ gui_mch_drawsign(int row, int col, int t
 
 		hdcMem = CreateCompatibleDC(s_hdc);
 		hbmpOld = (HBITMAP)SelectObject(hdcMem, sign->hShape);
-		/* Make hole */
+		// Make hole
 		BitBlt(s_hdc, x, y, w, h, hdcMem, 0, 0, SRCAND);
 
 		SelectObject(hdcMem, sign->hImage);
-		/* Paint sign */
+		// Paint sign
 		BitBlt(s_hdc, x, y, w, h, hdcMem, 0, 0, SRCPAINT);
 		SelectObject(hdcMem, hbmpOld);
 		DeleteDC(hdcMem);
@@ -8250,7 +8252,7 @@ gui_mch_register_sign(char_u *signfile)
     char_u	*ext;
 
     sign.hImage = NULL;
-    ext = signfile + STRLEN(signfile) - 4; /* get extension */
+    ext = signfile + STRLEN(signfile) - 4; // get extension
     if (ext > signfile)
     {
 	int do_load = 1;
@@ -8305,7 +8307,8 @@ gui_mch_destroy_sign(void *sign)
 
 #if defined(FEAT_BEVAL_GUI) || defined(PROTO)
 
-/* BALLOON-EVAL IMPLEMENTATION FOR WINDOWS.
+/*
+ * BALLOON-EVAL IMPLEMENTATION FOR WINDOWS.
  *  Added by Sergey Khorev <sergey.khorev@gmail.com>
  *
  * The only reused thing is beval.h and get_beval_info()
@@ -8366,8 +8369,8 @@ multiline_balloon_available(void)
 	}
 	else
 	{
-	    /* there is chance we have ancient CommCtl 4.70
-	       which doesn't export DllGetVersion */
+	    // there is chance we have ancient CommCtl 4.70
+	    // which doesn't export DllGetVersion
 	    DWORD dwHandle = 0;
 	    DWORD len = GetFileVersionInfoSize(comctl_dll, &dwHandle);
 	    if (len > 0)
@@ -8500,8 +8503,8 @@ BevalTimerProc(
 		|| abs(cur_beval->x - pt.x) > 3
 		|| abs(cur_beval->y - pt.y) > 3))
     {
-	/* Pointer resting in one place long enough, it's time to show
-	 * the tooltip. */
+	// Pointer resting in one place long enough, it's time to show
+	// the tooltip.
 	cur_beval->showState = ShS_PENDING;
 	cur_beval->x = pt.x;
 	cur_beval->y = pt.y;
@@ -8554,7 +8557,7 @@ gui_mch_post_balloon(BalloonEval *beval,
 
     if (abs(beval->x - pt.x) < 3 && abs(beval->y - pt.y) < 3)
     {
-	/* cursor is still here */
+	// cursor is still here
 	gui_mch_disable_beval_area(cur_beval);
 	beval->showState = ShS_SHOWING;
 	make_tooltip(beval, (char *)mesg, pt);
@@ -8564,12 +8567,12 @@ gui_mch_post_balloon(BalloonEval *beval,
 
     BalloonEval *
 gui_mch_create_beval_area(
-    void	*target UNUSED,	/* ignored, always use s_textArea */
+    void	*target UNUSED,	// ignored, always use s_textArea
     char_u	*mesg,
     void	(*mesgCB)(BalloonEval *, int),
     void	*clientData)
 {
-    /* partially stolen from gui_beval.c */
+    // partially stolen from gui_beval.c
     BalloonEval	*beval;
 
     if (mesg != NULL && mesgCB != NULL)
@@ -8600,7 +8603,7 @@ gui_mch_create_beval_area(
     static void
 Handle_WM_Notify(HWND hwnd UNUSED, LPNMHDR pnmh)
 {
-    if (pnmh->idFrom != ID_BEVAL_TOOLTIP) /* it is not our tooltip */
+    if (pnmh->idFrom != ID_BEVAL_TOOLTIP) // it is not our tooltip
 	return;
 
     if (cur_beval != NULL)
@@ -8611,7 +8614,7 @@ Handle_WM_Notify(HWND hwnd UNUSED, LPNMH
 	    // TRACE0("TTN_SHOW {{{");
 	    // TRACE0("TTN_SHOW }}}");
 	    break;
-	case TTN_POP: /* Before tooltip disappear */
+	case TTN_POP: // Before tooltip disappear
 	    // TRACE0("TTN_POP {{{");
 	    delete_tooltip(cur_beval);
 	    gui_mch_enable_beval_area(cur_beval);
@@ -8621,7 +8624,7 @@ Handle_WM_Notify(HWND hwnd UNUSED, LPNMH
 	    break;
 	case TTN_GETDISPINFO:
 	    {
-		/* if you get there then we have new common controls */
+		// if you get there then we have new common controls
 		NMTTDISPINFO_NEW *info = (NMTTDISPINFO_NEW *)pnmh;
 		info->lpszText = (LPSTR)info->lParam;
 		info->uFlags |= TTF_DI_SETITEM;
@@ -8656,7 +8659,7 @@ gui_mch_destroy_beval_area(BalloonEval *
     vim_free(beval->tofree);
     vim_free(beval);
 }
-#endif /* FEAT_BEVAL_GUI */
+#endif // FEAT_BEVAL_GUI
 
 #if defined(FEAT_NETBEANS_INTG) || defined(PROTO)
 /*
--- a/src/gui_x11.c
+++ b/src/gui_x11.c
@@ -57,7 +57,7 @@
 #define VIM_NAME	"vim"
 #define VIM_CLASS	"Vim"
 
-/* Default resource values */
+// Default resource values
 #define DFLT_FONT		"7x13"
 #ifdef FONTSET_ALWAYS
 # define DFLT_MENU_FONT		XtDefaultFontSet
@@ -74,7 +74,7 @@
 # define DFLT_TOOLTIP_BG_COLOR	"#ffff91"
 # define DFLT_TOOLTIP_FG_COLOR	"#000000"
 #else
-/* use the default (CDE) colors */
+// use the default (CDE) colors
 # define DFLT_MENU_BG_COLOR	""
 # define DFLT_MENU_FG_COLOR	""
 # define DFLT_SCROLL_BG_COLOR	""
@@ -85,9 +85,9 @@
 
 Widget vimShell = (Widget)0;
 
-static Atom   wm_atoms[2];	/* Window Manager Atoms */
-#define DELETE_WINDOW_IDX 0	/* index in wm_atoms[] for WM_DELETE_WINDOW */
-#define SAVE_YOURSELF_IDX 1	/* index in wm_atoms[] for WM_SAVE_YOURSELF */
+static Atom   wm_atoms[2];	// Window Manager Atoms
+#define DELETE_WINDOW_IDX 0	// index in wm_atoms[] for WM_DELETE_WINDOW
+#define SAVE_YOURSELF_IDX 1	// index in wm_atoms[] for WM_SAVE_YOURSELF
 
 #ifdef FEAT_XFONTSET
 /*
@@ -198,7 +198,7 @@ static struct specialkey
     {XK_F32,		'F', 'M'},
     {XK_F33,		'F', 'N'},
     {XK_F34,		'F', 'O'},
-    {XK_F35,		'F', 'P'},	/* keysymdef.h defines up to F35 */
+    {XK_F35,		'F', 'P'},	// keysymdef.h defines up to F35
 #ifdef SunXK_F36
     {SunXK_F36,		'F', 'Q'},
     {SunXK_F37,		'F', 'R'},
@@ -215,7 +215,7 @@ static struct specialkey
     {XK_Next,		'k', 'N'},
     {XK_Print,		'%', '9'},
 
-    /* Keypad keys: */
+    // Keypad keys:
 #ifdef XK_KP_Left
     {XK_KP_Left,	'k', 'l'},
     {XK_KP_Right,	'k', 'r'},
@@ -247,7 +247,7 @@ static struct specialkey
     {XK_KP_9,		'K', 'L'},
 #endif
 
-    /* End of list marker: */
+    // End of list marker:
     {(KeySym)0,	    0, 0}
 };
 
@@ -267,19 +267,19 @@ static struct specialkey
 #define XtCMenuFontSet		"MenuFontSet"
 
 
-/* Resources for setting the foreground and background colors of menus */
+// Resources for setting the foreground and background colors of menus
 #define XtNmenuBackground	"menuBackground"
 #define XtCMenuBackground	"MenuBackground"
 #define XtNmenuForeground	"menuForeground"
 #define XtCMenuForeground	"MenuForeground"
 
-/* Resources for setting the foreground and background colors of scrollbars */
+// Resources for setting the foreground and background colors of scrollbars
 #define XtNscrollBackground	"scrollBackground"
 #define XtCScrollBackground	"ScrollBackground"
 #define XtNscrollForeground	"scrollForeground"
 #define XtCScrollForeground	"ScrollForeground"
 
-/* Resources for setting the foreground and background colors of tooltip */
+// Resources for setting the foreground and background colors of tooltip
 #define XtNtooltipBackground	"tooltipBackground"
 #define XtCTooltipBackground	"TooltipBackground"
 #define XtNtooltipForeground	"tooltipForeground"
@@ -383,7 +383,7 @@ static XtResource vim_resources[] =
 	(XtPointer)SB_DEFAULT_WIDTH
     },
 #ifdef FEAT_MENU
-# ifdef FEAT_GUI_ATHENA		/* with Motif the height is always computed */
+# ifdef FEAT_GUI_ATHENA		// with Motif the height is always computed
     {
 	XtNmenuHeight,
 	XtCMenuHeight,
@@ -391,7 +391,7 @@ static XtResource vim_resources[] =
 	sizeof(int),
 	XtOffsetOf(gui_T, menu_height),
 	XtRImmediate,
-	(XtPointer)MENU_DEFAULT_HEIGHT	    /* Should figure out at run time */
+	(XtPointer)MENU_DEFAULT_HEIGHT	    // Should figure out at run time
     },
 # endif
     {
@@ -473,7 +473,7 @@ static XtResource vim_resources[] =
 	XtRString,
 	DFLT_TOOLTIP_FONT
     },
-    /* This one may not be really needed? */
+    // This one may not be really needed?
     {
 	"balloonEvalFontSet",
 	XtCFontSet,
@@ -483,7 +483,7 @@ static XtResource vim_resources[] =
 	XtRImmediate,
 	(XtPointer)NOFONTSET
     },
-#endif /* FEAT_BEVAL_GUI */
+#endif // FEAT_BEVAL_GUI
 #ifdef FEAT_XIM
     {
 	"preeditType",
@@ -503,7 +503,7 @@ static XtResource vim_resources[] =
 	XtRString,
 	NULL
     },
-#endif /* FEAT_XIM */
+#endif // FEAT_XIM
 };
 
 /*
@@ -514,7 +514,7 @@ static XtResource vim_resources[] =
  */
 static XrmOptionDescRec cmdline_options[] =
 {
-    /* We handle these options ourselves */
+    // We handle these options ourselves
     {"-bg",		".background",	    XrmoptionSepArg,	NULL},
     {"-background",	".background",	    XrmoptionSepArg,	NULL},
     {"-fg",		".foreground",	    XrmoptionSepArg,	NULL},
@@ -572,12 +572,12 @@ channel_poll_cb(
 {
     XtIntervalId    *channel_timer = (XtIntervalId *)client_data;
 
-    /* Using an event handler for a channel that may be disconnected does
-     * not work, it hangs.  Instead poll for messages. */
+    // Using an event handler for a channel that may be disconnected does
+    // not work, it hangs.  Instead poll for messages.
     channel_handle_events(TRUE);
     parse_queued_messages();
 
-    /* repeat */
+    // repeat
     *channel_timer = XtAppAddTimeOut(app_context, (long_u)20,
 						 channel_poll_cb, client_data);
 }
@@ -602,7 +602,7 @@ gui_x11_visibility_cb(
     XSetGraphicsExposures(gui.dpy, gui.text_gc,
 	    gui.visibility != VisibilityUnobscured);
 
-    /* This is needed for when redrawing is slow. */
+    // This is needed for when redrawing is slow.
     gui_mch_update();
 }
 
@@ -619,14 +619,14 @@ gui_x11_expose_cb(
     if (event->type != Expose)
 	return;
 
-    out_flush();	    /* make sure all output has been processed */
+    out_flush();	    // make sure all output has been processed
 
     gevent = (XExposeEvent *)event;
     gui_redraw(gevent->x, gevent->y, gevent->width, gevent->height);
 
     new_x = FILL_X(0);
 
-    /* Clear the border areas if needed */
+    // Clear the border areas if needed
     if (gevent->x < new_x)
 	XClearArea(gui.dpy, gui.wid, 0, 0, new_x, 0, False);
     if (gevent->y < FILL_Y(0))
@@ -636,7 +636,7 @@ gui_x11_expose_cb(
     if (gevent->y > FILL_Y(Rows))
 	XClearArea(gui.dpy, gui.wid, 0, FILL_Y((int)Rows), 0, 0, False);
 
-    /* This is needed for when redrawing is slow. */
+    // This is needed for when redrawing is slow.
     gui_mch_update();
 }
 
@@ -783,8 +783,8 @@ gui_x11_key_hit_cb(
     if (xic)
     {
 # ifdef USE_UTF8LOOKUP
-	/* XFree86 4.0.2 or newer: Be able to get UTF-8 characters even when
-	 * the locale isn't utf-8. */
+	// XFree86 4.0.2 or newer: Be able to get UTF-8 characters even when
+	// the locale isn't utf-8.
 	if (enc_utf8)
 	    len = Xutf8LookupString(xic, ev_press, (char *)string,
 				  sizeof(string_shortbuf), &key_sym, &status);
@@ -797,8 +797,8 @@ gui_x11_key_hit_cb(
 	    string = (char_u *)XtMalloc(len + 1);
 	    string_alloced = True;
 # ifdef USE_UTF8LOOKUP
-	    /* XFree86 4.0.2 or newer: Be able to get UTF-8 characters even
-	     * when the locale isn't utf-8.  */
+	    // XFree86 4.0.2 or newer: Be able to get UTF-8 characters even
+	    // when the locale isn't utf-8.
 	    if (enc_utf8)
 		len = Xutf8LookupString(xic, ev_press, (char *)string,
 						      len, &key_sym, &status);
@@ -810,15 +810,15 @@ gui_x11_key_hit_cb(
 	if (status == XLookupNone || status == XLookupChars)
 	    key_sym = XK_VoidSymbol;
 
-	/* Do conversion from 'termencoding' to 'encoding'.  When using
-	 * Xutf8LookupString() it has already been done. */
+	// Do conversion from 'termencoding' to 'encoding'.  When using
+	// Xutf8LookupString() it has already been done.
 	if (len > 0 && input_conv.vc_type != CONV_NONE
 # ifdef USE_UTF8LOOKUP
 		&& !enc_utf8
 # endif
 		)
 	{
-	    int		maxlen = len * 4 + 40;	/* guessed */
+	    int		maxlen = len * 4 + 40;	// guessed
 	    char_u	*p = (char_u *)XtMalloc(maxlen);
 
 	    mch_memmove(p, string, len);
@@ -829,8 +829,8 @@ gui_x11_key_hit_cb(
 	    len = convert_input(p, len, maxlen);
 	}
 
-	/* Translate CSI to K_CSI, otherwise it could be recognized as the
-	 * start of a special key. */
+	// Translate CSI to K_CSI, otherwise it could be recognized as the
+	// start of a special key.
 	for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
 	    if (string[i] == CSI)
 	    {
@@ -864,7 +864,7 @@ gui_x11_key_hit_cb(
 #endif
 
     if (key_sym == XK_space)
-	string[0] = ' ';	/* Otherwise Ctrl-Space doesn't work */
+	string[0] = ' ';	// Otherwise Ctrl-Space doesn't work
 
     /*
      * Only on some machines ^_ requires Ctrl+Shift+minus.  For consistency,
@@ -874,7 +874,7 @@ gui_x11_key_hit_cb(
 	string[0] = Ctrl__;
 
 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
-    /* why do we get XK_ISO_Left_Tab instead of XK_Tab for shift-tab? */
+    // why do we get XK_ISO_Left_Tab instead of XK_Tab for shift-tab?
     if (key_sym == XK_ISO_Left_Tab)
     {
 	key_sym = XK_Tab;
@@ -883,10 +883,10 @@ gui_x11_key_hit_cb(
     }
 #endif
 
-    /* Check for Alt/Meta key (Mod1Mask), but not for a BS, DEL or character
-     * that already has the 8th bit set.  And not when using a double-byte
-     * encoding, setting the 8th bit may make it the lead byte of a
-     * double-byte character. */
+    // Check for Alt/Meta key (Mod1Mask), but not for a BS, DEL or character
+    // that already has the 8th bit set.  And not when using a double-byte
+    // encoding, setting the 8th bit may make it the lead byte of a
+    // double-byte character.
     if (len == 1
 	    && (ev_press->state & Mod1Mask)
 	    && !(key_sym == XK_BackSpace || key_sym == XK_Delete)
@@ -894,7 +894,7 @@ gui_x11_key_hit_cb(
 	    && !enc_dbcs)
     {
 #if defined(FEAT_MENU) && defined(FEAT_GUI_MOTIF)
-	/* Ignore ALT keys when they are used for the menu only */
+	// Ignore ALT keys when they are used for the menu only
 	if (gui.menu_is_active
 		&& (p_wak[0] == 'y'
 		    || (p_wak[0] == 'm' && gui_is_menu_shortcut(string[0]))))
@@ -911,13 +911,13 @@ gui_x11_key_hit_cb(
 	len2 = XLookupString(ev_press, (char *)string2, sizeof(string2),
 							     &key_sym2, NULL);
 	if (key_sym2 == XK_space)
-	    string2[0] = ' ';	    /* Otherwise Meta-Ctrl-Space doesn't work */
+	    string2[0] = ' ';	    // Otherwise Meta-Ctrl-Space doesn't work
 	if (	   len2 == 1
 		&& string[0] == string2[0]
 		&& !(key_sym == XK_Tab && (ev_press->state & ShiftMask)))
 	{
 	    string[0] |= 0x80;
-	    if (enc_utf8) /* convert to utf-8 */
+	    if (enc_utf8) // convert to utf-8
 	    {
 		string[1] = string[0] & 0xbf;
 		string[0] = ((unsigned)string[0] >> 6) + 0xc0;
@@ -942,8 +942,8 @@ gui_x11_key_hit_cb(
 	len = -3;
     }
 
-    /* Check for special keys.  Also do this when len == 1 (key has an ASCII
-     * value) to detect backspace, delete and keypad keys. */
+    // Check for special keys.  Also do this when len == 1 (key has an ASCII
+    // value) to detect backspace, delete and keypad keys.
     if (len == 0 || len == 1)
     {
 	for (i = 0; special_keys[i].key_sym != (KeySym)0; i++)
@@ -959,12 +959,12 @@ gui_x11_key_hit_cb(
 	}
     }
 
-    /* Unrecognised key is ignored. */
+    // Unrecognised key is ignored.
     if (len == 0)
 	goto theend;
 
-    /* Special keys (and a few others) may have modifiers.  Also when using a
-     * double-byte encoding (can't set the 8th bit). */
+    // Special keys (and a few others) may have modifiers.  Also when using a
+    // double-byte encoding (can't set the 8th bit).
     if (len == -3 || key_sym == XK_space || key_sym == XK_Tab
 	    || key_sym == XK_Return || key_sym == XK_Linefeed
 	    || key_sym == XK_Escape
@@ -1040,7 +1040,7 @@ gui_x11_key_hit_cb(
     }
 #endif
 theend:
-    {}	    /* some compilers need a statement here */
+    {}	    // some compilers need a statement here
 #ifdef FEAT_XIM
     if (string_alloced)
 	XtFree((char *)string);
@@ -1065,7 +1065,7 @@ gui_x11_mouse_cb(
 
     if (event->type == MotionNotify)
     {
-	/* Get the latest position, avoids lagging behind on a drag. */
+	// Get the latest position, avoids lagging behind on a drag.
 	x = event->xmotion.x;
 	y = event->xmotion.y;
 	x_modifiers = event->xmotion.state;
@@ -1077,10 +1077,10 @@ gui_x11_mouse_cb(
 	 */
 	gui_mch_mousehide(FALSE);
 
-	if (button != MOUSE_DRAG)	/* just moving the rodent */
+	if (button != MOUSE_DRAG)	// just moving the rodent
 	{
 #ifdef FEAT_MENU
-	    if (dud)			/* moved in vimForm */
+	    if (dud)			// moved in vimForm
 		y -= gui.menu_height;
 #endif
 	    gui_mouse_moved(x, y);
@@ -1093,7 +1093,7 @@ gui_x11_mouse_cb(
 	y = event->xbutton.y;
 	if (event->type == ButtonPress)
 	{
-	    /* Handle multiple clicks */
+	    // Handle multiple clicks
 	    if (!timed_out)
 	    {
 		XtRemoveTimeOut(timer);
@@ -1104,7 +1104,7 @@ gui_x11_mouse_cb(
 			gui_x11_timer_cb, &timed_out);
 	    switch (event->xbutton.button)
 	    {
-		/* keep in sync with gui_gtk_x11.c */
+		// keep in sync with gui_gtk_x11.c
 		case Button1:	button = MOUSE_LEFT;	break;
 		case Button2:	button = MOUSE_MIDDLE;	break;
 		case Button3:	button = MOUSE_RIGHT;	break;
@@ -1115,13 +1115,13 @@ gui_x11_mouse_cb(
 		case 8:		button = MOUSE_X1;	break;
 		case 9:		button = MOUSE_X2;	break;
 		default:
-		    return;	/* Unknown button */
+		    return;	// Unknown button
 	    }
 	}
 	else if (event->type == ButtonRelease)
 	    button = MOUSE_RELEASE;
 	else
-	    return;	/* Unknown mouse event type */
+	    return;	// Unknown mouse event type
 
 	x_modifiers = event->xbutton.state;
 #if defined(FEAT_GUI_MOTIF) && defined(FEAT_MENU)
@@ -1134,7 +1134,7 @@ gui_x11_mouse_cb(
 	vim_modifiers |= MOUSE_SHIFT;
     if (x_modifiers & ControlMask)
 	vim_modifiers |= MOUSE_CTRL;
-    if (x_modifiers & Mod1Mask)	    /* Alt or Meta key */
+    if (x_modifiers & Mod1Mask)	    // Alt or Meta key
 	vim_modifiers |= MOUSE_ALT;
 
     gui_send_mouse_event(button, x, y, repeated_click, vim_modifiers);
@@ -1166,14 +1166,14 @@ gui_mch_prepare(int *argc, char **argv)
     arg = 1;
     while (arg < *argc)
     {
-	/* Look for argv[arg] in cmdline_options[] table */
+	// Look for argv[arg] in cmdline_options[] table
 	for (i = 0; i < (int)XtNumber(cmdline_options); i++)
 	    if (strcmp(argv[arg], cmdline_options[i].option) == 0)
 		break;
 
 	if (i < (int)XtNumber(cmdline_options))
 	{
-	    /* Remember finding "-rv" or "-reverse" */
+	    // Remember finding "-rv" or "-reverse"
 	    if (strcmp("-rv", argv[arg]) == 0
 		    || strcmp("-reverse", argv[arg]) == 0)
 		found_reverse_arg = TRUE;
@@ -1182,7 +1182,7 @@ gui_mch_prepare(int *argc, char **argv)
 		    && arg + 1 < *argc)
 		font_argument = argv[arg + 1];
 
-	    /* Found match in table, so move it into gui_argv */
+	    // Found match in table, so move it into gui_argv
 	    gui_argv[gui_argc++] = argv[arg];
 	    if (--*argc > arg)
 	    {
@@ -1190,7 +1190,7 @@ gui_mch_prepare(int *argc, char **argv)
 						    * sizeof(char *));
 		if (cmdline_options[i].argKind != XrmoptionNoArg)
 		{
-		    /* Move the options argument as well */
+		    // Move the options argument as well
 		    gui_argv[gui_argc++] = argv[arg];
 		    if (--*argc > arg)
 			mch_memmove(&argv[arg], &argv[arg + 1], (*argc - arg)
@@ -1203,7 +1203,7 @@ gui_mch_prepare(int *argc, char **argv)
 #ifdef FEAT_NETBEANS_INTG
 	    if (strncmp("-nb", argv[arg], 3) == 0)
 	{
-	    gui.dofork = FALSE;	/* don't fork() when starting GUI */
+	    gui.dofork = FALSE;	// don't fork() when starting GUI
 	    netbeansArg = argv[arg];
 	    mch_memmove(&argv[arg], &argv[arg + 1],
 					    (--*argc - arg) * sizeof(char *));
@@ -1243,9 +1243,9 @@ gui_mch_init_check(void)
 
 # if defined(FEAT_FLOAT) && defined(LC_NUMERIC)
     {
-	/* The call to XtOpenDisplay() may have set the locale from the
-	 * environment. Set LC_NUMERIC to "C" to make sure that strtod() uses a
-	 * decimal point, not a comma. */
+	// The call to XtOpenDisplay() may have set the locale from the
+	// environment. Set LC_NUMERIC to "C" to make sure that strtod() uses a
+	// decimal point, not a comma.
 	char *p = setlocale(LC_NUMERIC, NULL);
 
 	if (p == NULL || strcmp(p, "C") != 0)
@@ -1293,7 +1293,7 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
     unsigned	w, h;
 
 #if 0
-    /* Uncomment this to enable synchronous mode for debugging */
+    // Uncomment this to enable synchronous mode for debugging
     XSynchronize(gui.dpy, True);
 #endif
 
@@ -1312,9 +1312,8 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
      * Get the colors ourselves.  Using the automatic conversion doesn't
      * handle looking for approximate colors.
      */
-    /* NOTE: These next few lines are an exact duplicate of gui_athena.c's
-     * gui_mch_def_colors().  Why?
-     */
+    // NOTE: These next few lines are an exact duplicate of gui_athena.c's
+    // gui_mch_def_colors().  Why?
     gui.menu_fg_pixel = gui_get_color((char_u *)gui.rsrc_menu_fg_name);
     gui.menu_bg_pixel = gui_get_color((char_u *)gui.rsrc_menu_bg_name);
     gui.scroll_fg_pixel = gui_get_color((char_u *)gui.rsrc_scroll_fg_name);
@@ -1325,16 +1324,16 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
 #endif
 
 #if defined(FEAT_MENU) && defined(FEAT_GUI_ATHENA)
-    /* If the menu height was set, don't change it at runtime */
+    // If the menu height was set, don't change it at runtime
     if (gui.menu_height != MENU_DEFAULT_HEIGHT)
 	gui.menu_height_fixed = TRUE;
 #endif
 
-    /* Set default foreground and background colours */
+    // Set default foreground and background colours
     gui.norm_pixel = gui.def_norm_pixel;
     gui.back_pixel = gui.def_back_pixel;
 
-    /* Check if reverse video needs to be applied (on Sun it's done by X) */
+    // Check if reverse video needs to be applied (on Sun it's done by X)
     if (gui.rsrc_rev_video && gui_get_lightness(gui.back_pixel)
 					  > gui_get_lightness(gui.norm_pixel))
     {
@@ -1344,8 +1343,8 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
 	gui.def_back_pixel = gui.back_pixel;
     }
 
-    /* Get the colors from the "Normal", "Tooltip", "Scrollbar" and "Menu"
-     * group (set in syntax.c or in a vimrc file) */
+    // Get the colors from the "Normal", "Tooltip", "Scrollbar" and "Menu"
+    // group (set in syntax.c or in a vimrc file)
     set_normal_colors();
 
     /*
@@ -1377,8 +1376,8 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
     if (gui_win_x != -1 && gui_win_y != -1)
 	gui_mch_set_winpos(gui_win_x, gui_win_y);
 
-    /* Now adapt the supplied(?) geometry-settings */
-    /* Added by Kjetil Jacobsen <kjetilja@stud.cs.uit.no> */
+    // Now adapt the supplied(?) geometry-settings
+    // Added by Kjetil Jacobsen <kjetilja@stud.cs.uit.no>
     if (gui.geom != NULL && *gui.geom != NUL)
     {
 	mask = XParseGeometry((char *)gui.geom, &x, &y, &w, &h);
@@ -1427,10 +1426,10 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
 		    vim_mask_icon_height));
 	XtSetValues(vimShell, arg, (Cardinal)2);
 #else
-/* Use Pixmaps, looking much nicer. */
-
-/* If you get an error message here, you still need to unpack the runtime
- * archive! */
+// Use Pixmaps, looking much nicer.
+
+// If you get an error message here, you still need to unpack the runtime
+// archive!
 # ifdef magick
 #  undef magick
 # endif
@@ -1481,7 +1480,7 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
 
     attr.valuemask = 0L;
     attr.valuemask = XpmCloseness | XpmReturnPixels | XpmColormap | XpmDepth;
-    attr.closeness = 65535;	/* accuracy isn't crucial */
+    attr.closeness = 65535;	// accuracy isn't crucial
     attr.colormap = cmap;
     attr.depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen(scr);
 
@@ -1511,7 +1510,7 @@ gui_mch_init(void)
 #endif
 
 #ifdef USE_XSMP
-    /* Attach listener on ICE connection */
+    // Attach listener on ICE connection
     if (-1 != xsmp_icefd)
 	_xsmp_xtinputid = XtAppAddInput(app_context, xsmp_icefd,
 		(XtPointer)XtInputReadMask, local_xsmp_handle_requests, NULL);
@@ -1569,7 +1568,7 @@ gui_mch_new_colors(void)
     int
 gui_mch_open(void)
 {
-    /* Actually open the window */
+    // Actually open the window
     XtRealizeWidget(vimShell);
     XtManageChild(XtNameToWidget(vimShell, "*vimForm"));
 
@@ -1599,7 +1598,7 @@ gui_mch_open(void)
 #ifdef FEAT_CLIENTSERVER
     if (serverName == NULL && serverDelayedStartName != NULL)
     {
-	/* This is a :gui command in a plain vim with no previous server */
+	// This is a :gui command in a plain vim with no previous server
 	commWindow = XtWindow(vimShell);
 	(void)serverRegisterName(gui.dpy, serverDelayedStartName);
     }
@@ -1618,7 +1617,7 @@ gui_mch_open(void)
 
 
 #if defined(FEAT_MENU) && defined(FEAT_GUI_ATHENA)
-    /* The Athena GUI needs this again after opening the window */
+    // The Athena GUI needs this again after opening the window
     gui_position_menu();
 # ifdef FEAT_TOOLBAR
     gui_mch_set_toolbar_pos(0, gui.menu_height, gui.menu_width,
@@ -1626,9 +1625,9 @@ gui_mch_open(void)
 # endif
 #endif
 
-    /* Get the colors for the highlight groups (gui_check_colors() might have
-     * changed them) */
-    highlight_gui_started();		/* re-init colors and fonts */
+    // Get the colors for the highlight groups (gui_check_colors() might have
+    // changed them)
+    highlight_gui_started();		// re-init colors and fonts
 
 #ifdef FEAT_XIM
     xim_init();
@@ -1653,13 +1652,13 @@ gui_init_tooltip_font(void)
 
     if (XtConvertAndStore(vimShell, XtRString, &from, XtRFontSet, &to) == False)
     {
-	/* Failed. What to do? */
+	// Failed. What to do?
     }
 }
 #endif
 
 #if defined(FEAT_MENU) || defined(PROTO)
-/* Convert the menu font/fontset name to an XFontStruct/XFontset */
+// Convert the menu font/fontset name to an XFontStruct/XFontset
     void
 gui_init_menu_font(void)
 {
@@ -1673,7 +1672,7 @@ gui_init_menu_font(void)
 
     if (XtConvertAndStore(vimShell, XtRString, &from, XtRFontSet, &to) == False)
     {
-	/* Failed. What to do? */
+	// Failed. What to do?
     }
 #else
     from.addr = (char *)gui.rsrc_menu_font_name;
@@ -1683,7 +1682,7 @@ gui_init_menu_font(void)
 
     if (XtConvertAndStore(vimShell, XtRString, &from, XtRFontStruct, &to) == False)
     {
-	/* Failed. What to do? */
+	// Failed. What to do?
     }
 #endif
 }
@@ -1693,8 +1692,8 @@ gui_init_menu_font(void)
 gui_mch_exit(int rc UNUSED)
 {
 #if 0
-    /* Lesstif gives an error message here, and so does Solaris.  The man page
-     * says that this isn't needed when exiting, so just skip it. */
+    // Lesstif gives an error message here, and so does Solaris.  The man page
+    // says that this isn't needed when exiting, so just skip it.
     XtCloseDisplay(gui.dpy);
 #endif
     VIM_CLEAR(gui_argv);
@@ -1788,8 +1787,8 @@ gui_mch_init_font(
 #endif
 
 #ifdef FEAT_GUI_MOTIF
-    /* A font name equal "*" is indicating, that we should activate the font
-     * selection dialogue to get a new font name. So let us do it here. */
+    // A font name equal "*" is indicating, that we should activate the font
+    // selection dialogue to get a new font name. So let us do it here.
     if (font_name != NULL && STRCMP(font_name, "*") == 0)
 	font_name = gui_xm_select_font(hl_get_font_name());
 #endif
@@ -1797,8 +1796,8 @@ gui_mch_init_font(
 #ifdef FEAT_XFONTSET
     if (do_fontset)
     {
-	/* If 'guifontset' is set, VIM treats all font specifications as if
-	 * they were fontsets, and 'guifontset' becomes the default. */
+	// If 'guifontset' is set, VIM treats all font specifications as if
+	// they were fontsets, and 'guifontset' becomes the default.
 	if (font_name != NULL)
 	{
 	    fontset = (XFontSet)gui_mch_get_fontset(font_name, FALSE, TRUE);
@@ -1876,9 +1875,9 @@ gui_mch_init_font(
     }
     else
     {
-	/* When not using the font specified by the resources, also don't use
-	 * the bold/italic fonts, otherwise setting 'guifont' will look very
-	 * strange. */
+	// When not using the font specified by the resources, also don't use
+	// the bold/italic fonts, otherwise setting 'guifont' will look very
+	// strange.
 	if (gui.bold_font != NOFONT)
 	{
 	    XFreeFont(gui.dpy, (XFontStruct *)gui.bold_font);
@@ -1911,7 +1910,7 @@ gui_mch_get_font(char_u *name, int giveE
 {
     XFontStruct	*font;
 
-    if (!gui.in_use || name == NULL)	/* can't do this when GUI not running */
+    if (!gui.in_use || name == NULL)	// can't do this when GUI not running
 	return NOFONT;
 
     font = XLoadQueryFont(gui.dpy, (char *)name);
@@ -1961,13 +1960,13 @@ gui_mch_get_fontname(GuiFont font, char_
 
     if (name != NULL && font == NULL)
     {
-	/* In this case, there's no way other than doing this. */
+	// In this case, there's no way other than doing this.
 	ret = vim_strsave(name);
     }
     else if (font != NULL)
     {
-	/* In this case, try to retrieve the XLFD corresponding to 'font'->fid;
-	 * if failed, use 'name' unless it's NULL. */
+	// In this case, try to retrieve the XLFD corresponding to 'font'->fid;
+	// if failed, use 'name' unless it's NULL.
 	unsigned long value = 0L;
 
 	if (XGetFontProperty(font, XA_FONT, &value))
@@ -2141,7 +2140,7 @@ check_fontset_sanity(XFontSet fs)
 	    return FAIL;
 	}
     }
-    /* scan base font width */
+    // scan base font width
     min_width = 32767;
     for (i = 0; i < fn; i++)
     {
@@ -2166,7 +2165,7 @@ check_fontset_sanity(XFontSet fs)
 	    return FAIL;
 	}
     }
-    /* it seems ok. Good Luck!! */
+    // it seems ok. Good Luck!!
     return OK;
 }
 
@@ -2202,7 +2201,8 @@ fontset_height2(XFontSet fs)
 }
 #endif
 
-/* NOT USED YET
+#if 0
+// NOT USED YET
     static int
 fontset_descent(XFontSet fs)
 {
@@ -2211,7 +2211,7 @@ fontset_descent(XFontSet fs)
     extents = XExtentsOfFontSet (fs);
     return extents->max_logical_extent.height + extents->max_logical_extent.y;
 }
-*/
+#endif
 
     static int
 fontset_ascent(XFontSet fs)
@@ -2222,7 +2222,7 @@ fontset_ascent(XFontSet fs)
     return -extents->max_logical_extent.y;
 }
 
-#endif /* FEAT_XFONTSET */
+#endif // FEAT_XFONTSET
 
 /*
  * Return the Pixel value (color) for the given color name.
@@ -2233,7 +2233,7 @@ gui_mch_get_color(char_u *name)
 {
     guicolor_T	requested;
 
-    /* can't do this when GUI not running */
+    // can't do this when GUI not running
     if (!gui.in_use || name == NULL || *name == NUL)
 	return INVALCOLOR;
 
@@ -2257,14 +2257,15 @@ gui_mch_get_rgb_color(int r, int g, int 
     XColor	available;
     Colormap	colormap;
 
-/* Using XParseColor() is very slow, put rgb in XColor directly.
+#if 0
+// Using XParseColor() is very slow, put rgb in XColor directly.
 
     char	spec[8]; // space enough to hold "#RRGGBB"
     vim_snprintf(spec, sizeof(spec), "#%.2x%.2x%.2x", r, g, b);
     if (XParseColor(gui.dpy, colormap, (char *)spec, &available) != 0
 	    && XAllocColor(gui.dpy, colormap, &available) != 0)
 	return (guicolor_T)available.pixel;
-*/
+#endif
     colormap = DefaultColormap(gui.dpy, DefaultScreen(gui.dpy));
     vim_memset(&available, 0, sizeof(XColor));
     available.red = r << 8;
@@ -2362,9 +2363,9 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(
 
     if (enc_utf8)
     {
-	/* Convert UTF-8 byte sequence to 16 bit characters for the X
-	 * functions.  Need a buffer for the 16 bit characters.  Keep it
-	 * between calls, because allocating it each time is slow. */
+	// Convert UTF-8 byte sequence to 16 bit characters for the X
+	// functions.  Need a buffer for the 16 bit characters.  Keep it
+	// between calls, because allocating it each time is slow.
 	if (buflen < len)
 	{
 	    XtFree((char *)buf);
@@ -2382,7 +2383,7 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(
 	    {
 # ifdef SMALL_WCHAR_T
 		if (c >= 0x10000)
-		    c = 0xbf;		/* show chars > 0xffff as ? */
+		    c = 0xbf;		// show chars > 0xffff as ?
 # endif
 		((wchar_t *)buf)[wlen] = c;
 	    }
@@ -2390,7 +2391,7 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(
 #endif
 	    {
 		if (c >= 0x10000)
-		    c = 0xbf;		/* show chars > 0xffff as ? */
+		    c = 0xbf;		// show chars > 0xffff as ?
 		((XChar2b *)buf)[wlen].byte1 = (unsigned)c >> 8;
 		((XChar2b *)buf)[wlen].byte2 = c;
 	    }
@@ -2412,9 +2413,9 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(
 #ifdef FEAT_XFONTSET
     if (current_fontset != NULL)
     {
-	/* Setup a clip rectangle to avoid spilling over in the next or
-	 * previous line.  This is apparently needed for some fonts which are
-	 * used in a fontset. */
+	// Setup a clip rectangle to avoid spilling over in the next or
+	// previous line.  This is apparently needed for some fonts which are
+	// used in a fontset.
 	XRectangle	clip;
 
 	clip.x = 0;
@@ -2455,7 +2456,7 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(
     }
     else
     {
-	/* XmbDrawImageString has bug, don't use it for fontset. */
+	// XmbDrawImageString has bug, don't use it for fontset.
 	if (enc_utf8)
 	    XDrawImageString16(gui.dpy, gui.wid, gui.text_gc, TEXT_X(col),
 		    TEXT_Y(row), buf, wlen);
@@ -2464,7 +2465,7 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(
 		    TEXT_Y(row), (char *)s, len);
     }
 
-    /* Bold trick: draw the text again with a one-pixel offset. */
+    // Bold trick: draw the text again with a one-pixel offset.
     if (flags & DRAW_BOLD)
     {
 	if (enc_utf8)
@@ -2475,17 +2476,17 @@ gui_mch_draw_string(
 		    TEXT_Y(row), (char *)s, len);
     }
 
-    /* Undercurl: draw curl at the bottom of the character cell. */
+    // Undercurl: draw curl at the bottom of the character cell.
     if (flags & DRAW_UNDERC)
 	draw_curl(row, col, cells);
 
-    /* Underline: draw a line at the bottom of the character cell. */
+    // Underline: draw a line at the bottom of the character cell.
     if (flags & DRAW_UNDERL)
     {
 	int	y = FILL_Y(row + 1) - 1;
 
-	/* When p_linespace is 0, overwrite the bottom row of pixels.
-	 * Otherwise put the line just below the character. */
+	// When p_linespace is 0, overwrite the bottom row of pixels.
+	// Otherwise put the line just below the character.
 	if (p_linespace > 1)
 	    y -= p_linespace - 1;
 	XDrawLine(gui.dpy, gui.wid, gui.text_gc, FILL_X(col),
@@ -2543,12 +2544,12 @@ gui_mch_beep(void)
     void
 gui_mch_flash(int msec)
 {
-    /* Do a visual beep by reversing the foreground and background colors */
+    // Do a visual beep by reversing the foreground and background colors
     XFillRectangle(gui.dpy, gui.wid, gui.invert_gc, 0, 0,
 	    FILL_X((int)Columns) + gui.border_offset,
 	    FILL_Y((int)Rows) + gui.border_offset);
     XSync(gui.dpy, False);
-    ui_delay((long)msec, TRUE);	/* wait for a few msec */
+    ui_delay((long)msec, TRUE);	// wait for a few msec
     XFillRectangle(gui.dpy, gui.wid, gui.invert_gc, 0, 0,
 	    FILL_X((int)Columns) + gui.border_offset,
 	    FILL_Y((int)Rows) + gui.border_offset);
@@ -2614,7 +2615,7 @@ gui_mch_draw_part_cursor(int w, int h, g
 
     XFillRectangle(gui.dpy, gui.wid, gui.text_gc,
 #ifdef FEAT_RIGHTLEFT
-	    /* vertical line should be on the right of current point */
+	    // vertical line should be on the right of current point
 	    CURSOR_BAR_RIGHT ? FILL_X(gui.col + 1) - w :
 #endif
 		FILL_X(gui.col),
@@ -2677,8 +2678,8 @@ gui_mch_wait_for_chars(long wtime)
 				(long_u)(wtime == 0 ? 1L : wtime),
 						 gui_x11_timer_cb, &timed_out);
 #ifdef FEAT_JOB_CHANNEL
-    /* If there is a channel with the keep_open flag we need to poll for input
-     * on them. */
+    // If there is a channel with the keep_open flag we need to poll for input
+    // on them.
     if (channel_any_keep_open())
 	channel_timer = XtAppAddTimeOut(app_context, (long_u)20,
 				   channel_poll_cb, (XtPointer)&channel_timer);
@@ -2688,7 +2689,7 @@ gui_mch_wait_for_chars(long wtime)
     desired = (XtIMAll);
     while (!timed_out)
     {
-	/* Stop or start blinking when focus changes */
+	// Stop or start blinking when focus changes
 	if (gui.in_focus != focus)
 	{
 	    if (gui.in_focus)
@@ -2705,7 +2706,7 @@ gui_mch_wait_for_chars(long wtime)
 	parse_queued_messages();
 # ifdef FEAT_TIMERS
 	if (did_add_timer)
-	    /* Need to recompute the waiting time. */
+	    // Need to recompute the waiting time.
 	    break;
 # endif
 #endif
@@ -2741,7 +2742,9 @@ gui_mch_wait_for_chars(long wtime)
  * Output routines.
  */
 
-/* Flush any output to the screen */
+/*
+ * Flush any output to the screen
+ */
     void
 gui_mch_flush(void)
 {
@@ -2763,8 +2766,8 @@ gui_mch_clear_block(
 
     x = FILL_X(col1);
 
-    /* Clear one extra pixel at the far right, for when bold characters have
-     * spilled over to the next column. */
+    // Clear one extra pixel at the far right, for when bold characters have
+    // spilled over to the next column.
     XFillRectangle(gui.dpy, gui.wid, gui.back_gc, x, FILL_Y(row1),
 	    (col2 - col1 + 1) * gui.char_width + (col2 == Columns - 1),
 	    (row2 - row1 + 1) * gui.char_height);
@@ -2784,10 +2787,10 @@ gui_mch_clear_all(void)
 gui_mch_delete_lines(int row, int num_lines)
 {
     if (gui.visibility == VisibilityFullyObscured)
-	return;	    /* Can't see the window */
-
-    /* copy one extra pixel at the far right, for when bold has spilled
-     * over */
+	return;	    // Can't see the window
+
+    // copy one extra pixel at the far right, for when bold has spilled
+    // over
     XCopyArea(gui.dpy, gui.wid, gui.wid, gui.text_gc,
 	FILL_X(gui.scroll_region_left), FILL_Y(row + num_lines),
 	gui.char_width * (gui.scroll_region_right - gui.scroll_region_left + 1)
@@ -2809,10 +2812,10 @@ gui_mch_delete_lines(int row, int num_li
 gui_mch_insert_lines(int row, int num_lines)
 {
     if (gui.visibility == VisibilityFullyObscured)
-	return;	    /* Can't see the window */
-
-    /* copy one extra pixel at the far right, for when bold has spilled
-     * over */
+	return;	    // Can't see the window
+
+    // copy one extra pixel at the far right, for when bold has spilled
+    // over
     XCopyArea(gui.dpy, gui.wid, gui.wid, gui.text_gc,
 	FILL_X(gui.scroll_region_left), FILL_Y(row),
 	gui.char_width * (gui.scroll_region_right - gui.scroll_region_left + 1)
@@ -2839,18 +2842,18 @@ gui_x11_check_copy_area(void)
 
     XFlush(gui.dpy);
 
-    /* Wait to check whether the scroll worked or not */
+    // Wait to check whether the scroll worked or not
     for (;;)
     {
 	if (XCheckTypedEvent(gui.dpy, NoExpose, &event))
-	    return;	/* The scroll worked. */
+	    return;	// The scroll worked.
 
 	if (XCheckTypedEvent(gui.dpy, GraphicsExpose, &event))
 	{
 	    gevent = (XGraphicsExposeEvent *)&event;
 	    gui_redraw(gevent->x, gevent->y, gevent->width, gevent->height);
 	    if (gevent->count == 0)
-		return;		/* This was the last expose event */
+		return;		// This was the last expose event
 	}
 	XSync(gui.dpy, False);
     }
@@ -2931,7 +2934,7 @@ gui_mch_menu_hidden(vimmenu_T *menu, int
     void
 gui_mch_draw_menubar(void)
 {
-    /* Nothing to do in X */
+    // Nothing to do in X
 }
 
     void
@@ -2943,7 +2946,7 @@ gui_x11_menu_cb(
     gui_menu_cb((vimmenu_T *)client_data);
 }
 
-#endif /* FEAT_MENU */
+#endif // FEAT_MENU
 
 
 
@@ -2973,11 +2976,11 @@ gui_x11_wm_protocol_handler(
 						  wm_atoms[SAVE_YOURSELF_IDX])
     {
 	out_flush();
-	ml_sync_all(FALSE, FALSE);	/* preserve all swap files */
-
-	/* Set the window's WM_COMMAND property, to let the window manager
-	 * know we are done saving ourselves.  We don't want to be restarted,
-	 * thus set argv to NULL. */
+	ml_sync_all(FALSE, FALSE);	// preserve all swap files
+
+	// Set the window's WM_COMMAND property, to let the window manager
+	// know we are done saving ourselves.  We don't want to be restarted,
+	// thus set argv to NULL.
 	XSetCommand(gui.dpy, XtWindow(vimShell), NULL, 0);
 	return;
     }
@@ -3093,7 +3096,7 @@ gui_mch_start_blink(void)
 {
     if (blink_timer != (XtIntervalId)0)
 	XtRemoveTimeOut(blink_timer);
-    /* Only switch blinking on if none of the times is zero */
+    // Only switch blinking on if none of the times is zero
     if (blink_waittime && blink_ontime && blink_offtime && gui.in_focus)
     {
 	blink_timer = XtAppAddTimeOut(app_context, blink_waittime,
@@ -3158,7 +3161,7 @@ gui_x11_callbacks(Widget textArea, Widge
     XtAddEventHandler(textArea, KeyPressMask, FALSE, gui_x11_key_hit_cb,
 	(XtPointer)0);
 
-    /* get pointer moved events from scrollbar, needed for 'mousefocus' */
+    // get pointer moved events from scrollbar, needed for 'mousefocus'
     XtAddEventHandler(vimForm, PointerMotionMask,
 	FALSE, gui_x11_mouse_cb, (XtPointer)1);
     XtAddEventHandler(textArea, ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask |
@@ -3203,8 +3206,8 @@ gui_x11_get_last_mouse_event(void)
 
 #if defined(FEAT_SIGN_ICONS) || defined(PROTO)
 
-/* Signs are currently always 2 chars wide.  Hopefully the font is big enough
- * to provide room for the bitmap! */
+// Signs are currently always 2 chars wide.  Hopefully the font is big enough
+// to provide room for the bitmap!
 # define SIGN_WIDTH (gui.char_width * 2)
 
     void
@@ -3252,9 +3255,9 @@ gui_mch_register_sign(char_u *signfile)
 							 &sign, NULL, &attrs);
 	if (status == 0)
 	{
-	    /* Sign width is fixed at two columns now.
-	    if (sign->width > gui.sign_width)
-		gui.sign_width = sign->width + 8; */
+	    // Sign width is fixed at two columns now.
+	    // if (sign->width > gui.sign_width)
+	    //     gui.sign_width = sign->width + 8;
 	}
 	else
 	    emsg(_(e_signdata));
@@ -3272,8 +3275,8 @@ gui_mch_destroy_sign(void *sign)
 
 
 #ifdef FEAT_MOUSESHAPE
-/* The last set mouse pointer shape is remembered, to be used when it goes
- * from hidden to not hidden. */
+// The last set mouse pointer shape is remembered, to be used when it goes
+// from hidden to not hidden.
 static int last_shape = 0;
 #endif
 
@@ -3282,7 +3285,7 @@ static int last_shape = 0;
  */
     void
 gui_mch_mousehide(
-    int		hide)	/* TRUE = use blank ptr, FALSE = use parent ptr */
+    int		hide)	// TRUE = use blank ptr, FALSE = use parent ptr
 {
     if (gui.pointer_hidden != hide)
     {
@@ -3300,27 +3303,27 @@ gui_mch_mousehide(
 
 #if defined(FEAT_MOUSESHAPE) || defined(PROTO)
 
-/* Table for shape IDs.  Keep in sync with the mshape_names[] table in
- * misc2.c! */
+// Table for shape IDs.  Keep in sync with the mshape_names[] table in
+// misc2.c!
 static int mshape_ids[] =
 {
-    XC_left_ptr,		/* arrow */
-    0,				/* blank */
-    XC_xterm,			/* beam */
-    XC_sb_v_double_arrow,	/* updown */
-    XC_sizing,			/* udsizing */
-    XC_sb_h_double_arrow,	/* leftright */
-    XC_sizing,			/* lrsizing */
-    XC_watch,			/* busy */
-    XC_X_cursor,		/* no */
-    XC_crosshair,		/* crosshair */
-    XC_hand1,			/* hand1 */
-    XC_hand2,			/* hand2 */
-    XC_pencil,			/* pencil */
-    XC_question_arrow,		/* question */
-    XC_right_ptr,		/* right-arrow */
-    XC_center_ptr,		/* up-arrow */
-    XC_left_ptr			/* last one */
+    XC_left_ptr,		// arrow
+    0,				// blank
+    XC_xterm,			// beam
+    XC_sb_v_double_arrow,	// updown
+    XC_sizing,			// udsizing
+    XC_sb_h_double_arrow,	// leftright
+    XC_sizing,			// lrsizing
+    XC_watch,			// busy
+    XC_X_cursor,		// no
+    XC_crosshair,		// crosshair
+    XC_hand1,			// hand1
+    XC_hand2,			// hand2
+    XC_pencil,			// pencil
+    XC_question_arrow,		// question
+    XC_right_ptr,		// right-arrow
+    XC_center_ptr,		// up-arrow
+    XC_left_ptr			// last one
 };
 
     void
@@ -3341,7 +3344,7 @@ mch_set_mouse_shape(int shape)
 	    if (id >= XC_num_glyphs)
 		id = XC_left_ptr;
 	    else
-		id &= ~1;	/* they are always even (why?) */
+		id &= ~1;	// they are always even (why?)
 	}
 	else
 	    id = mshape_ids[shape];
@@ -3365,8 +3368,8 @@ gui_mch_menu_set_tip(vimmenu_T *menu)
     if (menu->id != NULL && menu->parent != NULL
 				       && menu_is_toolbar(menu->parent->name))
     {
-	/* Always destroy and create the balloon, in case the string was
-	 * changed. */
+	// Always destroy and create the balloon, in case the string was
+	// changed.
 	if (menu->tip != NULL)
 	{
 	    gui_mch_destroy_beval_area(menu->tip);
--- a/src/gui_xmdlg.c
+++ b/src/gui_xmdlg.c
@@ -46,9 +46,8 @@ extern Widget vimShell;
 # define apply_fontlist(w)
 #endif
 
-/****************************************************************************
- * Font selection dialogue implementation.
- */
+/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+// Font selection dialogue implementation.
 
 static char wild[3] = "*";
 
@@ -68,10 +67,10 @@ add_cancel_action(Widget shell, XtCallba
     static Atom dw_atom = 0;
     Display *display = XtDisplay(shell);
 
-    /* deactivate the built-in delete response of killing the application */
+    // deactivate the built-in delete response of killing the application
     XtVaSetValues(shell, XmNdeleteResponse, XmDO_NOTHING, NULL);
 
-    /* add a delete window protocol callback instead */
+    // add a delete window protocol callback instead
     if (!dw_atom)
     {
 	wmp_atom = XmInternAtom(display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", True);
@@ -105,14 +104,14 @@ typedef struct _SharedFontSelData
     Widget	list[NONE];
     Widget	name;
     Widget	sample;
-    char	**names;	/* font name array of arrays */
-    int		num;		/* number of font names */
-    String	sel[NONE];	/* selection category */
-    Boolean	in_pixels;	/* toggle state - size in pixels  */
-    char	*font_name;	/* current font name */
-    XFontStruct	*old;		/* font data structure for sample display */
-    XmFontList	old_list;	/* font data structure for sample display */
-    Boolean	exit;		/* used for program exit control */
+    char	**names;	// font name array of arrays
+    int		num;		// number of font names
+    String	sel[NONE];	// selection category
+    Boolean	in_pixels;	// toggle state - size in pixels
+    char	*font_name;	// current font name
+    XFontStruct	*old;		// font data structure for sample display
+    XmFontList	old_list;	// font data structure for sample display
+    Boolean	exit;		// used for program exit control
 } SharedFontSelData;
 
 /*
@@ -121,7 +120,7 @@ typedef struct _SharedFontSelData
     static char *
 fn(SharedFontSelData *data, int i)
 {
-    /* Assertion checks: */
+    // Assertion checks:
     if (data->num < 0)
 	abort();
     if (i >= data->num)
@@ -279,14 +278,14 @@ add_to_list(char **buf, char *item, int 
     if (*count == MAX_ENTRIES_IN_LIST)
 	return;
 
-    /* avoid duplication */
+    // avoid duplication
     for (i = 0; i < *count; ++i)
     {
 	if (!strcmp(buf[i], item))
 	    return;
     }
 
-    /* find order place, but make sure that wild card comes first */
+    // find order place, but make sure that wild card comes first
     if (!strcmp(item, wild))
 	i = 0;
     else
@@ -294,7 +293,7 @@ add_to_list(char **buf, char *item, int 
 	    if (strcmp(buf[i], item) > 0 && strcmp(buf[i], wild))
 		break;
 
-    /* now insert the item */
+    // now insert the item
     for (j = *count; j > i; --j)
 	buf[j] = buf[j-1];
     buf[i] = XtNewString(item);
@@ -310,12 +309,11 @@ match(SharedFontSelData *data, enum List
 {
     char buf[TEMP_BUF_SIZE];
 
-    /* An empty selection or a wild card matches anything.
-     */
+    // An empty selection or a wild card matches anything.
     if (!data->sel[l] || !strcmp(data->sel[l], wild))
 	return True;
 
-    /* chunk out the desired part... */
+    // chunk out the desired part...
     switch (l)
     {
 	case ENCODING:
@@ -337,7 +335,7 @@ match(SharedFontSelData *data, enum List
 	    ;
     }
 
-    /* ...and chew it now */
+    // ...and chew it now
 
     return !strcmp(buf, data->sel[l]);
 }
@@ -374,7 +372,7 @@ fill_lists(enum ListSpecifier fix, Share
     for (idx = (int)ENCODING; idx < (int)NONE; ++idx)
 	count[idx] = 0;
 
-    /* First we insert the wild char into every single list. */
+    // First we insert the wild char into every single list.
     if (fix != ENCODING)
 	add_to_list(list[ENCODING], wild, &count[ENCODING]);
     if (fix != NAME)
@@ -436,7 +434,7 @@ fill_lists(enum ListSpecifier fix, Share
 	WidgetList children;
 	Widget selected_button = 0;
 
-	/* Get and update the current button list.  */
+	// Get and update the current button list.
 	XtVaGetValues(data->encoding_pulldown,
 		XmNchildren, &children,
 		XmNnumChildren, &n_items,
@@ -450,7 +448,7 @@ fill_lists(enum ListSpecifier fix, Share
 
 	    if (i < (int)n_items)
 	    {
-		/* recycle old button */
+		// recycle old button
 		XtVaSetValues(children[i],
 			XmNlabelString, items[i],
 			XmNuserData, i,
@@ -459,7 +457,7 @@ fill_lists(enum ListSpecifier fix, Share
 	    }
 	    else
 	    {
-		/* create a new button */
+		// create a new button
 		button = XtVaCreateManagedWidget("button",
 			xmPushButtonGadgetClass,
 			data->encoding_pulldown,
@@ -479,16 +477,14 @@ fill_lists(enum ListSpecifier fix, Share
 	    XtFree(list[ENCODING][i]);
 	}
 
-	/* Destroy all the outstanding menu items.
-	 */
+	// Destroy all the outstanding menu items.
 	for (i = count[ENCODING]; i < (int)n_items; ++i)
 	{
 	    XtUnmanageChild(children[i]);
 	    XtDestroyWidget(children[i]);
 	}
 
-	/* Preserve the current selection visually.
-	 */
+	// Preserve the current selection visually.
 	if (selected_button)
 	{
 	    XtVaSetValues(data->encoding_menu,
@@ -522,7 +518,7 @@ fill_lists(enum ListSpecifier fix, Share
 		w = data->list[SIZE];
 		break;
 	    default:
-		w = (Widget)0;	/* for lint */
+		w = (Widget)0;	// for lint
 	}
 
 	for (i = 0; i < count[idx]; ++i)
@@ -635,7 +631,7 @@ do_choice(Widget w,
     {
 	if (!strcmp(data->sel[which], sel))
 	{
-	    /* unselecting current selection */
+	    // unselecting current selection
 	    XtFree(data->sel[which]);
 	    data->sel[which] = NULL;
 	    if (w)
@@ -651,7 +647,7 @@ do_choice(Widget w,
 
     fill_lists(which, data);
 
-    /* If there is a font selection, we display it. */
+    // If there is a font selection, we display it.
     if (data->sel[ENCODING]
 	    && data->sel[NAME]
 	    && data->sel[STYLE]
@@ -904,11 +900,11 @@ gui_xm_select_font(char_u *current)
     data->old = XLoadQueryFont(XtDisplay(parent), big_font);
     data->old_list = gui_motif_create_fontlist(data->old);
 
-    /* Set the title of the Dialog window. */
+    // Set the title of the Dialog window.
     data->dialog = XmCreateDialogShell(parent, "fontSelector", NULL, 0);
     str = XmStringCreateLocalized(_("Vim - Font Selector"));
 
-    /* Create form popup dialog widget. */
+    // Create form popup dialog widget.
     form = XtVaCreateWidget("form",
 	    xmFormWidgetClass, data->dialog,
 	    XmNdialogTitle, str,
@@ -948,7 +944,7 @@ gui_xm_select_font(char_u *current)
 	    NULL);
     apply_fontlist(data->cancel);
 
-    /* Create the separator for beauty. */
+    // Create the separator for beauty.
     n = 0;
     XtSetArg(args[n], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); n++;
     XtSetArg(args[n], XmNbottomAttachment, XmATTACH_FORM); n++;
@@ -959,7 +955,7 @@ gui_xm_select_font(char_u *current)
     separator = XmCreateSeparatorGadget(form, "separator", args, n);
     XtManageChild(separator);
 
-    /* Create font name text widget and the corresponding label. */
+    // Create font name text widget and the corresponding label.
     data->name = XtVaCreateManagedWidget("fontName",
 	    xmTextWidgetClass, form,
 	    XmNbottomAttachment, XmATTACH_FORM,
@@ -989,7 +985,7 @@ gui_xm_select_font(char_u *current)
     XmStringFree(str);
     apply_fontlist(name);
 
-    /* create sample display label widget */
+    // create sample display label widget
     disp_frame = XtVaCreateManagedWidget("sampleFrame",
 	    xmFrameWidgetClass, form,
 	    XmNshadowType, XmSHADOW_ETCHED_IN,
@@ -1014,7 +1010,7 @@ gui_xm_select_font(char_u *current)
 	    XmNfontList, data->old_list,
 	    NULL);
 
-    /* create toggle button */
+    // create toggle button
     str = XmStringCreateLocalized(_("Show size in Points"));
     size_toggle = XtVaCreateManagedWidget("sizeToggle",
 	    xmToggleButtonGadgetClass, form,
@@ -1029,8 +1025,7 @@ gui_xm_select_font(char_u *current)
     apply_fontlist(size_toggle);
     XtManageChild(size_toggle);
 
-    /* Encoding pulldown menu.
-     */
+    // Encoding pulldown menu.
 
     data->encoding_pulldown = XmCreatePulldownMenu(form,
 						 "encodingPulldown", NULL, 0);
@@ -1070,7 +1065,7 @@ gui_xm_select_font(char_u *current)
 	    XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL,
 	    NULL);
 
-    /* font list */
+    // font list
     frame = XtVaCreateManagedWidget("frame", xmFrameWidgetClass, sub_form,
 	    XmNshadowThickness, 0,
 	    XmNtopAttachment, XmATTACH_FORM,
@@ -1101,7 +1096,7 @@ gui_xm_select_font(char_u *current)
     data->list[NAME] = XmCreateScrolledList(frame, "fontList", args, n);
     XtVaSetValues(name, XmNuserData, data->list[NAME], NULL);
 
-    /* style list */
+    // style list
     frame = XtVaCreateManagedWidget("frame", xmFrameWidgetClass, sub_form,
 	    XmNshadowThickness, 0,
 	    XmNtopAttachment, XmATTACH_FORM,
@@ -1134,7 +1129,7 @@ gui_xm_select_font(char_u *current)
     data->list[STYLE] = XmCreateScrolledList(frame, "styleList", args, n);
     XtVaSetValues(name, XmNuserData, data->list[STYLE], NULL);
 
-    /* size list */
+    // size list
     frame = XtVaCreateManagedWidget("frame", xmFrameWidgetClass, sub_form,
 	    XmNshadowThickness, 0,
 	    XmNtopAttachment, XmATTACH_FORM,
@@ -1166,7 +1161,7 @@ gui_xm_select_font(char_u *current)
     data->list[SIZE] = XmCreateScrolledList(frame, "sizeList", args, n);
     XtVaSetValues(name, XmNuserData, data->list[SIZE], NULL);
 
-    /* update form widgets cancel button */
+    // update form widgets cancel button
     XtVaSetValues(form, XmNcancelButton, data->cancel, NULL);
 
     XtAddCallback(size_toggle, XmNvalueChangedCallback,
@@ -1184,7 +1179,7 @@ gui_xm_select_font(char_u *current)
 
     XmProcessTraversal(data->list[NAME], XmTRAVERSE_CURRENT);
 
-    /* setup tabgroups */
+    // setup tabgroups
 
     XmAddTabGroup(data->list[NAME]);
     XmAddTabGroup(data->list[STYLE]);
@@ -1196,7 +1191,7 @@ gui_xm_select_font(char_u *current)
 
     add_cancel_action(data->dialog, (XtCallbackProc)cancel_callback, data);
 
-    /* Preset selection data. */
+    // Preset selection data.
 
     data->exit = False;
     data->in_pixels= True;
@@ -1206,7 +1201,7 @@ gui_xm_select_font(char_u *current)
     data->sel[SIZE] = NULL;
     data->font_name = NULL;
 
-    /* set up current font parameters */
+    // set up current font parameters
     if (current && current[0] != '\0')
     {
 	int	    i;
@@ -1244,14 +1239,12 @@ gui_xm_select_font(char_u *current)
 	    }
 	    else
 	    {
-		/* We can't preset a symbolic name, which isn't a full font
-		 * description. Therefore we just behave the same way as if the
-		 * user didn't have selected anything thus far.
-		 *
-		 * Unfortunately there is no known way to expand an abbreviated
-		 * font name.
-		 */
-
+		// We can't preset a symbolic name, which isn't a full font
+		// description. Therefore we just behave the same way as if the
+		// user didn't have selected anything thus far.
+		//
+		// Unfortunately there is no known way to expand an abbreviated
+		// font name.
 		data->font_name = NULL;
 	    }
 	}
@@ -1260,16 +1253,15 @@ gui_xm_select_font(char_u *current)
 
     fill_lists(NONE, data);
 
-    /* Unfortunately LessTif doesn't align the list widget's properly.  I don't
-     * have currently any idea how to fix this problem.
-     */
+    // Unfortunately LessTif doesn't align the list widget's properly.  I don't
+    // have currently any idea how to fix this problem.
     XtManageChild(data->list[NAME]);
     XtManageChild(data->list[STYLE]);
     XtManageChild(data->list[SIZE]);
     XtManageChild(data->encoding_menu);
     manage_centered(form);
 
-    /* modal event loop */
+    // modal event loop
     while (!data->exit)
 	XtAppProcessEvent(XtWidgetToApplicationContext(data->dialog),
 							(XtInputMask)XtIMAll);
--- a/src/gui_xmebw.c
+++ b/src/gui_xmebw.c
@@ -52,13 +52,12 @@
 
 #include "gui_xmebwp.h"
 
-/* Provide some missing wrappers, which are missed from the LessTif
- * implementation.  Also missing in Motif 1.2 and earlier.
- *
- * We neither use XmeGetPixmapData or _XmGetPixmapData, since with LessTif the
- * pixmap will not appear in its caches properly. We cache the interesting
- * values in XmEnhancedButtonPart instead ourself.
- */
+// Provide some missing wrappers, which are missed from the LessTif
+// implementation.  Also missing in Motif 1.2 and earlier.
+//
+// We neither use XmeGetPixmapData or _XmGetPixmapData, since with LessTif the
+// pixmap will not appear in its caches properly. We cache the interesting
+// values in XmEnhancedButtonPart instead ourself.
 #if defined(LESSTIF_VERSION) || (XmVersion <= 1002)
 # ifndef Lab_IsMenupane
 #  define Lab_IsMenupane(w) (Lab_MenuType(w) == (int)XmMENU_POPUP || \
@@ -74,7 +73,7 @@
  * Motif internals we have to cheat around with.
  */
 
-/* Hopefully this will never change... */
+// Hopefully this will never change...
 #ifndef XmFOCUS_IGNORE
 # define XmFOCUS_IGNORE       1<<1
 #endif
@@ -144,8 +143,8 @@ static XtResource resources[] =
     }
 };
 
-/* This is needed to work around a bug in Lesstif 2, leaving the extension
- * NULL somehow results in getting it set to an invalid pointer. */
+// This is needed to work around a bug in Lesstif 2, leaving the extension
+// NULL somehow results in getting it set to an invalid pointer.
 XmPrimitiveClassExtRec xmEnhancedButtonPrimClassExtRec =
 {
     /* next_extension      */ NULL,
@@ -160,7 +159,7 @@ XmPrimitiveClassExtRec xmEnhancedButtonP
 XmEnhancedButtonClassRec xmEnhancedButtonClassRec =
 {
     {
-	/* core_class fields */
+	// core_class fields
 	/* superclass		 */ (WidgetClass) & xmPushButtonClassRec,
 	/* class_name		 */ "XmEnhancedButton",
 	/* widget_size		 */ sizeof(XmEnhancedButtonRec),
@@ -195,7 +194,7 @@ XmEnhancedButtonClassRec xmEnhancedButto
 	/* extension		 */ NULL
     },
 
-    /* primitive_class fields */
+    // primitive_class fields
     {
 	/* border highlight	 */ BorderHighlight,
 	/* border_unhighlight	 */ BorderUnhighlight,
@@ -206,7 +205,7 @@ XmEnhancedButtonClassRec xmEnhancedButto
 	/* extension		 */ (XtPointer)&xmEnhancedButtonPrimClassExtRec,
     },
 
-    /* label_class fields */
+    // label_class fields
     {
 	/* setOverrideCallback	 */ XmInheritSetOverrideCallback,
 	/* menuProcs		 */ XmInheritMenuProc,
@@ -214,12 +213,12 @@ XmEnhancedButtonClassRec xmEnhancedButto
 	/* extension		 */ NULL,
     },
 
-    /* pushbutton_class record */
+    // pushbutton_class record
     {
 	/* extension		 */ (XtPointer) NULL,
     },
 
-    /* enhancedbutton_class fields */
+    // enhancedbutton_class fields
     {
 	/* stipple_bitmap	 */ None
     }
@@ -262,17 +261,17 @@ alloc_color(Display	*display,
     return status != 0 ? 1 : 0;
 }
 
-/* XPM */
+// XPM
 static char * blank_xpm[] =
 {
-/* width height ncolors cpp [x_hot y_hot] */
+// width height ncolors cpp [x_hot y_hot]
 "12 12 4 1 0 0",
-/* colors */
+// colors
 " 	s iconColor1	m black	c #000000",
 ".	s none	m none	c none",
 "X	s topShadowColor	m none	c #DCDEE5",
 "o	s bottomShadowColor	m black	c #5D6069",
-/* pixels */
+// pixels
 "          ..",
 " XXXXXXXX ..",
 " X....... o.",
@@ -292,8 +291,8 @@ static char * blank_xpm[] =
     static void
 set_pixmap(XmEnhancedButtonWidget eb)
 {
-    /* Configure defines XPMATTRIBUTES_TYPE as XpmAttributes or as
-     * XpmAttributes_21, depending on what is in Xm/XpmP.h. */
+    // Configure defines XPMATTRIBUTES_TYPE as XpmAttributes or as
+    // XpmAttributes_21, depending on what is in Xm/XpmP.h.
     XPMATTRIBUTES_TYPE   attr;
     Pixmap	    sen_pix;
     Window	    root;
@@ -323,8 +322,7 @@ set_pixmap(XmEnhancedButtonWidget eb)
     int		    shift;
     GC		    gc;
 
-    /* Make sure there is a default value for the pixmap.
-     */
+    // Make sure there is a default value for the pixmap.
     if (!data)
 	return;
 
@@ -343,7 +341,7 @@ set_pixmap(XmEnhancedButtonWidget eb)
     eb->enhancedbutton.highlight_pixmap = None;
     eb->enhancedbutton.insensitive_pixmap = None;
 
-    /* We use dynamic colors, get them now. */
+    // We use dynamic colors, get them now.
     motif_get_toolbar_colors(
 	    &eb->core.background_pixel,
 	    &eb->primitive.foreground,
@@ -351,7 +349,7 @@ set_pixmap(XmEnhancedButtonWidget eb)
 	    &eb->primitive.top_shadow_color,
 	    &eb->primitive.highlight_color);
 
-    /* Setup color substitution table. */
+    // Setup color substitution table.
     color[0].pixel = eb->core.background_pixel;
     color[1].pixel = eb->core.background_pixel;
     color[2].pixel = eb->core.background_pixel;
@@ -361,9 +359,9 @@ set_pixmap(XmEnhancedButtonWidget eb)
     color[6].pixel = eb->primitive.highlight_color;
     color[7].pixel = eb->pushbutton.arm_color;
 
-    /* Create the "sensitive" pixmap. */
+    // Create the "sensitive" pixmap.
     attr.valuemask = XpmColorSymbols | XpmCloseness;
-    attr.closeness = 65535;	/* accuracy isn't crucial */
+    attr.closeness = 65535;	// accuracy isn't crucial
     attr.colorsymbols = color;
     attr.numsymbols = XtNumber(color);
 
@@ -372,7 +370,7 @@ set_pixmap(XmEnhancedButtonWidget eb)
     if (!fname || status != XpmSuccess)
 	status = XpmCreatePixmapFromData(dpy, root, data, &pix, &mask, &attr);
 
-    /* If something failed, we will fill in the default pixmap. */
+    // If something failed, we will fill in the default pixmap.
     if (status != XpmSuccess)
 	status = XpmCreatePixmapFromData(dpy, root, blank_xpm, &pix,
 								&mask, &attr);
@@ -381,7 +379,7 @@ set_pixmap(XmEnhancedButtonWidget eb)
 
     XGetGeometry(dpy, pix, &root, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
 
-    /* TODO: does the shift depend on label_location somehow? */
+    // TODO: does the shift depend on label_location somehow?
     shift = eb->primitive.shadow_thickness / 2;
 
     if (shift < 1)
@@ -395,15 +393,15 @@ set_pixmap(XmEnhancedButtonWidget eb)
     XSetClipOrigin(dpy, gc, shift, shift);
     XCopyArea(dpy, pix, sen_pix, gc, 0, 0, width, height, shift, shift);
 
-    /* Create the "highlight" pixmap. */
+    // Create the "highlight" pixmap.
     color[4].pixel = eb->primitive.bottom_shadow_color;
-#ifdef XpmAllocColor /* SGI doesn't have it */
+#ifdef XpmAllocColor // SGI doesn't have it
     attr.valuemask = XpmColorSymbols | XpmCloseness | XpmAllocColor;
     attr.alloc_color = alloc_color;
 #else
     attr.valuemask = XpmColorSymbols | XpmCloseness;
 #endif
-    attr.closeness = 65535;	/* accuracy isn't crucial */
+    attr.closeness = 65535;	// accuracy isn't crucial
     attr.colorsymbols = color;
     attr.numsymbols = XtNumber(color);
 
@@ -439,15 +437,15 @@ set_pixmap(XmEnhancedButtonWidget eb)
     XFreePixmap(dpy, pix);
     XFreePixmap(dpy, mask);
 
-    /* Create the "insensitive" pixmap. */
+    // Create the "insensitive" pixmap.
     attr.valuemask = XpmColorSymbols | XpmCloseness | XpmColorKey;
-    attr.closeness = 65535;	/* accuracy isn't crucial */
+    attr.closeness = 65535;	// accuracy isn't crucial
     attr.colorsymbols = color;
     attr.numsymbols = sizeof(color) / sizeof(color[0]);
     attr.color_key = XPM_MONO;
     status = XpmCreatePixmapFromData(dpy, root, data, &pix, &mask, &attr);
 
-    /* Need to create new Pixmaps with the mask applied. */
+    // Need to create new Pixmaps with the mask applied.
 
     ins_pix = XCreatePixmap(dpy, root, width + shift, height + shift, depth);
 
@@ -566,13 +564,13 @@ draw_unhighlight(XmEnhancedButtonWidget 
 			    XtClass(eb->core.parent), XmQTspecifyUnhighlight))
 		    != NULL) && (UnhighlightT->getUnhighlightGC != NULL))
 	{
-	    /* if unhighlight trait in parent use specified GC... */
+	    // if unhighlight trait in parent use specified GC...
 	    manager_background_GC =
 		 UnhighlightT->getUnhighlightGC(eb->core.parent, (Widget) eb);
 	}
 	else
 	{
-	    /* ...otherwise, use parent's background GC */
+	    // ...otherwise, use parent's background GC
 	    manager_background_GC = ((XmManagerWidget)
 				    (eb->core.parent))->manager.background_GC;
 	}
@@ -696,7 +694,7 @@ draw_label(XmEnhancedButtonWidget eb, XE
 		eb->label.pixmap = eb->pushbutton.unarm_pixmap;
 	}
 	else
-	    /* pushbutton is not armed */
+	    // pushbutton is not armed
 	    eb->label.pixmap = eb->pushbutton.unarm_pixmap;
     }
 
@@ -758,7 +756,7 @@ Enter(Widget wid,
 	    if (eb->pushbutton.armed)
 		return;
 
-	    /* ...so KHelp event is delivered correctly. */
+	    // ...so KHelp event is delivered correctly.
 	    _XmSetFocusFlag(XtParent(XtParent(eb)), XmFOCUS_IGNORE, TRUE);
 	    XtSetKeyboardFocus(XtParent(XtParent(eb)), (Widget) eb);
 	    _XmSetFocusFlag(XtParent(XtParent(eb)), XmFOCUS_IGNORE, FALSE);
@@ -767,7 +765,7 @@ Enter(Widget wid,
 
 	    ((XmManagerWidget) XtParent(wid))->manager.active_child = wid;
 
-	    /* etched in menu button */
+	    // etched in menu button
 	    if (etched_in && !XmIsTearOffButton(eb))
 	    {
 		XFillRectangle(XtDisplay(eb), XtWindow(eb),
@@ -843,7 +841,7 @@ Leave(Widget wid,
 
 	if (_XmGetInDragMode((Widget)eb)
 		&& eb->pushbutton.armed
-		&& ( /* !ActiveTearOff || */
+		&& ( // !ActiveTearOff ||
 				       event->xcrossing.mode == NotifyNormal))
 	{
 	    eb->pushbutton.armed = FALSE;
@@ -915,7 +913,7 @@ set_size(XmEnhancedButtonWidget newtb)
 
     _XmCalcLabelDimensions((Widget) newtb);
 
-    /* Find out how big the pixmap is */
+    // Find out how big the pixmap is
     if (newtb->enhancedbutton.pixmap_data
 	    && !IsNull(newtb->label.pixmap)
 	    && !IsNull(newtb->enhancedbutton.normal_pixmap))
@@ -958,8 +956,8 @@ set_size(XmEnhancedButtonWidget newtb)
     }
     else
     {
-	/* FIXME: We should calculate an drawing offset for the pixmap here to
-	 * adjust it.  */
+	// FIXME: We should calculate an drawing offset for the pixmap here to
+	// adjust it.
     }
 
 #if 0
@@ -972,7 +970,7 @@ set_size(XmEnhancedButtonWidget newtb)
 	    newtb->core.height);
 #endif
 
-    /* Invoke Label's Resize procedure. */
+    // Invoke Label's Resize procedure.
     {
 	XtWidgetProc resize;
 	XtProcessLock();
@@ -994,7 +992,7 @@ Initialize(Widget rq, Widget ebw, ArgLis
     resize = xmLabelClassRec.core_class.resize;
     XtProcessUnlock();
 
-    /* Create a bitmap for stippling (Drawable resources are cheap).  */
+    // Create a bitmap for stippling (Drawable resources are cheap).
     if (STIPPLE_BITMAP == None)
     {
 	Display *dpy = XtDisplay((Widget) request);
@@ -1005,15 +1003,14 @@ Initialize(Widget rq, Widget ebw, ArgLis
     }
     eb->enhancedbutton.doing_setvalues = False;
 
-    /* First see what type of extended label this is.
-     */
+    // First see what type of extended label this is.
     if (eb->enhancedbutton.pixmap_data)
     {
 	XmString str;
 	set_pixmap(eb);
 
-	/* FIXME: this is not the perfect way to deal with menus, which do not
-	 * have any string set right now.  */
+	// FIXME: this is not the perfect way to deal with menus, which do not
+	// have any string set right now.
 	str = XmStringCreateLocalized("");
 	XtVaSetValues((Widget) eb, XmNlabelString, str, NULL);
 	XmStringFree(str);
@@ -1106,7 +1103,7 @@ SetValues(Widget current,
 	    /*
 	     * Artificially let the highlight appear if the mouse is over us.
 	     */
-	    /* Best way to get the root window of object: */
+	    // Best way to get the root window of object:
 	    XGetGeometry(dpy, XtWindow(cur), &root, &r_x, &r_y, &r_width,
 			 &r_height, &r_border, &r_depth);
 	    XQueryPointer(XtDisplay(cur), XtWindow(cur), &root_q, &child,
@@ -1133,7 +1130,7 @@ SetValues(Widget current,
     if (NOT_EQUAL(primitive.shadow_thickness))
     {
 	redraw = True;
-	/* Don't change the pixmaps */
+	// Don't change the pixmaps
 	change = False;
     }
 
@@ -1230,10 +1227,9 @@ Redisplay(Widget w, XEvent *event, Regio
     {
 	GC  gc;
 
-	/* Don't shade if the button contains a label with a pixmap, since
-	 * there is no variant of the label available with the needed
-	 * background.
-	 */
+	// Don't shade if the button contains a label with a pixmap, since
+	// there is no variant of the label available with the needed
+	// background.
 	if (eb->pushbutton.armed && eb->pushbutton.fill_on_arm)
 	{
 		if (eb->label.label_type == (int)XmPIXMAP)
@@ -1248,7 +1244,7 @@ Redisplay(Widget w, XEvent *event, Regio
 	}
 	else
 	    gc = eb->pushbutton.background_gc;
-	/* really need to fill with background if not armed ? */
+	// really need to fill with background if not armed ?
 	if (gc)
 	    XFillRectangle(XtDisplay(eb), XtWindow(eb), gc,
 		    box.x, box.y, box.width, box.height);
@@ -1318,7 +1314,7 @@ Redisplay(Widget w, XEvent *event, Regio
 	    switch (default_button_emphasis)
 	    {
 		case XmINTERNAL_HIGHLIGHT:
-		    /* The call above erases the border highlighting. */
+		    // The call above erases the border highlighting.
 		    if (eb->primitive.highlight_drawn)
 			(*(((XmPushButtonWidgetClass) XtClass (eb))
 			   ->primitive_class.border_highlight)) ((Widget) eb) ;
@@ -1368,13 +1364,13 @@ Redisplay(Widget w, XEvent *event, Regio
 		parent = XtParent(eb);
 		if (XmIsManager(parent))
 		{
-		    /* Use the parent's GC so monochrome works. */
+		    // Use the parent's GC so monochrome works.
 		    bottom_gc = XmParentTopShadowGC(eb);
 		    top_gc = XmParentBottomShadowGC(eb);
 		}
 		else
 		{
-		    /* Use your own pixel for drawing. */
+		    // Use your own pixel for drawing.
 		    bottom_gc = eb->primitive.top_shadow_GC;
 		    top_gc = eb->primitive.bottom_shadow_GC;
 		}
@@ -1447,4 +1443,4 @@ BorderUnhighlight(Widget w)
     draw_pixmap(eb, NULL, NULL);
 }
 
-#endif /* FEAT_TOOLBAR */
+#endif // FEAT_TOOLBAR
--- a/src/version.c
+++ b/src/version.c
@@ -743,6 +743,8 @@ static char *(features[]) =
 static int included_patches[] =
 {   /* Add new patch number below this line */
 /**/
+    2383,
+/**/
     2382,
 /**/
     2381,